Diajukan Untuk Memenuhi Persyaratan Memperoleh Gelar Sarjana Pada Jurusan Hubungan Internasional

Ukuran: px
Mulai penontonan dengan halaman:

Download "Diajukan Untuk Memenuhi Persyaratan Memperoleh Gelar Sarjana Pada Jurusan Hubungan Internasional"

Transkripsi

1 KEBIJAKAN LUAR NEGERI AUSTRALIA TERHADAP INDONESIA: PEMERINTAHAN JOHN HOWARD DARI PARTAI KOALISI LIBERAL ( ) DAN PEMERINTAHAN KEVIN RUDD DARI PARTAI BURUH ( ) Diajukan Untuk Memenuhi Persyaratan Memperoleh Gelar Sarjana Pada Jurusan Hubungan Internasional Oleh: Christa Mc Auliffe Suryo Puteri NIM: PROGRAM STUDI HUBUNGAN INTERNASIONAL FAKULTAS ILMU SOSIAL DAN ILMU POLITIK UNIVERSITAS ISLAM NEGERI SYARIF HIDAYATULLAH JAKARTA 2011

2

3

4 LEMBAR PERNYATAAN Dengan ini saya menyatakan bahwa : 1. Skripsi ini merupakan hasil karya asli saya yang diajukan untuk memenuhi salah satu persyaratan memperoleh gelar strata 1 di Universitas Islam Negeri (UIN) Syarif Hidayatullah Jakarta. 2. Semua sumber yang saya gunakan dalam penulisan ini telah saya cantumkan sesuai dengan ketentuan yang berlaku di Universitas Islam Negeri (UIN) Syarif Hidayatullah Jakarta. 3. Jika di kemudian hari terbukti bahwa karya ini bukan hasil karya saya atau merupakan hasil jiplakan dari karya orang lain, maka saya bersedia menerima sanksi yang berlaku di Universitas Islam Negeri (UIN) Syarif Hidayatullah Jakarta. Jakarta, 29 Juli 2011 Christa Mc Auliffe Suryo Puteri i

5 ABSTRAK Penelitian di dalam skripsi ini memaparkan tentang kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia dari dua pemerintahan Australia yang dipimpin oleh dua Perdana Menteri dari dua partai besar yang berbeda di Australia, yakni pemerintahan John Howard dari Partai Koalisi Liberal ( ) dan pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh ( ). Konsep yang dipakai penulis untuk menjawab pertanyaan penelitian di dalam skripsi ini adalah konsep kebijakan luar negeri model adaptif milik Rosenau yang dikaitkan dengan faktor-faktor internal dan eksternal yang mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia. Model adaptif ini menggambarkan bahwa kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia dipengaruhi oleh faktorfaktor internal dan eksternal serta gaya kepemimpinan (leadership) Perdana Menteri dari Partai Koalisi Liberal dan Partai Buruh. Selanjutnya, skripsi ini merupakan penelitian kualitatif dengan mengandalkan data-data primer dan skunder yang bertujuan untuk memaparkan atau mendeskripsikan tentang kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia pada pemerintahan John Howard dan Kevin Rudd. Dari penelitian ini diketahui bahwa terdapat faktor-faktor internal dan eksternal serta gaya kepemimpinan dari Perdana Menteri John Howard dari Partai koalisi Liberal dan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh yang mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia. Di antara faktor-faktor tersebut, faktor gaya kepemimpinanlah yang menjadi fokus penulis dari penelitian ini. ii

6 KATA PENGANTAR Bismillahirrahmanirrahim, segala puji bagi Allah SWT atas segala rahmat dan nikmatnya, sehingga penulis dapat menyelesaikan skripsi ini. Sebagai syarat untuk mendapatkan gelar sarjana pada jurusan Hubungan Internasional. Terimakasih dan syukur penulis ucapkan atas segala dukungan dan motivasi yang telah diberikan kepada penulis dari berbagai pihak sehingga penulis mampu menyelesaikan skripsi ini. Penulis menyadari bahwa dukungan dan motivasi dari berbagai pihak tersebut sangat membantu penulis dalam melalui hambatan selama proses penyelesaian skripsi ini. Berbagai pihak yang membantu di antaranya: kedua orang tua penulis, Papa dan Mama tersayang yang telah memberikan yang terbaik untuk penulis, baik kasih sayang, doa, nasehat, dukungan dan motivasi dalam segala hal dari awal hingga akhir, terimakasih Papa dan Mamaku tersayang. Selain itu, penulis ingin menyampaikan rasa terimakasih kepada kedua kakak penulis, Mas Agnesch dan Mas Ronald yang selalu menemani, membantu, menjaga, menyayangi dan berbagi banyak hal kepada penulis. Terimakasih banyak karena kalian telah memberikan dan menjadi yang terbaik untukku. Kemudian, penulis juga menyampaikan rasa terima kasih yang sebesarbesarnya kepada dosen pembimbing sekaligus Ketua Jurusan Hubungan Internasional, Ibu Dina Afrianty, Ph.D, yang telah membimbing penulis dalam memahami permasalahan di dalam skripsi ini, meluangkan waktu untuk membaca skripsi ini, mendengarkan penulis, memberi dukungan penulis, menyemangati di saat suka maupun duka. Semua itu sangat membantu penulis dalam menyelesaikan skripsi ini. Terimakasih atas arahan, ilmu, nasehat, dukungan serta motivasi yang telah Ibu Dina berikan selama ini. Penulis sangat bersyukur sekali dapat bertemu dan dibimbing oleh Ibu Dina. Sekali lagi terimakasih Ibu Dina atas smuanya. Selanjutnya, terimakasih juga penulis sampaikan kepada Bapak Ali Munhanif Ph.D. selaku Penasehat Akademik, Bapak Agus Nilmada Azmi M.Si. selaku Sekretaris Jurusan Hubungan Internasional, Bapak Nazaruddin Nasution, iii

7 MA dan Bapak Adian Firnas, M.Si selaku dosen Hubungan Internasional, dan juga seluruh staf Dosen di jurusan Hubungan Internasional yang telah mengajarkan dan membagi ilmunya kepada penulis selama masa studi di UIN. Terimakasih penulis ucapkan kepada Prof. Dr. Ikrar Nusa Bhakti selaku peneliti LIPI, yang telah meluangkan waktunya untuk diwawancara oleh penulis dan menjelaskan secara detail kepada penulis mengenai hubungan Australia- Indonesia. Terimakasih juga Prof. Ikrar untuk beberapa masukannya. Terimakasih kepada seluruh keluarga besar penulis atas dukungan dan doanya. Pakde, Bude, Oom, Tante, dan Sepupu-sepupu (Suryo Putero dan Suryo Puteri) yang telah menghibur penulis di saat bosan, terimakasih. Terimakasih juga kepada: Ali Fikri, Natiqoh, Qory, Izzun dan Anne, yang turut serta membantu penulis dalam mencari dan mendapatkan bahan-bahan untuk skripsi ini. Teman-teman penulis yang selalu ada untuk mendengarkan isi hati penulis: Dian, Diah, Desty dan Astrid, terimakasih. Untuk sahabat kecil penulis Septiani, makasih atas dukungannya selama ini. Serta untuk teman-teman HI lainnya: Insan, Firman, Nanda, Ican, Alfi Perdana, Julian, dan lain-lain yang tidak bisa penulis tuliskan satu persatu, namun tanpa mengurangi rasa terimakasih kepada kalian, thank you so much and best luck for you mates. Penulis juga sampaikan terimakasih kepada rekan-rekan kerja di Toeic Center Indonesia yang telah memberikan kesempatan serta pengalaman kepada penulis. Terimakasih atas dispensasi waktu yang diberikan kepada penulis untuk menyelesaikan skripsi ini. Tidak lupa penulis ucapkan terimakasih yang tulus untuk Mustafid yang selama ini telah setia menemani, mendengarkan dan memberikan kecerian serta nasehat kepada penulis. Terimakasih untuk perhatian dan dukungan yang diberikan. Semangat buat skripsinya Mustafid, Jeg Elsker Deg. Terakhir, terlepas dari adanya kekurangan di dalam skripsi ini, penulis berharap skripsi ini dapat memberikan manfaat bagi siapapun yang membacanya. Dan untuk semua pihak yang membantu dalam penyelasaian skripsi ini semoga diberikan balasan kebaikan yang berlipat. Christa Mc Auliffe Suryo Puteri iv

8 DAFTAR ISI DAFTAR ISI DAFTAR TABEL BAB I PENDAHULUAN A. Latar Belakang...1 B. Pertanyaan Penelitian...6 C. Kerangka Pemikiran C.1 Konsep Kebijakan Luar Negeri...7 C.2 Konsep Kepentingan Nasional...12 D. Metode Penelitian...13 E. Sistematika Penulisan...14 BAB II FAKTOR-FAKTOR YANG MEMPENGARUHI KEBIJAKAN LUAR NEGERI AUSTRALIA A. Faktor Internal A.1 Faktor Sejarah dan Demografis...17 A.2 Faktor Geografis...22 A.3 Kepentingan Nasional...26 A.4 Pembuatan Kebijakan Luar Negeri Australia...30 A.5 Kebijakan Pertahanan Australia...38 B. Faktor Eksternal B.1 Perkembangan Konstelasi Politik, Keamanan dan Ekonomi Regional dan Internasional...40 v

9 BAB III KEBIJAKAN LUAR NEGERI AUSTRALIA TERHADAP INDONESIA: PEMERINTAHAN JOHN HOWARD DARI PARTAI KOALISI LIBERAL ( ) DAN PEMERINTAHAN KEVIN RUDD DARI PARTAI BURUH ( ) A. Kebijakan Luar Negeri Australia Terhadap Indonesia di Bawah Pemerintahan John Howard dari Koalisi Liberal ( )...44 B. Kebijakan Luar Negeri Australia Terhadap Indonesia di Bawah Pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh ( )...66 BAB IV ANALISA GAYA KEPEMIMPINAN JOHN HOWARD DARI PARTAI KOALISI LIBERAL DAN KEVIN RUDD DARI PARTAI BURUH Analisa Gaya Kepemimpinan John Howard dari Partai Koalisi Liberal dan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh...78 BAB V PENUTUP DAFTAR PUSTAKA LAMPIRAN A. Kesimpulan...87 vi

10 DAFTAR TABEL Tabel III.1 Bantuan Australia untuk Kegiatan Anti-Teroris: Tabel III.2 Barang Ekspor Utama Australia ke Indonesia: Tabel III.3 Barang Impor Utama Australia dari Indonesia: Tabel III.4 Grafik Perdagangan Indonesia-Australia: Tabel IV Neraca Perdagangan Indonesia-Australia: vii

11 DAFTAR LAMPIRAN Lampiran 1: Transkrip Wawancara Lampiran 2: Defence White Paper 2009 viii

12 BAB I PENDAHULUAN A. Latar Belakang Masalah Australia dan Indonesia merupakan dua negara yang secara geografis dekat, namun memiliki banyak perbedaan, baik dalam segi sejarah, politik, ekonomi, sosial dan budaya. Karena begitu banyaknya perbedaan yang ada di antara dua negara ini sehingga sulit untuk menemukan dua negara bertetangga lain seperti Australia dan Indonesia. Hal ini sejalan dengan pernyataan Evans (1991: 1) bahwa tidak ada dua negara tetangga di belahan dunia manapun yang berbeda sejarah, budaya, penduduk, bahasa serta tradisi sosial dan politiknya seperti Australia dan Indonesia. Indonesia terletak di antara dua benua, yakni Asia dan Australia dan diapit oleh dua samudera, yaitu Samudera Pasifik dan Samudera Hindia. Hal ini menempatkan peran strategis Indonesia di mata internasional termasuk Australia. Indonesia setidaknya memiliki tiga selat yang menjadi lintas perdagangan internasional yang menghubungkan Samudera Pasifik dengan Samudera Hindia, yaitu Selat Malaka, Selat Sunda dan Selat Lombok. Oleh karena hal inilah, Indonesia bernilai strategis secara politik (Ibnudin, Pikiran Rakyat, 22 Maret 2010). Lebih jauh lagi, sebagai tetangga dekat, Indonesia menempati posisi penting bagi Australia. Oleh sebab itu secara geopolitik Indonesia menjadi salah satu 1

13 perhatian utama dalam kebijakan luar negeri Australia. Dengan demikian membangun kemitraan yang sehat antara Australia-Indonesia merupakan suatu tuntutan yang harus diciptakan oleh kedua negara (Sulistiyanto 2010). Hubungan Australia dengan Indonesia diawali saat Indonesia berjuang untuk mencapai kemerdekaan pada tahun Pada masa itu, Australia bersimpati terhadap perjuangan kemerdekaan Indonesia. Australia di bawah pemerintahan Perdana Menteri Joseph Benedict Chifley dari Partai Buruh, menjadi negara yang sangat mendukung kemerdekaan Indonesia (Bhakti 1992: 143). Evans (1991: 186) juga menyatakan bahwa Australia mendukung Indonesia dan sangat menentang kolonialisme Belanda. Dukungan Australia terhadap Indonesia terlihat ketika pada tahun 1947, Australia resmi menjadi wakil dari Indonesia dalam Komisi Jasa-Jasa Baik (United Good Offices Committe) serta mendukung Indonesia bergabung dalam Perserikatan Bangsa-Bangsa (PBB) pada tahun Walaupun hubungan antara Australia-Indonesia awalnya berlangsung baik dan harmonis, bukan berarti hubungan tersebut bersifat statis. Sejarah mencatat hubungan kedua negara ini sering mengalami pasang surut. Adakalanya hubungan diplomatik Australia-Indonesia berjalan baik tanpa kendala yang berarti, namun tidak jarang hubungan keduanya memanas. Menurut Evans (1991: 186) hubungan Australia dan Indonesia dapat diibaratkan sebagai roller coaster", yang suatu ketika mengalami peningkatan hubungan, namun juga selalu diikuti dengan penurunan. 2

14 Pergantian pemerintahan di Australia dari Partai Buruh kepada Partai koalisi Liberal yang dipimpin oleh Perdana Menteri Menzies untuk periode , mempengaruhi hubungan antara Australia dengan Indonesia pada kurun waktu tersebut. Di samping itu, situasi Perang Dingin juga membuat kebijakan luar negeri Australia di bawah pemerintahan koalisi Liberal harus mendukung politik global Amerika Serikat pada masa tersebut, yakni membendung penyebaran komunis (containment policy). Hal ini menyebabkan Australia di bawah Pemerintahan koalisi Liberal lebih menginginkan kekuatan-kekuatan Barat ada di Asia Pasifik. Akibatnya, pemerintah Australia saat itu mendukung Irian Barat (Papua) dikuasai oleh Belanda. Permasalahan tentang Papua masih sering menjadi masalah dalam hubungan Australia-Indonesia hingga saat ini (Bhakti, Wuryandari dan Muna 1997; Hamid 1999; Tewes ; Firth 2005). Selain kebijakan pemerintah koalisi Liberal yang mendukung containment policy, perubahan sikap Australia terhadap Indonesia juga disebabkan oleh posisi Indonesia dan Papua New Guinea yang merupakan benteng pertahanan dan sekaligus titik kelemahan Australia (Hamid 1999). Lebih jauh lagi, menurut Suryadinata (1998: 115) konfrontasi Indonesia-Belanda mengenai pembebasan Papua serta konfrontasi Indonesia-Malaysia pada 1965, membuat Australia menaruh curiga kepada Indonesia. Sikap Australia tersebut disebabkan pada saat itu, Partai Komunis mulai berpengaruh sehingga menyebabkan kekhawatiran Australia akan penyebaran komunis di kawasan Asia Pasifik. Oleh karena itu, antara tahun hubungan Australia-Indonesia mengalami titik terendah 3

15 (lihat juga Critchley 1995; Bhakti, Wuryandari dan Muna 1997; Thorton et. al 1997; Firth 2005). Hubungan Australia-Indonesia antara tahun sangat fluktuatif, di mana antara tahun itu hubungan keduanya menghadapi beberapa masalah, seperti masalah integrasi Timor Timur ke Indonesia dan masalah pemberitaan kekayaan Presiden Soeharto oleh salah satu media cetak Australia The Sydney Morning Herald pada 10 April Namun, masalah utama yang mengganggu hubungan kedua negara adalah masalah integrasi Timor Timur ke Indonesia yang bukan dengan jalan damai hingga mengakibatkan terbunuhnya lima wartawan Australia pada tahun 1975 (kasus Balibo) (Bhakti, Wuryandari dan Muna 1997). Kebijakan luar negeri Australia mengenai permasalahan Timor Timur lebih diwarnai oleh kebijakan dari Perdana Menteri Whitlam dari Partai Buruh ( ) yang mendukung integrasi Timor Timur ke Indonesia. Keinginan Australia untuk menjaga hubungan baik dengan Indonesia pada masa itu membuat Australia tetap mendukung Indonesia. Walaupun setelah peristiwa Balibo media massa dan publik Australia menjadi kritis terhadap Indonesia, namun Australia tidak menginginkan adanya isu-isu yang mengganggu hubungan kedua negara. Hal ini disebabkan pada masa itu, Indonesia memiliki pengaruh kuat serta peran penting di kawasan Asia Tenggara. Indonesia saat itu dapat menjadi pintu pembuka bagi hubungan Australia dengan negara-negara di kawasan Asia Tenggara bahkan negara-negara Asia lainnya. Oleh sebab itu, kebijakan Whitlam ini dipertahankan selama masa pemerintahan koalisi Liberal Malcolm Fraser ( ) dan juga 4

16 oleh pemerintahan Bob Hawke dari Partai Buruh ( ) (Coldrey 1986 dalam Hamid 1999: 423; Chega, 2005). Dari pemaparan di atas penulis melihat bahwa hubungan Australia- Indonesia selalu mengalami pasang surut. Kebijakan masing-masing negara kerap berubah seiring dengan perubahan pemerintahan di kedua negara. Selain itu penulis juga melihat bahwa pergantian pemerintahan di Australia, dari Partai Buruh ke Partai koalisi Liberal memiliki pengaruh yang cukup berarti bagi hubungan bilateral Australia-Indonesia. Naiknya Paul Keating dari Partai Buruh pada 1991 menggantikan Bob Hawke telah memberikan pengaruh yang sangat berarti bagi hubungan bilateral Australia-Indonesia. Hubungan Australia-Indonesia pada masa pemerintahan Keating mengalami peningkatan dan merupakan puncak hubungan Australia dengan Indonesia. Bahkan, Keating menganggap Indonesia merupakan negara tetangga terpenting dan special bagi Australia (Wuryandari 1996; Bhakti 2001). Namun, puncak keharmonisan hubungan kedua negara kian menurun setelah Paul Keating tidak lagi menjabat sebagai perdana menteri. Pada tahun 1996, John Howard resmi menggantikkan Paul Keating setelah partainya memenangkan pemilu. Pada masa pemerintahan Howard, hubungan Australia-Indonesia mengalami dinamika yang cukup panjang. Berbagai masalah yang terjadi seperti kasus Timor Timur dan pemberian visa bagi warga Papua, dan perubahan penekanan dalam hubungan luar negeri Australia pada masa Howard membuat ketegangan antara Australia-Indonesia (Bhakti 2001; Thayeb 2008). 5

17 Kemenangan Partai Buruh pada tahun 2007 mengantarkan Kevin Rudd menggantikkan Howard yang telah berkuasa selama sebelas tahun. Pergantian kepemimpinan dari Partai koalisi Liberal dengan Perdana Menteri John Howard ( ) kepada Partai Buruh di bawah pimpinan Kevin Rudd ( ) membuat penulis tertarik untuk mengetahui lebih dalam tentang kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia di bawah kepemimpinan John Howard dan Kevin Rudd serta pengaruh gaya kepemimpinan perdana menteri dari dua partai besar yang berbeda. Skripsi ini membahas tentang bagaimana kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia di bawah pemerintahan Howard dari Partai Liberal dan pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh. Di dalam skripsi ini penulis memfokuskan analisa terhadap pengaruh gaya kepemimpinan perdana menteri dari dua partai besar yang berbeda di Australia, yakni Partai Buruh dan Partai koalisi Liberal dalam menentukan dan melaksanakan kebijakan luar negerinya terhadap Indonesia tanpa mengenyampingkan pengaruh faktor-faktor lainnya. B. Pertanyaan Penelitian Di dalam skripsi ini penulis mencantumkan beberapa pertanyaan pokok yang akan menjadi acuan dalam analisi skripsi ini. Adapun pertanyaan pertanyaan tersebut adalah sebagai berikut: 1. Bagaimana kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia periode John Howard dari Partai koalisi Liberal dan Kevin Rudd Partai Buruh? 6

18 2. Apa perbedaan kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia pada masa John Howard dan Kevin Rudd? 3. Bagaimana gaya kepemimpinan John Howard dari Partai koalisi Liberal dan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia? C. Kerangka Pemikiran Di dalam meneliti sebuah masalah diperlukan adanya kerangka pemikiran, untuk memudahkan penulis dalam mengambarkan dan menganalisa permasalahan yang di bahas. Berikut konsep-konsep yang menjadi kerangka berpikir penulis: C.1 Konsep Kebijakan Luar Negeri Semua negara di dunia, termasuk Australia memiliki politik luar negeri untuk menunjang kepentingannya dan juga untuk mempertahankan integritas bangsa di dunia internasional (Bhakti 2008). Hudson (1988 dalam Mediansky dan Palfreeman 1990) yang dikutip oleh Bhakti (2001: 21) mengatakan bahwa secara sederhana politik luar negeri merupakan segala bentuk kebijakan suatu negara terhadap lingkungan luarnya yang menjadi subyek dari kepentingan dan aktifitas resmi negara itu. Menurut Rosenau (1976: 27-32) kebijakan luar negeri merupakan keseluruhan sikap dan aktivitas suatu negara dalam upayanya mengatasi dan memperoleh keuntungan dari lingkungan eksternalnya yang bertujuan untuk mempertahankan kelangsungan hidup suatu negara. Menambahkan Rosenau, 7

19 Bhakti (2001: 22) mengatakan bahwa tujuan yang dimaksud tersebut meliputi baik tujuan politik, keamanan dan ekonomi, sesuai dengan kepentingan nasionalnya yang telah ditentukan oleh penentu kebijakan luar negeri sebagai hasil dari proses politik. Pernyataan di atas sejalan dengan pendapat Malhotra (2004: ) bahwa kebijakan luar negeri memiliki beberapa unsur yang berkaitan dan saling mempengaruhi yakni, pertahanan, diplomasi dan ekonomi. Selanjutnya, ia mengatakan bahwa kebijakan luar negeri dibuat atas nama negara, akan tetapi pemerintahlah yang benar-benar merumuskan dan melaksanakannya. Pemerintah tersebut merupakan perpaduan dari berbagai organisasi dan individu yang memiliki kepentingan yang tidak sama. Kebijakan luar negeri yang memiliki beberapa unsur penting yang saling berkaitan dan dirumuskan oleh pemerintahan suatu negara ini tidak pernah diselenggarakan dalam kevakuman, tetapi selalu dikondisikan dengan lingkungannya baik domestik dan eksternal. Lingkungan domestik tersebut terdiri dari partai politik, kelompok penekan, organisasi birokrasi yang saling bersaing, media massa, opini publik, budaya politik dan lain-lain. Sedangkan, lingkungan eksternalnya adalah aktor-aktor sub sistemik dari negara-negara tetangga dan juga kawasan, negara super power, organisasi internasional dan organisasi regional (Malhotra 2004: 186). Sedangkan Bhakti (2001: 22) berpendapat bahwa faktor internal yang mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia tersebut antara lain ialah faktor sejarah dan demografis, geografis, kepentingan nasional, cara pandang aktor 8

20 politik (pemberi pengaruh, pembuat dan penentu kebijakan) terhadap sistem internasional, serta kepentingan dan peran yang diinginkan oleh negara tersebut di dalam sistem internasional. Sedangkan faktor-faktor eksternal yang mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negri tersebut adalah perubahan konstelasi politik, ekonomi dan keamanan internasional. Malhotra (2004: ) mengatakan bahwa kebijakan luar negeri dibuat oleh beberapa orang dari pemerintahan suatu negara, yakni seorang kepala pemerintahan (eksekutif) dan juga menteri luar negeri, penasehat serta bawahanbawahannya. Namun, dalam prakteknya kebijakan luar negeri sebagian besar diaminkan oleh eksekutif. Senada dengan Malhotra, Smith (1992: 22) menulis bahwa eksekutif atau Perdana Menteri Australia memiliki hak prerogatif dan merupakan aktor utama yang memainkan kebijakan luar negeri Australia. Secara konstitusional kepala negara adalah Gubernur Jendral sebagai wakil dari Ratu Inggris, namun dalam prakteknya istilah kekuatan eksekutif pemerintah mengacu pada Perdana Menteri dan menteri-menteri lainnya. Lebih jauh lagi, Smith (1992: 23) menjelaskan bahwa Perdana Menteri Australia merupakan aktor utama dalam pembuatan kebijakan luar negeri, sebagai tokoh yang dominan ketika timbulnya konflik antara menteri-menteri. Namun demikian, bentuk dan gaya kepemimpinan (leadership) pada tiap perdana menteri yang memimpin berbeda-beda. Menambahkan pendapat Smith di atas, Chauvel (1992: 9) menilai bahwa Perdana Menteri biasanya adalah orang yang paling berpengaruh dan memiliki kekuasaan yang lebih di antara anggota-anggota kabinet. Seorang Perdana 9

21 Menteri dapat mengajukan inisiatif dalam kebijakan ekonomi ataupun mengeluarkan pernyataan tentang kebijakan luar negeri. Namun, perlu diketahui bahwa perdana menteri Australia bukanlah seorang Presiden yang terpilih dengan hak mereka sendiri. Perdana Menteri (dan para pemimpin partai oposisi atau prime minister shadow) adalah para pemimpin partai yang dipilih oleh anggotaanggota parlemen dari partainya. Oleh sebab itu, mereka juga dapat digantikan dengan orang lain seperti pada kasus Kevin Rudd di tahun 2010 yang lalu. Hal ini menunjukkan bahwa masih ada unsur ketergantungan di sini antara Perdana Menteri dengan partai politik yang mengusungnya. Senada dengan pernyataan tersebut Hamid (1999: 391) mengatakan bahwa dalam melihat politik luar negeri Australia harus juga dipertimbangkan gaya kepemimpinan di antara partai-partai besar yang berkuasa, yakni Partai Buruh dan Partai Koalisi Liberal-Nasional. Menurut Bhakti (2008: 20) ada dua pandangan di kalangan pengamat internasional di Australia mengenai sistem internasional, yakni pertama, mereka yang memandang bahwa dunia ini penuh dengan konflik dan anarkis untuk mencapai tujuan nasional suatu negara. Sedangkan pada pandangan kedua, dunia diibaratkan sebagai global village (desa dunia) di mana anggotanya melakukan kerjasama demi mencapai tujuan bersama yakni keamanan, kemakmuran dan kemajuan bersama. Terkait dengan penjelasan itu, Bhakti (2008) menilai bahwa terdapat perbedaan nuansa politik antara pemerintahan Partai koalis Liberal Australia dan Pemerintahan Partai Buruh Australia. Pemerintah Liberal biasanya lebih memilih kedekatan sosio-kultural atau sejarah, yakni kedekatannya dengan Inggris dan Amerika Serikat serta memandang dunia anarkis. Sebaliknya, 10

22 pemerintahan Partai Buruh lebih memilih kedekatan geografis, yakni mencari keamanan di dalam Asia dan mengutamakan kerjasama untuk mencapai kemajuan bersama. Dari penjelasan dari berbagai peneliti di atas, dapat dikatakan bahwa kebijakan luar negeri memiliki unsur politik, pertahanan dan ekonomi yang bertujuan untuk melindungi kepentingan nasional negara tersebut dan dipengaruhi oleh faktor internal dan faktor eksternal serta gaya kepemimpinan dari kepala pemerintahan (eksekutif) dalam merumuskan serta melaksanakan kebijakan luar negeri negara tersebut. Untuk kepentingan analisa pada Bab IV skripsi ini, yakni mengenai pengaruh gaya kepemimpinan dari John Howard dari Partai koalisi Liberal dan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh penulis menggunakan model adaptif kebijakan luar negeri milik Rosenau. Rosenau menilai bahwa pada hakekatnya kebijakan luar negeri merupakan suatu mekanisme untuk suatu negara beradaptasi terhadap perubahan-perubahan di lingkungannya baik internal maupun eksternal yang didasarkan kepada persepsi para pembuat keputusan mengenai kondisi lingkungan tersebut dalam upayanya untuk bertahan hidup dan mencapai tujuan nasionalnya (lihat Rosenau 1974: 47 dan Rosenau 1981: 42-50). Pada dasarnya, model adaptif tersebut sejalan dengan pemaparan dari berbagai peneliti di atas yang telah penulis jelaskan bahwa kebijakan luar negeri merupakan konsekuensi dari perubahan yang terjadi di lingkungan eksternal, lingkungan internal dan juga kepemimpinan (leadership). 11

23 Bagian selanjutnya memaparkan tentang konsep kepentingan nasional. Seperti yang sudah dijelaskan bahwa kebijakan luar negeri suatu negara termasuk Australia bertujuan untuk melindungi serta meningkatkan kepentingan nasionalnya. Oleh sebab itu, konsep kebijakan luar negeri melekat dan saling berkaitan dengan konsep kepentingan nasional. C.2 Konsep Kepentingan Nasional Evans (1991: 33) mengatakan bahwa kepentingan nasional merupakan starting point atau titik awal dari kebijakan luar negeri. Senada dengan Evans, Frankel (1979) dalam Malhotra (2004: 79) memandang bahwa kepentingan nasional adalah konsep yang paling penting dalam hubungan internasional dan merupakan kunci dalam kebijakan luar negeri karena kepentingan nasional adalah materi dasar bagi para pembuat kebijakan luar negeri. Di dalam merumuskan kebijakan luar negeri tersebut, para pembuat kebijakan dipandu oleh perspektif kepentingan nasional mereka yang bertujuan untuk mencapai dan melindungi kepentingan nasional tersebut. Untuk kepentingan analisa, penulis kembali mengutip pendapat Evans tentang kepentingan nasional Australia. Menurut Evans (1991: 33) kepentingan nasional Australia mencakup tiga kategori besar, yaitu: pertama, dari segi kepentingan geopolitik dan strategis ialah the defence of Australian sovereignty and political independence (mempertahankan kedaulatan dan kemerdekaan politik Australia) salah satu tujuannya adalah untuk mengamankan Australia dari imigran gelap yang dapat mengancam kedaulatan dan integritas wilayahnya; 12

24 kedua, dari sisi ekonomi, ialah in trying to secure a free and liberal international trading regime (berupaya melindungi perdagangan bebas internasional) hal ini bertujuan untuk meningkatkan perekonomian dan kesejahteraan bangsa; ketiga, being seen to be a good international citizen (menjadi warga internasional yang baik), yakni ikut serta mengatasi isu-isu global, penjaga perdamaian, kontrol senjata, penegakan HAM dan lain-lain. D. Metode Penelitian Penelitian ini merupakan penelitian kualitatif yang bertujuan untuk memaparkan tentang kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia pada pemerintahan John Howard dari Partai Koalisi Liberal ( ) dan pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh ( ). Menurut Cresswell (1998) pendekatan kualitatif adalah suatu proses penelitian dan pemahaman yang berdasarkan pada fenomena sosial dan masalah manusia. Untuk menjawab pertanyaan penelitian skripsi ini, penulis mengandalkan data-data primer dan sekunder sebagai acuan, yakni data-data yang didapat dalam bentuk yang sudah jadi berupa publikasi dan sudah dikumpulkan oleh pihak atau instansi lain. Data ini diperoleh melalui studi kepustakaan untuk dapat lebih memahami kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia pada masa pemerintahan John Howard dari Partai koalisi Liberal dan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh. Sumber-sumber data tersebut dapat berupa buku, jurnal, interview dari sumber yang berkepentingan yakni peneliti dari Lembaga Ilmu Pengetahuan 13

25 Indonesia (LIPI), Prof. Ikrar Nusa Bhakti, kemudian juga dari internat, surat kabar dan penerbit-penerbit lainnya. E. Sistematika Penulisan BAB I PENDAHULUAN A. Latar Belakang Masalah B. Pertanyaan Penelitian C. Tujuan Penelitian D. Kerangka Pemikiran D.1 Kebijakan Luar Negeri D.2 Kepentingan Nasional E. Metode Penelitian F. Sistematika Penulisan BAB II FAKTOR-FAKTOR YANG MEMPENGARUHI KEBIJAKAN LUAR NEGERI AUSTRALIA A. Faktor Internal A.1 Faktor Sejarah dan Demografis A.2 Faktor Geografis A.3 Kepentingan Nasional A.4 Pembuatan Kebijakan Luar Negeri A.5 Kebijakan Pertahanan Australia 14

26 B. Faktor Eksternal B.1 Perkembangan Konstelasi Politik, Ekonomi, dan Keamanan Regional dan Internasional BAB III KEBIJAKAN LUAR NEGERI AUSTRALIA TERHADAP INDONESIA: JOHN HOWARD DARI PARTAI KOALISI LIBERAL dan PEMERINTAHAN KEVIN RUDD DARI PARTAI BURUH A. Kebijakan Luar negeri Australia Terhadap Indonesia di Bawah Pemerintahan John Howard dari Partai Liberal B. Kebijakan Luar Negeri Australia Terhadap Indonesia di Bawah Pemerintahan kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh BAB IV ANALISA GAYA KEPEMIMPINAN JOHN HOWARD DARI PARTAI KOALISI LIBERAL DAN KEVIN RUDD DARI PARTAI BURUH DALAM KEBIJAKAN LUAR NEGERI AUSTRALIA TERHADAP INDONESIA BAB V PENUTUP A. Kesimpulan DAFTAR PUSTAKA LAMPIRAN 15

27 BAB II FAKTOR-FAKTOR YANG MEMPENGARUHI KEBIJAKAN LUAR NEGERI AUSTRALIA Bab ini membahas tentang faktor-faktor yang mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia. Faktor-faktor yang mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia sangat ditentukan oleh berbagai faktor internal dan juga eksternal. Oleh karena itu, pembahasan ini dibagi menjadi dua sub bab, yakni: pertama, faktorfaktor internal yang mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia; kedua, faktorfaktor eksternal yang mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia. Pembahasan mengenai faktor-faktor ini penting karena dari faktor-faktor tersebut dapat dilihat perbedaan pendekatan dalam melakukan kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia pada Pemerintahan Buruh dan Pemerintahan koalisi Liberal-Nasional. Terkait dengan penjelasan penulis pada Bab I bahwa kebijakan luar negeri suatu negara, tidak terkecuali Australia tidak pernah diselenggarakan dalam kevakuman. Namun, selalu dikondisikan dan dipengaruhi oleh faktor-faktor internal dan eksternal negara tersebut (Malhotra 2004: ). Di dalam menjelaskan faktor internal dan eksternal tersebut penulis mengutip hasil pemikiran dari Ikrar Nusa Bhakti yang tercantum di dalam laporan penelitian LIPI tahun Menurut Bhakti (2001: 22-39) secara umum, faktor-faktor internal tersebut ialah faktor sejarah dan demografis, geografis, kepentingan nasional, sistem politik, cara pandang aktor-aktor politik (pemberi pengaruh, pembuat dan 16

28 penentu kebijakan) terhadap sistem internasional, serta kepentingan dan peran yang diinginkan oleh negara tersebut di dalam sistem internasional. Sedangkan, faktor-faktor eksternalnya antara lain ialah lingkungan regional dan internasional, dalam hal ini perkembangan konstelasi politik, ekonomi dan keamanan internasional, serta kebijakan negara atau sekelompok negara lain terhadap negara tersebut. A. Faktor-faktor Internal Yang Mempengaruhi Kebijakan Luar Negeri Australia Pemaparan mengenai faktor-faktor internal dalam pembentukan kebijakan luar negeri Australia di bawah ini didasarkan pada pendapat Bhakti (2001: 22-39), yaitu: A.1 Faktor Sejarah dan Demografis Jika dilihat dari faktor sejarah dan demografis Australia, kebijakan luar negeri Australia sangat dipengaruhi oleh dua negara, yakni Inggris dan Amerika Serikat. Pada tahun 1787, Australia ditemukan dan diklaim sebagai bagian dari Inggris oleh Kapten James Cook utusan pertama Pemerintah Inggris. Setelah Amerika merdeka, Inggris mulai mengalami kesulitan untuk mengirim para narapidananya. Oleh karena itu, pada 26 Januari 1788, setahun setelah Australia ditemukan, Inggris mengirimkan koloni pertamanya yang terdiri dari para narapinadanya ke Australia dan sejak tahun 1788 itulah Australia resmi berfungsi sebagai tempat dikirimkannya narapidana Inggris (Bhakti 2001: 24). Melengkapi pendapat dari Bhakti, Hamid (1999: 390) mengatakan bahwa fungsi Australia 17

29 sebagai tempat penampungan para narapidana Inggris berakhir sejak tahun Perkembangan yang terjadi di Australia sebagai daerah peternakan membuat Australia tidak lagi hanya dihuni oleh para narapidana namun, juga ditempati oleh para imigran Inggris yang lebih bervariasi seperti para petani, peternak, dan lainlain. Dengan semakin berkembangnya Australia baik dari segi masyarakat, perekonomian dan politik. Pemerintah Inggris menyetujui pembentukan pemerintah koloni Australia, yang berproses secara bertahap sampai akhirnya pada pembentukan negara federal Australia pada 1 Januari Walaupun, Australia telah menjadi negara federal, menurut Bhakti (2001: 24) Australia tetap merupakan bagian dari Inggris yang kebijakan luar negerinya dirumuskan serta diimplementasikan di Inggris. Barulah pada tahun 1935 Federasi Australia membentuk kantor kecil urusan luar negeri dan setelah tahun 1940 Australia membuka kedutaan besar di luar negeri (lihat juga Evans 1991: 19; Siboro 1996: 178; Firth 2005: 5). Menurut Siboro (1996: 152) imigran asal Inggris sangat dominan di Australia. Aspek yang paling bermakna dari imigran asal Inggris tersebut adalah memelihara nilai-nilai dari negara asalnya. Senada dengan pernyataan tersebut Evans (1991: 20) dan Hamid (1999: ) menilai bahwa faktor kesejarahan Australia yang mengidentikan diri dengan Inggris ini menguasai pemikiranpemikiran dari masyarakat Australia. Hal ini tidak terlepas dari sikap awal Inggris kepada Australia, yakni menjamin keamanan Australia; melakukan perdagangan luar negeri dengan Australia; hubungan luar negeri Australia selama lebih dari dua puluh tahun sejak terbentuk federasi dilakukan oleh Inggris; sistem 18

30 pendidikan Inggris yang juga sebagai model sistem pendidikan Australia; serta kebudayaan Inggris yang mengakar di masyarakat Australia, sehingga membentuk identitas ke-inggris-an yang tidak dapat dihilangkan. Namun, sebelum terjadinya Perang Dunia II, Australia mulai menyadari bahwa Inggris tidak lagi mampu melindungi Australia. Bagi Australia saat itu Inggris lebih mementingkan keamanan wilayahnya. Keyakinan Australia semakin kuat ketika pada 15 Februari 1942, Jepang berhasil menyerang Singapura yang menyebabkan Australia menurunkan pasukan untuk ikut berperang. Pada saat yang sama Australia mulai mengalihkan perlindungannya dari Inggris kepada Amerika Serikat (Firth 2005: 30). Senada dengan pendapat Firth, Bhakti dan Alami (2005: 30) mengatakan bahwa sekitar tahun 1788 sampai dengan 1941 kekuatan besar pelindung Australia adalah Inggris. Perang Dunia II mengharuskan Inggris untuk lebih mempertahankan keamanan wilayahnya di Eropa dari pada melindungi daerahdaerah jajahannya di Asia Tenggara. Serangan Jepang ke Asia Tenggara merupakan ancaman langsung bagi Australia, namun dengan bantuan Angkatan Laut serta Angkatan Udara AS, wilayah Australia bisa terhindar dari serbuan Jepang. Atas dasar alasan tersebut Australia berpaling dari Inggris ke Amerika Serikat. Akibatnya, Australia harus mengikuti kebijakan luar negeri AS untuk tetap mendapatkan jaminan keamanan dari AS, sebagai contoh ketika masa Perang Dingin fokus perhatian AS adalah mencegah perluasan komunisme di Asia Pasifik yang berdampak terhadap kebijakan Australia untuk mengembangkan Forward Defence Strategy yang diwujudkan salah satunya melalui 19

31 keikutsertaan Australia dalam politik pembendungan komunisme AS (containment policy) di Asia Pasifik seperti dalam Perang Korea dan Perang Vietnam. Penyerangan yang dilakukan Jepang pada saat Perang Dunia II, selain membuat Australia berpaling dari kekuatan Inggris juga memaksa Australia untuk lebih mandiri dalam hal keamanan dan kebijakan luar negerinya, terutama jika Pemerintahan Buruh berkuasa. Namun, pada kenyataannya pengaruh AS tidak dapat dihilangkan begitu saja. Seperti pada kasus pemerintahan Whitlam yang menginginkan Australia mandiri dan lepas dari pengaruh AS bahkan terkesan anti AS, hal ini menyebabkan Perdana Menteri Whitlam dari Partai Buruh dipecat pada tahun 1975 dan digantikan oleh Fraser dari Partai koalisi Liberal. Sejak saat itulah penerus-penerus Whitlam dari Partai Buruh seperti Hawke lebih berhatihati dengan AS dan tetap membiarkan pengaruh AS ada dalam kebijakan luar negeri Australia (Bhakti 2001 dan Firth 2005). Pengaruh kebijakan AS terhadap Australia juga terlihat dari perubahan sikap Australia dari menentang integrasi Papua ke Indonesia pada tahun 1950an sampai dengan pertengahan 1960an yang kemudian berubah mendukug Papua ke Indonesia. Hal ini terkait dengan kebijakan AS dan Inggris yang memilih untuk mendukung Indonesia karena alasan takut Indonesia jatuh ke pengaruh komunis. Tidak hanya itu pengaruh kebijakan luar negeri Australia atas Timor Timur pada tahun juga sangat dipengaruhi kebijakan AS terhadap Timor Timur. Pengaruh AS terhadap kebijakan luar negeri Australia juga sangat terlihat pada pemerintahan Howard dari Partai Liberal di mana Howard mengklaim bahwa 20

32 Australia merupakan deputi serif AS di kawasan Asia Pasifik (lihat Crithley 1995: 66; Siboro 1996: 179; Bhakti, Wuryandari dan Muna 1997: 22; Wuryandari 2001: 62; Bhakti 2001: 25; Tawes 2005: dalam situs resmi Parliment of Australia). Kebijakan luar negeri Australia pada masa pemerintahan Howard yang sangat bergantung dan dipengaruhi oleh AS tidak terlepas dari adanya berbagai masalah baik di kawasan regional maupun internasional seperti, krisis ekonomi yang terjadi di negara-negara ASEAN pada tahun 1997 yang menyebabkan perekonomian beberapa negara di Asia termasuk Indonesia mengalami keterpurukan, kasus terorisme yang melanda AS pada tahun 2001 yang ikut merubah agenda politik luar negeri AS menjadi perang melawan terorisme, kasus peledakan Bom di Bali tahun 2002 yang banyak menewaskan warga Australia, kasus peledakan Bom di depan Kedutaan Besar Australia di Indonesia pada tahun 2004 serta berbagai masalah lainnya, yang mengakibatkan Australia di bawah pemerintahan Howard semakin berlindung di bawah payung keamanan AS (Chauvel 2004 dalam Mar iyah 2005). Dari penjelasan yang penulis paparkan di atas, terlihat bahwa sejarah dan juga demografis dari negara Australia menjadi salah satu faktor yang memang sangat berpengaruh dalam kebijakan luar negeri Australia. Kedekatan bilateral antara Australia dan Inggris maupun Australia dengan AS menjadi pertimbangan Australia dalam melaksanakan kebijakan luar negerinya terutama jika pemerintahan koalisi Liberal berkuasa. 21

33 A.2 Faktor Geografis Selain faktor sejarah yang telah penulis jelaskan, faktor lain yang penting dalam kebijakan-kebijakan luar negeri Australia ialah faktor geografis. Hamid (1999: ) menjelaskan bahwa secara geografis Australia menempati lokasi yang strategis di kawasan Asia Tenggara dan Pasifik Selatan, serta dikelilingi oleh dua samudera besar, yakni Samudera Hindia dan Samudera Pasifik. Bagian Barat Australia diapit oleh Samudera Hindia yang merupakan jalur transportasi yang menghubungkan Australia dengan benua Afrika, anak benua India dan kawasan Asia Tenggara; sementara di bagian Timur Australia dikelilingi oleh Samudera Pasifik yang menghubungkan dengan bagian utara dan selatan benua Amerika. Pada bagian utara Australia dipagari oleh pulau-pulau Pasifik Selatan, dengan Indonesia dan Papua New Guinea sebagai penyangga utamanya. Oleh karena itu, kepentingan Australia terhadap pulau-pulau di utaranya bermakna strategis dalam sistem pertahanan Australia, yakni sebagai benteng pertahanan dan invasi musuh dan juga merupakan titik kelemahan utamanya. Hal ini pula yang menyebabkan Indonesia memiliki posisi strategis dan penting bagi Australia (Hamid 1999: ). Pentingnya faktor geografis dalam kebijakan-kebijakan luar negeri Australia pertama kali diakui oleh Menteri Luar Negeri Percy Spender pada tahun 1950 ketika menentang integrasi Papua ke Indonesia karena penentangan itu dikhawatirkan akan mengancam keamanan Australia (Spender 1950: 12 dalam Crithley 1995: 80; Adil 1993: 6 dalam Hamid 1999: 387). 22

34 Sedangkan Bhakti (2001: 26) menjelaskan bahwa kedekatan geografis dengan negara-negara Asia di mana negara-negara tersebut memiliki perbedaan dalam banyak segi ditambah lagi dengan letak Australia yang terlalu jauh dengan AS dan Inggris membuat Australia sampai dengan pertengahan 1983, memandang bahwa kedekatannya dengan Asia bukan sebuah hikmah, melainkan sebuah hal yang menakutkan. Hal ini juga terkait dengan ancaman langsung yang dirasakan Australia ketika Jepang menyerang Asia Tenggara dan Pasifik Selatan pada Perang Dunia II yang membuat Australia semakin bergantung terhadap kekuatan dari negara besar, yakni AS untuk menjamin keamanannya. Ketakutan Australia terhadap bangsa Asia semakin terlihat ketika Partai Komunis Cina berhasil mengahalau Partai Nasionalis Cina dari daratan Cina ke Taiwan, akibatnya muncul persepsi Australia akan bahaya merah atau Red Peril. Ketakutan Australia pada bangsa-bangsa Asia ini menimbulkan kebijakan keamanannya yang Mencari Keamanan dari Asia. Masuknya Inggris ke dalam Masyarakat Ekonomi Eropa (sekarang Uni Eropa) pada tahun 1972, menyebabkan ekspor Australia ke Inggris menjadi berkurang (Hamid 1999: 387). Pada saat yang sama, Australia mulai menyadari bahwa masa depan ekonominya sangat tergantung pada negara-negara Asia, khususnya Jepang dan Cina. Munculnya macan-macan Asia di bidang ekonomi serta adanya pandangan bahwa abad dua puluh satu merupakan abad Asia, pada akhirnya bukan saja membuat Australia sadar akan masa depan ekonominya, namun juga membuat Australia pada tahun 1983, mengubah kebijakan keamanannya dari Mencari Keamanan dari Asia menjadi Mencari Keamanan 23

35 dalam Asia. Perubahan kebijakan ini dilakukan oleh Pemerintahan Bob Hawke dari Partai Buruh dan terus bertahan hingga saat ini (Bhakti 2001: 26; Bhakti 2006: 12). Sedangkan Firth (2005: 45) menilai bahwa perubahan pandangan Australia ini sebenarnya sudah dimulai sejak Pemerintahan Whitlam dari Partai Buruh, karena pada masa pemerintahan Whitlam ini Australia mulai terbuka terhadap imigran dari kawasan Asia karena kebijakan ini perasaan takut dari masyarakat Australia terhadap negara-negara Asia semakin berkurang. Kebijakan Whitlam ini kemudian diteruskan oleh para penggantinya seperti, Fraser, Hawke dan juga Paul Keating. Adanya perubahan kebijakan terhadap Asia yang telah dilakukan Australia di bawah pemerintahan Hawke dari Partai Buruh berdampak terhadap semakin membaiknya hubungan Australia dengan Indonesia pada saat itu. Hal tersebut juga dikatakan oleh Ryan (1995) bahwa hubungan Australia-Indonesia terjalin lebih erat lagi terutama pada masa Pemerintahan Paul Keating. Bahkan, secara tegas Paul Keating mengatakan dalam acara Australian Today Indonesia 94 Promotion di Sydney pada 16 Maret 1994, seperti yang dikutip oleh Ryan (1995: 201): No other country is more important to australia than Indonesia. If we fail to get this relationship right, and nurture and develope it, the whole web of our foreign relation is incomplete. (Tidak ada negara yang lebih penting bagi Australia, kecuali Indonesia. Jika kita tidak berhasil menjalin hubungan baik, memelihara dan membangun hubungan tersebut, maka keseluruhan jaringan dalam hubungan luar negeri Australia tidak lengkap). 24

36 Konsepsi Paul Keating yang tertuang dalam pernyataan di atas merupakan perwujudan bahwa jika Australia ingin membangun hubungan yang lebih baik dengan negara-negara Asia, khususnya Jepang, Cina dan Korea Selatan, maka Australia harus mampu membangun hubungan yang baik dengan negara tetangga Asia terdekatnya, yakni Indonesia (Bhakti 2001: 26; Keating 1994 dalam Bhakti 2006: 12). Pembahasan di atas mengenai pentingnya pengaruh faktor geografis dalam kebijakan luar negeri Australia menggambarkan bahwa saat ini Australia tidak lagi hanya melihat dan tergantung dengan AS dan Inggris, tapi juga bergantung terhadap negara-negara Asia termasuk Indonesia. Hal ini juga berpengaruh terhadap hubungan Australia dengan negara-negara Asia khususnya Indonesia. Kedua faktor yang telah penulis jelaskan, yakni faktor sejarah dan demografis serta faktor goegrafis merupakan faktor yang selalu dipertimbangkan dalam merumuskan dan melaksanakan kebijakan luar negeri Australia. Seperti yang dikatakan Hamid (1999: 391) bahwa faktor geografi dan sejarah merupakan faktor tetap yang dipertimbangkan oleh para pemimpin Australia. Namun, masih ada beberapa faktor lainnya yang juga berpengaruh dalam kebijakan luar negeri Australia dan penting untuk diketahui lebih lanjut. Penjelasan menganai faktorfaktor lainnya penulis bahas pada sub bab-sub bab selanjutnya. 25

37 A.3 Kepentingan Nasional Faktor tetap lain yang menjadi pertimbangan dan memiliki pengaruh penting bagi kebijakan luar negeri Australia selain faktor sejarah dan geografis menurut Bhakti (2008) ialah kepentingan nasional. Hal ini juga terkait dengan penjelasan penulis pada bab sebelumnya bahwa kepentingan nasional merupakan starting point atau titik awal dari kebijakan luar negeri (Evans 1991: 33). Senada dengan Evans, Frankel mengatakan bahwa kepentingan nasional adalah kunci kebijakan luar negeri. Oleh sebab itu, kepentingan nasional suatu negara merupakan pedoman bagi para pembuat kebijakan yang bertujuan untuk melindungi kepentingan nasional itu sendiri (Frankel 1979 dalam Burchill 2005: 3). Menguatkan pernyataan dari Evans dan Frankel sebelumnya, Bhakti (2001: 31) berpendapat bahwa tujuan yang ingin dicapai oleh suatu negara dari kebijakan luar negerinya adalah kepentingan nasional negara tersebut. Selanjutnya, Bhakti (2001: 31) berargumen bahwa politik luar negeri Australia bukan hanya perwujudan dari kepentingan domestik Australia yang harus dicapai dalam hubungan internasionalnya, namun juga bagaimana membuat Australia menjadi warga negara internasional yang baik. Bhakti memandang bahwa politik luar negeri Australia memiliki political objectives, security objectives, dan economic objectives. Political objectives dari kebijakan luar negeri Australia terdiri dari empat hal pokok, yakni: pertama, Australia yang lebih aman, baik dari fisik atau wilayah, ekonomi, budaya, dan politik dalam hal ini termasuk ideologi serta national ethos; kedua, lingkungan internasional yang lebih aman; ketiga, dunia 26

38 yang lebih sejahtera; keempat, dunia yang lebih baik. Dari empat hal pokok tersebut dapat ditarik kesimpulan bahwa political objectives dari kebijakan luar negeri Australia memiliki makna politik, strategis dan ekonomi (Bhakti 2001: 31; Palfreeman 1988 dalam Bhakti 2008: 20). Kemudian, dari sisi security objectives, kebijakan luar negeri Australia bermakna untuk menjaga keamanan Australia baik secara individual (Selfreliance), dalam kerangka aliansi militer di bawah payung AS seperti SEATO (South East Asia Treaty Organization) tahun 1954 dan ANZUS (Australia, New Zealand and The United State) tahun 1951, serta di bawah payung Inggris (Five Power Defence Arrangement-FPDA) tahun Bukan hanya dengan AS dan Inggris, Australia juga ikut dalam kerangka kerjasama regional, yakni membangun jaring-jaring kerjasama keamanan dengan negara-negara ASEAN dan Pasifik Selatan, di antaranya melakukan Persetujuan Keamanan Antara Republik Indonesia-Australia (Agreement on Maintaining Security--AMS) pada tahun 1995, dan juga menandatangani Perjanjian Kerjasama Keamanan antara Republik Indonesia dan Australia (Framework Agreement on Security Cooperation Between The Republic Indonesia and Australia) pada tahun 2006 (Bhakti, Wuryandari dan Muna 1997: 61; Bhakti 2001: 31; Bhakti 2006: 5). Selain kedua tujuan yang telah penulis ungkapkan sebelumnya, kebijakan luar negeri Australia juga mempunyai economic objectives. Artinya, Australia harus mampu mengaitkan antara kebijakan luar negeri dengan perdagangan komoditi Australia, bagaimana Australia mampu memainkan perannya dalam diplomasi ekonomi multilateral seperti di dalam GATT (General Agreements on 27

39 Tariffs and Trade) atau WTO (World Trade Organization), World Bank, IMF (International Monetery Fund) dan lain-lain; mampu membuat Australia melakukan tukar-menukar kebijakan investasi asing; dan mampu meningkatkan hubungan ekonominya dengan negara-negara ASEAN, Jepang, Cina, Korea Selatan AS, Pasifik Selatan dan lain-lain (Bhakti 2001: 32). Hal ini dilakukan karena pada dasarnya Australia memang sangat bergantung pada perdagangan luar negerinya. Oleh karena itu, Australia memiliki kepentingan mengamankan jalurjalur distribusinya (lihat Hamid 1999: 387). Dari penjelasan yang telah dipaparkan di atas, penulis menilai bahwa political objectives, security objectives dan economic objectives merupakan satu kesatuan yang tidak dapat dipisahkan dalam kebijakan luar negeri Australia. Tujuan-tujuan politik luar negeri itulah yang kemudian dijabarkan dalam apa yang disebut kepentingan nasional. Terkait dengan penjelasan penulis pada bab sebelumnya bahwa Evans (1991: 33) mengaktegorikan kepentingan nasional Australia secara luas ke dalam tiga kategori, yakni: pertama, kepentingankepentingan geopolitik dan strategis, yakni usaha untuk memepertahankan kedaulatan dan kemerdekaan politik Australia. Di dalam hal ini, memiliki dua dimensi, yakni dimensi global dan regional. Kepentingan langsung Australia adalah memastikan negara-negara di sekitarnya agar tetap dalam kondisi damai, stabil, tidak bermusuhan atau setidaknya tetap netral terhadap Australia. Di dalam Defence White Paper 1987 yang termasuk dalam wilayah ini, yakni wilayah teritori Australia dan wilayah-wilayah yang terdekat, seperti Indonesia, Papua New Guinea, New Zealand dan negara-negara lain di wilayah barat daya pasifik 28

40 serta negara-negara lain di wilayah Asia Tenggara. Kedua, kepentingan ekonomi dan perdagangan, hal ini terkait dengan upaya Australia untuk melindungi seluruh sumber kekayaan alam yang dimilikinya, dalam meningkatkan perdagangan internasional yang bertujuan meningkatkan perekonomian dan kesejahteraan bangsa. Meningkatkan nilai ekspor Australia, dan pada saat yang sama melindungi nilai dan kualitas kehidupan bangsa Australia. Ketiga, kepentingan nasional Australia adalah bagaimana Australia berusaha untuk menjadi warga internasional yang baik. Hal ini berhubungan dengan kepedulian Australia terhadap masalah-masalah regional dan internasional yang seringkali membutuhkan pendekatan-pendekatan non-militer. Oleh karena itu, Australia harus memainkan perannya di bidang ini, seperti menangani isu-isu global, pejagaan perdamaian, kontrol senjata dan lain-lain. Khusus terhadap Indonesia, menurut Bhakti (Tempo, 21 September 1996) siapapun yang berkuasa di Australia akan tetap memandang Indonesia sebagai negara yang penting bagi Australia. Karena dilihat dari segi geostrategis Indonesia merupakan tameng sekaligus bisa menjadi ancaman bagi Australia. Oleh sebab itu, Australia berkepentingan untuk menjadikan Indonesia kuat, namun tidak terlalu kuat untuk menjadi ancaman bagi Australia. Sedangkan, dari segi ekonomi, Indonesia merupakan pangsa pasar yang besar baik di bidang produk barang konsumsi ataupun jasa. Hal ini membuat Australia tetap mempertahankan forumforum tahunan tingkat menteri (Ministrial Forum) sejak tahun 1992 dan juga meningkatkan promosinya di Indonesia yang bertujuan meningkatkan investasi dan bisnisnya. 29

41 Terkait dengan penjelasan di atas, dari wawancara penulis dengan Bhakti di Jakarta, tanggal 28 Maret 2011, diketahui bahwa pada dasarnya tidak banyak perbedaan antara kepentingan nasional Australia pada saat Pemerintahan Buruh berkuasa maupun Pemerintahan koalisi Liberal. Hanya saja di dalam mencapai kepentingan nasional tersebut, meski substansinya sama, terdapat perbedaan pendekatan di dalam melakukan kebijakan luar negeri Australia antara Perdana Menteri dari Partai Buruh dengan Perdana Menteri Partai koalisi Liberal. Pemaparan di atas menggambarkan bahwa Indonesia memiliki posisi strategis bagi kepentingan nasional Australia. Seperti yang telah diuraikan di atas, bahwa pertama, dari kepentingan geopolitik dan strategis, Australia memiliki kepentingan untuk memastikan Indonesia sebagai negara tetangga terdekatnya untuk tetap dalam kondisi damai, stabil dan tidak bermusuhan atau setidaknya tetap netral terhadap Australia; kedua, dari kepentingan ekonomi, posisi Indonesia menempati posisi strategis bagi jalur perdagangan luar negeri Australia selain itu sebagai negara yang memiliki penduduk lebih dari 200 juta jiwa, Indonesia merupakan pangsa pasar kedelapan terbesar bagi Australia. Walaupun tidak sebesar Jepang, Cina dan Korea Selatan, namun perdagangan luar negeri dengan Indonesia tetap menguntungkan bagi Australia. A.4. Pembuatan Kebijakan Luar Negeri Australia Menurut Bhakti (2001: 33) politik luar negeri memiliki tingkat kerahasiaan tertentu dibandingkan masalah-masalah politik domestik. Karena sifatnya yang rahasia serta berhubungan dengan pertahanan nasional, maka 30

42 kontrol dari politik luar negeri berada di tangan eksekutif. Penjelasan dari Bhakti tersebut sejalan dengan Smith (1992: 22) bahwa di Australia peran utama dalam kebijakan luar negeri dimainkan oleh eksekutif yang memiliki hak prerogatif. Di dalam membuat kebijakan luar negeri ada beberapa hal yang harus dipertimbangkan, antara lain: sensitifitas negara-negara lain, kecanggihan diplomasi, serta mengobservasi tuntutan-tuntutan intelejen militer. Selain itu, pembuatan kebijakan luar negeri memerlukan informasi yang banyak dan juga akurat, baik di dalam negeri maupun di luar negeri. Oleh karenanya, Pemerintah melalui organisasi-organisasi birokratisnya mengumpulkan, menganalisa dan menelaah data yang datang terus menerus itu yang bertujuan untuk memberikan gambaran yang komperhensif atas semua pristiwa yang terjadi (Bhakti 2001 dan Firth 2005). Dari penjelasan tersebut dapat diketahui bahwa peran birokrasi amatlah penting. Birokrasi yang dominan dalam mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia ialah Depertemen Luar Negeri dan Perdagangan serta Departemen Pertahanan. Dalam skala yang lebih rendah, kedua departemen tersebut dapat membuat keputusan mengenai kebijakan luar negeri tanpa harus melalui proses yang panjang (lihat Bhakti 2001; Firth 2005: 77-78). Politik luar negeri juga cenderung menuntut tindakan yang cepat. Sebagai contoh ialah, krisis dalam hubungan antara Australia dan Indonesia, kebijakan Whitlam terhadap terhadap Timor Timur pada tahun , penandatanganan Kerjasama Pemeliharaan Keamanan Australia-Indonesia tahun 1995, diplomasi yang dilakukan Perdana Menteri Kevin Rudd terhadap Indonesia 31

43 terkait kasus terpidana mati Bali Nine beberapa waktu setelah menjabat sebagai Perdana Menteri. Tindakan-tindakan yang dibuat dilakukan dalam waktu yang sempit, maka tidak mungkin untuk terlebih dahulu berkonsultasi dengan kabinet, parlemen ataupun partai-partai politik (Bhakti 2001: 34; Chega 2005: 28; ). Hal lain yang penting untuk diingat dalam politik luar negeri adalah ketidak jelasan batasan antara isu politik, militer dan ekonomi karena isu-isu ini merupakan unsur dari kebijakan luar negeri yang saling berkaitan satu sama lain dan saling mempengaruhi. Oleh sebab itu, para pembuat kebijakan luar negeri harus mampu mempertimbangkan berbagai faktor domestik dan internasional baik dari segi politik, militer dan ekonomi. Hal ini terkait dengan penjelasan sebelumnya bahwa pemeran utama dari proses pembuatan kebijakan luar negeri semua negara termasuk Australia adalah eksekutif, namun institusi-institusi lain seperti partai politik, parlemen, kelompok kepentingan, publik dan media pun ikut mempengaruhi pembuat keputusan (Malhotra 2004: 186). Pertama, Eksekutif. Terkait dengan penjelasan di atas dan juga penjelasan pada Bab I bahwa kebijakan luar negeri Australia sebagian besar dimainkan oleh eksekutif. Dalam prakteknya istilah kekuatan eksekutif pemerintah mengacu pada Perdana Menteri dan menteri-mentari lainnya. Namun demikian, aktor utama yang memainkan kebijakan luar negeri adalah Perdana Menteri, di mana bentuk dan gaya setiap Perdana Menteri berbeda-beda dalam memimpin (Smith 1992: 22-23). Senada dengan pernyataan tersebut Bahkti (2001) menilai bahwa setiap kabinet di Australia memiliki Komite yang menangani masalah poltik luar negeri dan pertahanan, di mana Perdana meneteri, 32

44 Menlu, Menteri Pertahanan dan Bendahara Negara menjadi anggotanya. Namun, hal ini amat bergantung pada Perdana Menteri dalam memainkan perannya serta hubungan antara Perdana Menteri dengan Menlunya misalnya, Perdana Menteri Whitlam yang memang sangat dominan dalam menjalankan kebijakan luar negerinya karena saat ia memerintah ia sangat jarang memanggil rapat anggota Komite Luar Negeri dan Pertahanan. Kemudian, Perdana Menteri Fraser juga mendominasi kebijakan luar negeri, sedangkan Perdana Menteri Hawke cenderung kurang dominan bila dibandingkan dengan Whitlam dan Fraser. Pada masa Paul keating, kebijakan luar negeri Australia khususnya terhadap Indonesia sangat dipengaruhi oleh peran dari Keating. Begitupula pada masa pemerintahan John Howard dan Kevin Rudd dimana kedua Perdana Menteri tersebut dinilai sangat dominan dalam merumuskan dan melaksankan kebijakan luar negeri Australia (Bhakti 2001: 36; Kelly 2006; Gyngell 2008). Kedua, parlemen. Menurut Bhakti (2001: 37) dan Firth (2005: 86) meski parlemen kalah dominan dibandingkan dengan eksekutif dalam proses pembentukkan kebijakan luar negeri, namun para anggota parlemen dapat mempengaruhi pembuatan kebijakan tersebut melalui Joint Committee on Foreign Affairs and Defence. Hal ini juga bisa dilakukan secara individual, yakni jika para anggota parlemen yang memiliki keinginan di bidang luar negeri dan pertahanan juga dapat mempengaruhinya dengan bantuan para staf ahlinya serta ditunjang dengan informasi yang ada di Perpusatakaan Parlemen Australia. Ketiga, Partai Politik. Partai-partai politik di Australia merupakan lembaga yang tidak dikontrol oleh suatu perundangan apapun dan juga tidak pernah 33

45 disebut-sebut di dalam konstitusi. Oleh sebab itu, ketentuan-ketentuan dalam hal penerimaan anggota, perumusan kebijakan dan pemilihan calon-calon parlemen adalah urusan partai itu sendiri dan tidak dapat diajukan ke pengadilan seperti yang diberlakukan bagi lembaga-lembaga swasta lainnya. Walaupun demikian, partai-partai tersebut merupakan inti dari demokrasi parlementer yang mendominasi sistem politik Australia (Sawer 1987 dalam Hamid 1999: 180). Lebih jelas lagi, Hamid (1999: 182) mengatakan bahwa Australia memakai sistem dua-partai. Hal ini didasari pada Partai Liberal dan Partai Nasional (dahulu Partai Country) selalu membentuk koalisi, baik ketika memerintah maupun ketika menjadi oposisi, untuk menghadapi Partai Buruh. Selain, Partai koalisi Liberal dan Partai Buruh masih ada beberapa partai kecil lainnya yang ambil bagian dalam proses politik seperti Green Party. Namun, dalam prakteknya hanya dua Partai yang dominan dalam proses politik di Australia yakni Partai koalisi Liberal dan Partai Buruh. Oleh sebab itu, pada pembahasan mengenai pengaruh partai politik dalam kebijakan luar negeri Australia, penulis hanya membahas mengenai dua partai tersebut. Partai Buruh (Australian Labor Party) adalah partai tertua di Australia yang terbentuk pada tahun 1980-an (Moon dan Sharman 2003: 25). Periode berkuasa Partai Buruh lebih pendek dari Partai koalisi Liberal, namun partai ini berani membuat inovasi-inovasi dan perubahan-perubahan baru dalam sistem politik Australia, seperti penggabungan antara Kementrian Luar Negeri dengan Kementrian Perdagangan yang dilakukan pemerintahan Buruh pada tahun 1987 (lihat Firth 2005). Di dalam situs resmi Partai Buruh tertulis bahwa Partai Buruh 34

46 memiliki hubungan institusional yang kuat dengan gerakan buruh yang dianggap mewakili kelas buruh. Partai ini berkembang dari sebuah pemogokan massal pada 1890an. Hal ini membuat serikat kerja menyadari bahwa mereka memerlukan wakil-wakil politik di parlemen untuk memperjuangkan kepentingan mereka. Aikin, Jinks dan Warhust (1989) dalam Hamid (1999: 197) bahwa Partai Buruh dianggap sebuah partai yang berideologi sosialis demokratis yang memiliki tujuan untuk mengadakan sosialisasi terhadap sektor industri, yang juga disebutkan dalam Mukadimah dari tujuan partai, yang dirumuskan pada Konferensi Nasional tahun Hamid (1999: ) mengatakan bahwa anggota-anggota parlemen Partai Buruh harus mengikuti aturan-aturan serta kebijakan-kebijakan partai yang telah ditetapkan dalam Konferensi Nasional. Kalaupun ada kebebasan, maka hal itu adalah kebebasan menentukan prioritas kebijakan yang telah ditetapkan Konferensi Nasional. Kaukus dari Partai Buruh sangat berperan dalam pemerintahan Partai Buruh, jika Perdana Menteri tidak mendapat dukungan atau melakukan kebijakan yang tidak populer serta membahayakan partai, maka Perdana Menteri tersebut dapat diberhentikan dan diganti dengan anggota yang lain, seperti yang terjadi pada kasus Kevin Rudd tahun Senada dengan Hamid, Bhakti (2001: 37) mengatakan bahwa khusus Partai Buruh Australia, para anggota kaukus partai dapat mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia melalui platform partai yang dihasilkan dalam konferensi dua tahunan. Meskipun begitu, dalam banyak hal, contohnya dalam hubungan Australia-Indonesia, kritik negatif hasil konferensi dapat dikesampingkan ketika Partai buruh Berkuasa. 35

47 Partai koalisi Liberal-Nasional atau juga sering disebut Partai Liberal merupakan salah satu partai terbesar di Australia, yang dibentuk pada tahun 1944 untuk menentang keberadaan Partai Buruh (Liberal History dalam situs resmi Partai Liberal). Partai ini cukup lama berkuasa di Australia, bahkan Partai koalisi ini pernah memerintah selama dua puluh tiga tahun ( ) dan yang terakhir selama sebelas tahun ( ). Partai Liberal dibentuk oleh anggota-anggota parlemen yang berasal dari kelompok kapitalis kelas menengah, sebagai penentangan mereka terhadap keterwakilan gerakan buruh, yang masuk melalui Partai Buruh di dalam Parlemen Federal. Berbeda dengan Partai Buruh yang memiliki ideologi partai yang lebih jelas, Partai Liberal tidak memiliki itu. Partai Liberal memiliki dua faksi besar, yaitu faksi konservatif dan faksi liberal. dalam perkembangannya, faksi konservatif lebih mendominasi partai, sehingga Partai liberal lebih sering disebut partai konservatif. Ketidakjelasan ideologi dari Partai Koalisi Liberal ini menyebabkan anggota-anggota Partai Liberal tidak terlalu terikat pada prinsip-prinsip ideologi partai. Hal ini berdampak pada penerapan kebijakan partai, seorang anggota partai misalnya, dalam posisi apapun termasuk perdana menteri dapat bebas menafsirkan sesuai dengan kenyataan dan keadaan yang berkembang, seperti dalam Pemerintahan Partai Liberal seorang perdana menteri dapat memutuskan sendiri siapa yang akan menempati kursi kabinetnya. Hal inilah yang membedakan antara Partai Buruh dengan Partai Liberal (Hamid 1999: 232). Keempat, Kelompok Kepentingan. Kelompok kepentingan yang ada di Australia dapat mempengaruhi proses kebijakan luar negeri Australia melalui tiga 36

48 cara: pertama, melalui pernyataan media massa untuk mempengaruhi opini publik; kedua, demonstrasi; ketiga, melakukan lobi dengan para menteri atau Perdana Menteri. Sebagai contoh, terkait masalah Papua antara Australia- Indonesia menurut (Bhakti dalam wawancara, 28 Maret 2011) ada kelompokkelompok kepentingan di Australia yang menginginkan Papua merdeka, hal ini juga menjadi salah satu penyebab sulitnya menyelesaikan masalah Papua dan menjadi dilema bagi pemerintah Australia untuk bersikap terhadap Indonesia. Contoh konkritnya adalah kasus pemberian visa sementara bagi 42 warga Papua oleh pemerintah Australia pada tahun 2006 yang membuat pemerintah Indonesia menyampaikan protes karena salah satu dari pencari suaka tersebut merupakan anggota dari gerakan Papua merdeka yang merupakan incaran polisi Indonesia. Menurut Bhakti, kuatnya lobi dari kelompok kepentingan yang menginginkan Papua merdeka membuat ke 42 warga Papua ini bisa mendapat suaka politik dari pemerintah Australia. Kelima, Media Massa. Paran media massa amat dominan dalam meningkatkan opini dan menggiring publik Australia dalam berbagai hal termasuk kebijakan luar negeri (Bhakti 2001: 37-38). Dalam suatu negara yang menganut paham demokrasi liberal seperti Australia, media memiliki kedudukan independen. Mereka memiliki kewajiban untuk menyampaikan informasi seluasluasnya kepada publik, termasuk kritikan-kritikan terhadap berbagai ketimpangan yang terjadi di tengah-tengah masyarakat, kalangan pemerintahan, bahkan di negara lain termasuk Indonesia. Media Australia memang terkenal sangat kritis terhadap pemerintahan Indonesia dan juga berbagai isu terkait masalah Australia 37

49 dengan Indonesia. Kebebasan pers semacam ini sudah berlangsung di Australia sejak tahun 1824 pada saat pemerintah mengakhiri kontrolnya atas dunia pers (Profil Australia dalam situs resmi Kedutaan Besar Republik Indonesia). Menurut Bhakti (1997: 23-25) penyerangan Indonesia ke Timor Timur pada tahun 1975 yang menyebabkan kematian lima wartawan Australia merupakan salah satu alasan mengapa media massa dan radio Australia sering bersikap kritis terhadap pemerintah Indonesia mengenai kasus Timor Timur dan juga kasus-kasus lainnya seperti kasus David Jenkins pada tahun A.5 Kebijakan Pertahanan Australia Selain faktor-faktor yang telah penulis paparkan sebelumnya, faktor lain yang memiliki keterkaitan dengan kebijakan luar negeri Australia menurut Bhakti (2001) ialah kebijakan pertahanan yang juga didominasi oleh eksekutif. Lebih lengkap, Bhakti menjelaskan bahwa dalam pembuatan kebijakan pertahanan, terdapat kaukus kabinet mengenai politik luar negeri dan pertahanan yang beranggotakan Perdana Menteri, Wakil Perdana Menteri, Menteri Luar Negeri dan Perdagangan, Menteri Pertahanan, Jaksa Agung, dan Bendahara Negara (Menteri Keuangan). Tanggungjawab dalam menentukan kebijakan pertahanan Australia berada pada Departemen Pertahanan Australia yang terdiri dari kelompok sipil dan militer. Selanjutnya, sebagai negara yang sebagian besar penduduknya merupakan keturunan Eropa serta letaknya yang dekat dengan Asia, jauh dari negara asal dan pelindungnya Inggris dan AS menyebabkan Australia memiliki kepedulian yang 38

50 tinggi terhadap negara-negara tetangganya termasuk Indonesia. Sebelum tahun 1970an, doktrin strategis pertahanannya dikenal dengan Forward Defence Strategy. Strategi ini merupakan upaya Australia membantu AS dalam membendung komunisme yang datang dari Utara. Hal tersebut pula yang melatarbelakangi Australia turut serta dalam Perang Korea, Perang Vietnam atau bahkan konflik antara Indonesia dan Malaysia, seperti yang telah penulis jelaskan sebelumnya (Bhakti 2001: 40-41). Menurut Bhakti dan Alami (2005: 32) kebijakan pertahanan Australia dipengaruhi paling tidak oleh dua hal yaitu, pertama, perubahan strategis pertahanan AS dan Inggris di Asia Pasifik khususnya Asia Tenggara; kedua, perubahan bentuk ancaman. Perubahan modernisasi alat utama sistem persenjataan, postur dan strategi pertahanan Australia disesuaikan dengan perubahan-perubahan lingkungan strategis tersebut. Selain itu, perubahan kebijakan pertahanan Australia juga dipengaruhi oleh pemerintahan dan Perdana Menteri dari partai mana yang berkuasa. Jika pemerintahan dari Partai Buruh yang berkuasa maka, ikatan kekuatan pertahanan dengan negara-negara Asia lebih kuat dibanding dengan AS, namun bukan berarti Australia melepaskan diri dari perlindungan AS. Karena jika pemerintahan Buruh berkuasa politik luar negeri Australia lebih nasionalistik, internasionalistik serta berpandangan luas terhadap negara-negara di Asia dan Pasifik Selatan. Dengan kata lain kebijakan luar negeri Australia yang memiliki keterikatan dengan kebijakan pertahanannya selalu disesuaikan dengan perubahan-perubahan yang terjadi di lingkungan eksternal dan juga internal. 39

51 Dalam kaitan dengan Indonesia, siapapun yang berkuasa di Australia akan tetap memandang Indonesia penting bagi pertahanan Australia. Hal ini dikarenakan posisi Indonesia yang merupakan tameng sekaligus ancaman bagi Australia. Oleh sebab itu, Indonesia selalu dicantumkan dan dianggap penting di dalam Buku Putih Pertahanan Australia (Bhakti dalam Tempo, 21 September 1996; lihat juga Buku Putih Pertahanan Australia 1987; Buku Putih Pertahanan Australia 1997; Buku Putih Pertahanan Australia 2000; Buku Putih Pertahanan Australia 2003; Buku Putih Pertahanan Australia 2005; Buku Putih Pertahanan Australia 2009). B. Faktor Eksternal Selain faktor-faktor internal yang menentukan kebijakan luar negeri Australia ada pula faktor-faktor eksternal yang ikut mempengaruhi seperti yang sudah penulis jelaskan. Pemaparan mengenai faktor-faktor eksternal yang mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia di bawah ini juga berpijak pada pendapat dari Bhakti di dalam laporan penelitian LIPI tahun 2001, yakni: B.1. Perubahan konstelasi politik, ekonomi dan keamanan regional dan internasional Konstelasi politik, ekonomi dan keamanan regional serta internasional tidaklah bersifat statis, melainkan bersifat dinamis dan selalu berubah. Adanya dinamika baik regional maupun interasional amat mempengaruhi implementasi politik luar negeri Australia. Seperti yang telah penulis paparkan sebelumnya 40

52 bahwa sebelum dan pada Perang Dunia I, politik luar negeri Australia dimainkan oleh Inggris. Namun, pasca Perang Dunia I menjelang Perang Dunia II Australia melihat Inggris tidak lagi dapat mengamankan daerah jajahannya di kawasan Asia Pasifik yang menyebabkan Australia mulai mengalihkan pandangannya ke AS. Kemudian Perang Pasifik yang mengakibatkan jatuhnya Singapura ke tangan Jepang akhirnya membuat Australia benar-benar mengalihkan perlindungannya ke AS yang mengakibatkan kebijakan Australia dipengaruhi oleh AS. Pasca Perang Dunia II dan dimulainya Perang Dingin membuat Australia ikut dalam kebijakan AS dengan melaksanakan pembendungan komunisme di kawasan Asia Pasifik. Selain itu, Australia juga masuk dalam kerangaka keamanan AS yakni, ANZUS dan SEATO dalam rangka pencegahan komunisme di kawasan Asia Pasifik (lihat Evans 19991; Firth 2005). Pada tahun 1983 di bawah pemerintahan Hawke dari Partai Buruh, Australia mulai merubah kebijakan keamanannya dari Mencari keamanan dari Asia menjadi Mencari Keamanan di dalam Asia. Hal ini didasari oleh pemikiran Hawke bahwa masa depan perdagangan luar negeri Australia berada di Asia, terutama perdagangan dengan negara Jepang, Cina dan Korea Selatan. Namun, pada tahun 1997 krisis ekonomi melanda kawasan Asia Pasifik membuat terpuruknya ekonomi negara-negara Asia tidak terkecuali Indonesia. Krisis ekonomi yang melanda Asia tersebut bahkan selain membuat ekonomi Indonesia terpuruk juga menyebabkan kekacauan politik dan memicu konflik sosial di Indonesia. Hal ini membuat kebijakan luar negeri Australia di bawah pemerintahan Howard dari Partai koalisi Liberal semakin mendekatkan diri 41

53 kepada AS dan mulai menjauhi Asia termasuk Indonesia (lihat Bhakti 2001; Chauvel 2004 dalam Mar iyah 2005). Sedangkan menurut Pudjiastuti (2006) krisis tahun 1997 membuat perekonomian Indonesia terpuruk dan kekacauan stabilitas dalam negeri Indonesia, hal ini membuat Australia yang memiliki tingkat kemakmuran yang lebih maju dari Indonesia dan beberapa negara Asia lainnya menjadi salah satu negara yang menjadi tujuan utama para imigran asal Indonesia maupun para imigran lain dari negara Asia Selatan dan Timur Tengah seperti Afghanistan dan Irak yang memanfaatkan Indonesia sebagai negara transit sebelum menuju Australia serta berbagai kegiatan lintas batas lainnya (smuggling dan trafficking). Sejak saat itulah isu-isu perbatasan antara Australia dan Indonesia semakin menonjol dan mendapat perhatian lebih dari pemerintah Australia karena Isu imigran gelap dan pelintas batas ini bukan hanya mengancam keamanan Australia tapi juga perekonomian Australia. Perubahan konstelasi politik, keamanan dan ekonomi baik regional maupun interansional kembali berubah ketika terjadi peristiwa terorisme di AS pada tahun 2001 yang menghancurkan gedung kembar WTC di New York. Perubahan ancaman dari konvensional menjadi non konvensional ikut pula mempengaruhi kebijakan Australia terutama ketika terjadi peristiwa terorisme di Indonesia dengan meledaknya Bom di Bali pada tahun 2002 dan meledaknya Bom di depan Kedutaan Besar Australia pada tahun 2004 (Chauvel 2004 dalam Mar iyah 2005). 42

54 Hal ini juga terkait dengan pemaparan penulis pada bab sebelumnya bahwa perubahan-perubahan yang terjadi pada lingkungan strategis baik itu perubahan kebijakan AS dan Inggris maupun perubahan ancaman ikut mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri dan pertahanan Australia (Bhakti dan Alami 2005: 32). Dari penjelasan yang telah penulis uraikan di atas, terlihat bahwa kebijakan luar negeri Australia dipengaruhi beberapa faktor penting baik itu faktor-faktor internal maupun faktor eksternal. Penjelasan mengenai faktor-faktor bertujuan untuk membantu dalam memahami kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia di bawah pemerintahan John Howard dari Partai Liberal dan pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh, yang akan penulis bahas pada bab selanjutnya. 43

55 BAB III KEBIJAKAN LUAR NEGERI AUSTRALIA TERHADAP INDONESIA: JOHN HOWARD DARI PARTAI KOALISI LIBERAL ( ) DAN KEVIN RUDD DARI PARTAI BURUH ( ) Bab ini membahas tentang kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia pada Pemerintahan John Howard dari Partai Liberal dan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh. Bab ini terdiri dari dua sub bab yakni, sub bab pertama membahas tentang kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia di bawah Pemerintahan John Howard dari Partai Liberal; sub bab kedua membahas tentang kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia di bawah Pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh. Dari kedua pembahasan tersebut akan terlihat bagaimana karakter serta perbedaan kebijakan luar negeri dari kedua pemerintahan dengan Perdana Menteri yang berbeda partai tersebut. A.1 Kebijakan Luar Negeri Australia Terhadap Indonesia di Bawah Pemerintahan John Howard Dari Partai Liberal John Washington Howard merupakan Perdana Menteri Australia yang ke dua puluh lima. Ia merupakan Perdana Menteri yang diusung oleh Partai koalisi Liberal dan secara resmi dilantik pada 11 Maret Dengan pelantikannya ini, menandakan berakhirnya masa kepemimpinan Paul Keating dari Partai Buruh selama tiga belas tahun (Wuryandari 2001). 44

56 Menurut Kelly (2006) Howard merupakan seorang Perdana menteri yang telah diragukan untuk membuat kontribusi dalam menentukan kebijakan luar negeri dan keamanan nasional Australia. Hal ini dikarenakan, sebelum ia menjabat sebagai Perdana Menteri, selama dua puluh dua tahun ia berkarir di parlemen Australia terkenal sangat fokus dan perhatian kepada isu-isu domestik dan memiliki perhatian terbatas pada dunia luas. Lebih jauh lagi, Kelly mengutarakan bahwa Howard berkuasa sebagai pemula dalam kebijakan luar negeri, namun naluri yang ia miliki terhadap kebijakan luar negeri cukup dalam. Seperti yang telah digambarkan di atas bahwa pada awal pemerintahannya Howard merupakan seorang yang amatir dalam kebijakan luar negeri. Menurut Howard dalam Kelly (2006) kebijakan luar negeri merupakan latihan dari sebuah praktek politik yang didasarkan pada kepentingan nasional dan nilai-nilai Australia. Dia menolak jika pembuatan kebijakan luar negeri merupakan bentuk seni eksotis dari diplomasi. Howard merasa bahwa kebijakan luar negeri dijalankan dengan akal sehat. Selama sepuluh tahun lebih ia memerintah, ia tidak pernah merubah rumus dasar dari kebijakan luar negerinya, yang hanya didasarkan pada sikapnya yang juga dipengaruhi oleh Partai Koalisi Liberal yang konservatif dalam membuat kebijakan terutama pada awal pemerintahannya di tahun Hanya saja seiring berjalannya waktu pengalamannya meningkat sehingga memperhalus kebijakan luar negerinya. Sedangkan menurut Wuryandari (2001: 50-51) sejak awal pemerintahannya, Howard terlihat bingung dengan arah kebijakan luar negeri Australia. Walaupun, setelah Howard dilantik sebagai Perdana Menteri, ia 45

57 mengatakan bahwa pemerintahan koalisi Liberal akan melanjutkan kebijakan pemerintahan Buruh sebelumnya yang dipimpin oleh Paul Keating, yakni memiliki hubungan yang kuat dengan Asia. Namun, pernyataan tersebut berhenti hanya sebagai retorika saja. Howard dinilai tidak memberikan perhatian secara khusus kepada kebijakan luar negeri Australia. Stagnasi kebijakan luar negeri pada pemerintahan Howard menyebabkan banyaknya kritikan yang ditujukan kepadanya. Hal ini disebabkan oleh salah satu fungsi kebijakan luar negeri ialah mempromosikan berbagai kepentingan nasional Australia. Salah satu kritikan tajam terhadap pemerintahan Howard datang dari surat kabar di Australia The Age menjelang akhir 1996, yang menulis Australian needs the federal Government to Determine a clear set of priorities in foreign, defence and trade policy (Australia membutuhkan pemerintahan federal untuk menentukan seperangkat prioritas yang jelas dalam kebijakan luar negeri, pertahanan dan perdagangan) (terjemahan penulis). Senada dengan pernyataan Wuryandari, Kelly (2006: 5) menilai bahwa stagnasi kebijakan luar negeri di awal pemerintahan Howard dikarenakan pada saat pertama menjabat sebagai Perdana Menteri, Howard hanya memiliki sedikit kontak internasional, ia juga tidak memiliki jaringan dengan regional serta memiliki kecurigaan terhadap pengaruh Hawke dan Keating pada Departemen Luar Negeri dan Perdagangan. Selain itu, Howard juga kurang memahami tentang konsep kebijakan luar negeri dan memiliki empati yang sedikit dengan Asia. Memperkuat argumen sebelumnya, menurut Trood (1998: 185) dalam Wuryandari (2001: 52) dan Suryanarayana (2001) berbeda dengan pasangan 46

58 Keating dan Evans dari pemerintahan Buruh, Perdana menteri Howard dan Menteri Luar Negerinya Downer kurang memiliki antusiasme dalam politik luar negeri serta cenderung inward looking dengan memberikan skala prioritas utama pada berbagai persoalan domestik. Oleh sebab itu, di awal pemerintahannya, politik luar negeri Australia mengalami sejumlah kemunduran terutama dengan Asia yang semakin lama semakin menjauh. Hubungan dengan Cina mengalami penurunan ketika pemerintahan Howard memberikan dukungan publik untuk Presiden Clinton pada Maret 1996, untuk penyebaran Angkatan Laut di Selat Taiwan. Tidak berhenti di situ, pemerintah Howard juga melakukan pencabutan skema perdagangan bantuan DIFF (Development Import Financial Facilities) dengan negara-negara Asia, menghapus program siaran Asia dari Australian Television International, memotong program siaran berbahasa Asia dari radio Australia. Kondisi seperti di atas telah menyebabkan banyaknya kritikan terhadap pemerintahan Howard. Dari kritikan tersebut perlahan Howard menyadari bahwa untuk menjadi Perdana Menteri Australia yang sukses harus memiliki kebijakan luar negeri yang efektif seperti yang dilakukan pendahulunya baik Whitlam, Fraser, Hawke dan Keating yang kesemuanya memiliki jejak kebijakan luar negerinya masing-masing. Setelah tujuh belas bulan menjabat sebagai Perdana menteri, pemerintahan Partai koalisi Liberal mulai mengeluarkan serangkaian kebijakan baru yang menyangkut masalah politik luar negeri, pertahanan dan perdagangan. Kebijakan tersebut meliputi: White Paper on Foreign and Trade 47

59 Policy yang dikeluarkan pada Agustus 1997 dan Australia Strategic Policy pada Desember 1997 (lihat Muna 2000; Wuryandari 2001; Kelly 2006). Dari kedua dokumen yang dikeluarkan ini, pemerintahan Howard mencoba untuk meredefinisi kepentingan masa depan Australia di bidang politik luar negeri, pertahanan dan keamanan serta perdagangan, yakni dengan melakukan penyesuaian diri dari perkembangan regional dan internasional. Di dalam dokumen tersebut, pemerintahan Howard menetapkan prioritas dari kebijakan luar negerinya untuk mencapai kepentingan nasionalnya, yakni sebagai berikut : Pertama, Australia s commitment to the region as its highest foreign policy priority (komitmen Australia kepada region sebagai prioritas tertinggi kebijakan luar negerinya); kedua, Working to enhance Australia s security (melakukan peningkatan keamanan Australia); ketiga, Strengthening Australia s broader global links (menguatkan perluasan ikatan-ikatan global Australia); keempat, Australia s human and principled foreign policy (prinsip kemanusiaan pada kebijakan luar negeri Australia ) (terjemahan penulis) (Downer, 5 Maret 1998 dalam situs resmi Departement of Foreign Affairs and Trade). Dari agenda-agenda kebijakan luar negeri dari pemerintahan Howard terlihat bahwa kawasan Asia Pasifik menduduki posisi tertinggi, namun sayangnya komitmen tersebut terhenti pada tahap retorika saja, sedangkan banyak kebijakan pemerintah Howard yang kontraproduktif bagi hubungan Australia dengan negara-negara Asia, seperti yang telah penulis jelaskan sebelumnya. 48

60 Kebijakan luar negeri pemerintahan Howard yang menjauhkan diri dari Asia, berdampak terhadap penolakan negara-negara ASEAN terhadap keinginan Australia untuk bergabung dengan ASEM (the Asia-Europe Summit Meetings) dalam KTT I Asia-Eropa yang berlangsung di Bangkok pada Akibatnya, Australia pada masa pemerintahan Howard tidak dapat membangun hubungan yang efektif dengan Asia termasuk Indonesia. Hal ini juga dikatakan oleh Kevin Rudd (dalam Asialink, The University of Melbourne, 17 Oktober 2000) bahwa kebijakan luar negeri pemerintahan Howard ialah disengagement from Asia (menjauhkan diri dari Asia). Khusus terhadap Indonesia, Howard tetap menilai Indonesia adalah negara yang penting bagi Australia. Terbukti bahwa di dalam buku putih tahun 1997 yang dikeluarkan pemerintahan Howard tertulis jika hubungan Australia- Indonesia akan selalu penting. Hal ini dikarenakan posisi strategis Indonesia yang merupakan rute utama perdagangan Australia, dengan populasi dan posisinya di Asia tenggara dan pembangunan serta diversifikasi kemitraan bilateralnya merupakan hal-hal yang patut diperhitungkan. Selain itu, perlu juga diingat bahwa Indonesia merupakan negara tetangga terdekat yang dari dan di mana ancaman bagi Australia berasal (lihat In The National Interest 1997: 61 dalam Chauvel 2004 dalam Mar iyah 2005; Hamid 1999). Senada dengan penjelasan di atas, Kelly (2006) mengungkapkan bahwa pada dasarnya kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia di bawah pemerintahan Howard tidak berbeda dengan pemerintahan Keating sebelumnya, sebagai contoh ia tetap mendukung perjanjian pertahanan Australia-Indonesia 49

61 pada tahun Namun, Howard pada kunjungan pertamanya ke luar negeri yakni ke Indonesia pada 1996, menegaskan bahwa Australia tidak bisa menjadi Asia dan ia menginginkan Indonesia yang pada saat itu di pimpin oleh Presiden Soeharto untuk tidak menolak sejarah Australia. Pemaparan di atas terkait dengan penjelasan Kelly (2006) bahwa kebijakan luar negeri Australia di bawah pemerintahan Keating dinilai Howard berusaha menjadikan Australia sebagai Asia dan menganggap Indonesia sebagai negara terpenting bagi Australia. Pemerintahan Howard memang tetap menganggap penting Indonesia namun, ia tidak menginginkan Indonesia memonopoli perhatian Australia. Sedangkan Bhakti mengungkapkan kepada penulis di Jakarta dalam wawancara pada 28 Maret 2011 bahwa Howard kurang setuju dengan pendekatan inter personal yang dilakukan Keating terhadap Indonesia. Lebih lanjut, Bhakti menjelaskan bahwa Howard ingin hubungan Australia-Indonesia terjalin baik, akan tetapi tidak menyetujui Australia mengidentikkan diri dengan Asia. Menurut Chauvel (2004 dalam Mar iyah 2005) kebijakan luar negeri Australia di bawah pemerintahan Howard memang pada awalnya belum menunjukkan adanya perubahan dari kebijakan luar negeri Keating. Namun, pasca krisis moneter tahun 1997, Indonesia mengalami perubahan image. Hal ini berdampak pada melemahnya posisi Indonesia di dunia internasional, yang pada akhirnya berpengaruh pada hubungan Australia- Indonesia. Perubahan situasi yang terjadi di kawasan Asia akibat adanya krisis pada 1997, membuat kebijakan luar negeri Australia di satu sisi harus menyesuaikan 50

62 diri dengan perubahan tersebut terutama pada negara-negara ASEAN, dan khususnya pada negara tetangga terdekatnya Indonesia. Namun, di sisi lain karakter pemerintahan John Howard yang menjauhkan diri dari Asia dalam hal ini termasuk juga Indonesia serta mendekatkan diri pada aliansinya yakni AS. Bahkan, Howard mengklaim bahwa Australia merupakan Deputy Sheriff AS di kawasan Asia (Chauvel 2005 dalam Mar iyah 2005: xvii). Sedangkan Downer (1997: 5 dalam Wuryandari 2001: 60) menjelaskan bahwa situasi strategis di Asia Pasifik yang semakin kompleks, terutama pasca krisis pada pertengahan 1997 menyebabkan Australia memiliki kepentingan yang sangat besar terhadap AS. Lebih lanjut, Downer mengatakan bahwa Australia mempercayai bahwa kehadiran AS merupakan faktor kunci bagi terwujudnya stabilitas kawasan keamanan di Asia Pasifik yang pada saat itu sedang mengahadapi banyak masalah dan tantangan terkait krisis yang terjadi pada tahun Kemunduran hubungan antara Australia-Indonesia semakin terjadi pasca krisis tahun 1997, Indonesia mengalami kekacauan politik dalam negeri yang membuat Presiden Soeharto mengundurkan diri pada 1998 dan digantikan oleh Presiden Habibie. Dalam laporan Chega (2005: 33) berakhirnya pemerintahan Presiden Soeharto diakui pemerintah Australia di bawah Howard sebagai kesempatan untuk melanjutkan penyelesaian masalah Timor Timur dalam kerangka kedaulatan Indonesia. Masalah Timor Timur merupakan kerikil yang mewarnai perjalanan hubungan antara Australia-Indonesia. Australia merasa bahwa Timor Timur, Papua New Gueinea dan Indonesia merupakan halaman depan Australia. Karena alasan tersebut Australia merasa berkepentingan untuk 51

63 ikut menyelesaikan masalah tersebut. Jika, pada masa kepemimpinan Whitlam, Fraser, Hawke dan Keating permasalahan Timor Timur dapat diselesaikan dengan jalan kerjasama antara Australia-Indonesia, tapi tidak untuk pemerintahan Howard. Beralihnya kebijakan Australia mengenai Timor Timur ini sangat dipengaruhi oleh survei yang dilakukan Australia pada bulan Juli-Agustus tahun 1998 kepada rakyat Timor Timur mengenai status quo. Hasil survei tersebut menunjukkan bahwa sebagian besar rakyat Timor Timur tidak sepakat dengan status quo dan menginginkan otonomi baik secara referendum maupun pengambilan keputusan. Kemudian Australia membagikan hasil survei tersebut kepada Indonesia (lihat juga Bhakti dalam Kontan, 20 September 1999). Lebih jauh lagi, pada tanggal 19 Desember 1998 Perdana Menteri Australia, John Howard menulis surat kepada Presiden Habibie untuk melakukan pembicaraan langsung kepada rakyat Timor Timur secepatnya, yang bertujuan untuk memperoleh dukungannya terhadap otonomi dalam wilayah Indonesia. Howard meyarankan untuk pelaksanaan tindakan penentuan nasib sendiri setelah periode otonomi yang cukup lama serupa dengan pendekatan yang disetujui di Kaledonia Baru untuk kolonisasi Perancis. Saran yang diberikan Howard yang tertulis dalam suratnya mengenai pendekatan yang serupa dengan kolonisasi Perancis menyinggung perasaan Presiden Habibie yang merasa jika Indonesia disamakan dengan penjajahan yang dilakukan Perancis. Hal ini memicu sikap Presiden Habibie yang setuju dengan adanya jajak pendapat penentuan nasib sendiri bagi Timor Timur, yang berakhir dengan lepasnya Timor Timur dari Indonesia pada Agustus tahun 1999 (Laporan Chega 2005). 52

64 Perubahan kebijakan Australia terhadap Indonesia terkait masalah Timor Timur semakin membuat hubungan Australia-Indonesia pada masa Pemerintahan Howard mengalami penurunan yang sangat tajam mengakibatkan Presiden Habibie membatalkan secara sepihak perjanjian AMS pada tahun Lebih lanjut, menurut Effendy (2001: 5) yang dikutip oleh Wuryandari (2001: 60-61) pilihan yang dilakukan pemerintahan Howard sangat dipengaruhi oleh ideologi Howard yang sangat konservatif yang merupakan pemimpin Partai koalisi Liberal yang memang memiliki pandangan konservatif. Howard merupakan seorang yang menganut paham bahwa Australia adalah negara Eropa yang mempunyai tugas menegakkan nilai-nilai Barat, seperti yang telah penulis uraikan sebelumnya bahwa saat kunjungan perdananya ke Indonesia, Howard menegaskan bahwa Indonesia harus menerima sejarah Australia yang memang sejarah Australia adalah keturuanan Inggris. Sejalan dengan pendapat Effendy, Kelly (2006) menilai bahwa kebijakan luar negeri Howard merupakan sintesis dari pandangan Partai Liberal dan prinsip tradisional Australia. Oleh karena itu, kebijakan luar negeri Australia yang selama ini dinilai Howard hanya Asia, seperti yang dilakukan oleh pemerintahan Buruh di bawah Keating telah berakhir. Hal ini dibuktikan dengan keberanian Australia dalam menyelesaikan masalah Timor Timur yang berkepanjangan dengan Indonesia. Selain masalah Timor Timur yang menjadi batu sandungan antara Australia-Indonesia. Permasalahan imigran juga mempengaruhi hubungan Australia-Indonesia. Pasca krisis yang melanda Asia termasuk Indonesia, Australia yang merupakan negara maju di kawasan Asia Pasifik membuat para 53

65 imigran baik dari Indonesia maupun dari negara lain terutama negara Asia Selatan dan Timur Tengah yang akan menuju Australia membuat Australia memperketat kebijakan terkait masalah imigran ini. Pemerintah Howard mengklaim bahwa Indonesia tidak serius dalam mengontrol imigran gelap menuju Australia seperti pada kasus kapal TAMPA pada tahun Howard mengatakan bahwa terkait masalah tersebut merupakan sepenuhnya tanggung jawab Indonesia. Sedangkan dari pihak Indonesia menilai bahwa ini merupakan masalah yang harus diselesaikan bersama (Pudjiastuti 2006). Perbedaan pandangan antara pemerintah Australia dengan pemerintah Indonesia membuat semakin buruknya hubungan antara Australia-Indonesia di bawah pemerintahan Howard. Hanggarini (2008: 59) menulis bahwa kebijakan luar negeri Howard yang kurang berpihak terhadap Indonesia dipengaruhi oleh lingkungan yang membentuk pribadi Howard. Pandangan Howard yang menyiratkan anti konsep multikulturalisme adalah pengaruh dari keterlibatannya dalam Partai Liberal yang konservatif (lihat juga Koran Tempo, 8 februari 2002). Lebih lanjut Hanggarini berpendapat bahwa gaya diplomasi Howard adalah megaphone diplomacy yakni menyuarakan masalah-masalah antara kedua negara secara sepihak dan kontroversial seperti kasus TAMPA tahun 2001, yang dinilai merupakan hal yang berlebihan dan mengganggu hubungan Australia-Indonesia. Sedangkan Parnohadiningrat (2002) mengatakan bahwa Pemerintah Liberal saat itu yang dipimpin oleh Howard telah melakukan blame-game diplomacy dan megaphone diplomacy pada kasus TAMPA tahun 2001 untuk kepentingan kampanye politiknya. Hal ini senada dengan yang dikatakan oleh 54

66 Kelly (2006) bahwa salah satu karakter kepemimpinan Howard adalah memakai permasalahan imigran gelap dengan Indonesia untuk memenangkan pemilu tahun Lebih lanjut lagi, hubungan Australia-Indonesia kembali diuji ketika terjadi peristiwa Bom Bali pada 12 Oktober 2002 setahun setelah peristiwa 11 September 2001 di AS. Laporan resmi menyebutkan bahwa ledakan di Kuta, Bali, telah menewaskan 185 orang dan mencederai 324 orang lainnya, kebanyakan korban berasal dari Australia. Peristiwa ini menyadarkan Australia untuk meningkatkan kerjasama dengan Indonesia. Selain itu, peristiwa Bom Bali menjadi awal kerjasama antara Polisi Federal Australia dengan Kepolisian Indonesia. Dari kerjasama tersebut maka dibentuklah Densus 88 untuk mengungkap kasus tersebut. Bantuan dan kerjasama antara kepolisian Australia dengan Indonesia menunjukkan bahwa kepolisian Indonesia mampu mengungkap kasus Bom Bali dengan mengadili 40 orang yang menjadi tersangka. Meskipun begitu, Indonesia mengalami peristiwa Bom di depan Keduatan Besar Australia pada September 2004 (Pudjiastuti 2006). Peristiwa ini kembali membuat Australia lebih menaruh perhatian yang lebih besar terhadap keamanan Indonesia, hal ini tertuang dalam bantuan Australia kepada Indonesia sejak tahun 2002 sampai 2005: 55

67 3.1 Tabel Bantuan Australia untuk Kegiatan Anti-Terorist Tahun Waktu Tujuan Jumlah Oktober 2002 Paket Counter terrorism assistance selama 4 tahun A$ 10 juta Februari 2004 Pembentukkan Jakarta for Law Enforcement Cooperation September Bantuan untuk Masyarakat yang terkena Bom di 2004 depan Kedubes Australia A$ 36.6 juta A$ 3 juta 7 Desember 2004 Penambahan Paket Counter Terrorism Assistance A$ 10 juta 18 Maret 2005 Capacity Building untuk anti Money Laundring and Combating Terrorist Financing A$ 2 juta 1 Oktober 2005 Bantuan untuk masyarakat terkena Bom Bali II A$ 1 juta Sumber: (Pudjiastuti 2006: 138) Bantuan yang diberikan pemerintah Australia untuk Indonesia dalam menanggulangi terorisme membuat hubungan Australia-Indonesia semakin membaik. Namun, di lain sisi hubungan Australia-Indonesia kembali mendingin ketika pemerintah Australia memberikan suaka politik kepada 42 warga papua yang lari ke Australia pada 18 Januari Kebijakan Australia terhadap imigran asal Papua tersebut membuat Indonesia menilai Australia memiliki maksud lain. Hal ini disebabkan peristiwa imigran sebelumnya, di mana Australia menolak untuk menerima para imigran dari negara lain, yakni sebagian besar dari Afghanistan dan Irak, namun membiarkan warga Papua yang salah satunya 56

68 merupakan anggota kelompok Papua Merdeka tinggal di Australia. Hal ini juga terkait dengan penjelasan penulis sebelumnya pada Bab II bahwa masalah Papua masih menjadi rintangan hubungan Australia-Indonesia. Hal ini disebabkan kuatnya lobi dari kelompok penekan di Australia untuk Papua Merdeka (lihat Bhakti dalam Republika Online, 27 Mei 2006; Bhakti dalam wawancara 28 Maret 2011). Selain itu, trauma akan peristiwa lepasnya Timor Timur dari Indonesia membuat Indonesia lebih berhati-hati dengan Australia. Oleh sebab itu, kasus pemberian visa terhadap 42 warga Papua yang salah satunya merupakan anggota Papua Merdeka dan sedang dalam pencarian oleh polisi Indonesia membuat pemerintah Indonesia menaruh curiga terhadap Australia dan melayangkan protes resmi kepada pemerintah Australia. Namun, Howard dalam berita ABC 5 April 2006 sebagaimana dikutip Pudjiastuti (2006: 143) Mr. Howard says he understands the reaction but the bilateral relationship is strong enough to survive (Howard mengatakan, dia mengerti tentang reaksi itu, namun ia merasa jika hubungan bilateral Australia-Indonesia cukup kuat untuk bertahan) (terjemahan penulis). Sedangkan Indonesia merasa bahwa Australia telah melanggar kedaulatan Indonesia dengan ikut campur masalah dalam negeri Indonesia. Protes keras dari Indonesia kembali dilakukan dengan menarik mundur Duta Besar Indonesia Hamzah Thayeb (lihat juga Tempo Interaktif, 11 Juni 2006). Protes keras bukan hanya dilakukan oleh pemerintah Indonesia, namun masyarakat Indonesia juga melakukan protes atas sikap Australia yang tidak 57

69 menghargai kedaulatan Indonesia. Hal ini menyebabkan Australia mengirimkan utusannya Michel L Estrange ke Jakarta untuk menemui Menteri Luar negeri Indonesia yang bertujuan memperbaiki hubungan Australia-Indonesia. Selain itu, demi menjaga perasaan dan hubungan baik dengan Indonesia, Menteri keimigrasian Vanstone pada 29 April 2006 merilis tulisan di surat kabar Australia The Weekend Australia yang berisi Papuan separatism is a racist, toxic and cause (Separatisme Papua adalah rasis, racun dan merupakan masalah) (terjemahan penulis) (lihat Pudjiastuti 2006: 144). Serangkaian masalah yang dihadapi Australia dan Indonesia dari mulai kasus Timor Timur, kasus imigran gelap dan kapal Tampa 2001, pemberian visa kepada 42 warga Papua, serta berbagai kasus terorisme yang melanda Indonesia, pada dasarnya menurut Thayeb (2008) membuat hubungan Australia-Indonesia semakin matang. Hal tersebut juga membuat pemerintahan Australia di bawah Howard menyadari bahwa diperlukan suatu kerjasama keamanan antara Australia dengan Indonesia. Hal ini dilakukan terkait dengan perubahan ancaman yang terjadi yang lebih bersifat non konvensional yang membutuhkan kerjasama dari berbagai pihak untuk mencegah ancaman tersebut. Hal ini juga tidak terlepas dari persoalan di Indonesia seperti kasus imigran gelap atau people smuggling, terorisme dan berbagai ancaman yang bersifat non konvensional lainnya. Atas dasar alasan tersebut, Australia di bawah John Howard dan Indonesia sepakat untuk menandatangani Frame Work Agreement on Security Cooperation atau juga di sebut The Lombok Treaty pada 13 November Lombok Treaty mengatur 21 kerjasama dalam 10 bidang, yaitu: kerjasama bidang pertahanan, penegakan 58

70 hukum, anti-terorisme; kerjasama intelijen, keamanan maritim, keselamatan dan keamanan penerbangan, pencegahan perluasan (non-proliferasi) senjata pemusnah massal, kerjasama tanggap darurat, organisasi multilateral, dan peningkatan saling pengertian dan saling kontak antar masyarakat dan antar perseorangan (lihat Bhakti 2006; Newsletter, Edisi III/06/2008). Terlepas dari berbagai permasalahan yang mengganjal hubungan kedua negara di atas. Pada dasarnya jalinan kerjasama yang baik antara Australia dengan Indonesia bukan hanya berpengaruh pada keamanan Australia namun, juga menguntungkan bagi perekonomian Australia. Seperti yang dikatakan oleh Crithley (1995) bahwa hubungan kerjasama yang baik antara Australia dengan Indonesia akan menguntungkan ekonomi Australia. Hal ini terkait dengan penjelasan penulis pada bab pertama bahwa tujuan kebijakan luar negeri meliputi tujuan politik, keamanan dan perdagangan. Kemudian, Kepentingan nasional Australia terhadap Indonesia bukan hanya dalam segi keamanan saja, tetapi juga dalam segi ekonomi (Bhakti 2001). Indonesia merupakan mitra dagang yang penting bagi Australia, walaupun tidak sestrategis Jepang, Cina dan Korea Selatan. Namun, Indonesia juga merupakan pangsa pasar yang menguntungkan bagi Australia. Sebagai ilustrasi, pada tahun 2004 perdagangan Australia-Indonesia mencapai 8,5 juta dollar Australia. Seperti yang terlihat pada tabel di berikut ini: 59

71 3.2 Tabel Ekspor Utama Australia ke Indonesia tahun (dalam A$ 000) No. Jenis Barang Jumlah 2,680,63 6 Tahun ,219,572 3,059,364 2,784,374 3,234,441 1 Kapas 436, , , , ,690 2 Minyak mentah 22 51,042 27, , ,342 3 Binatang hidup 143, , , , ,960 4 Alumunium 187, , , , ,950 5 Tembaga 24,237 30,097 39,055 38, ,364 6 Susu & Krim 64,055 91, ,764 72, ,583 7 Manufaktur metal lainnya 8 Manuf classed by material 9 Chemicals & related products 10 Food & live animals 47,647 69,819 66,296 77,337 73,712 76,070 80,292 78,980 65,351 62,198 64,077 86,811 75,791 69,928 60,113 45,056 57,487 66,717 51,721 58,195 Sumber: Departemen Luar Negeri dan Perdagangan Australia 2006 dalam Pudjiastuti (2006: 148). 60

72 3.3 Tabel Barang Impor Australia dari Indonesia tahun (dalam A$ 000) No. Jenis Barang Tahun Jumlah 2,699,626 3,898,401 4,221,614 4,077,553 3,698,732 1 Crude petroleum 890,525 1,690, ,841 1,192,606 1,202,042 2 Gold 111, , ,214 1,076, ,134 3 Paper & paperboard 4 Confidental hems 5 Refined petroleum 6 Sound &video recorder 93,118 71, , , ,890 97, ,476 97, , ,208 38, ,558 79,928 59, ,660 43,417 50,170 79, , ,660 7 Furniture 81,110 80,536 96, , ,396 8 Shipe & boats 24,353 16,178 45,256 64,469 97,461 9 Woods & simple 10 Machinery & transport equip 52,013 35,721 49,402 64,469 82,935 67,907 69,312 67,057 67,248 73,508 Sumber: Departemen Luar Negeri dan Perdagangan Australia 2006 dalam Pudjiastuti (2006: 149). Dari statistik yang tertera di Tabel 3.2 dan 3.3 dapat dilihat bahwa ekspor Australia ke Indonesia memang menguntungkan bagi Australia, walaupun terjadi penurunan di tahun 2003, akan tetapi pada tahun 2004 ekspor Australia ke Indonesia mengalami kenaikan yang signifikan. Hal ini membuat Indonesia menjadi pasar kelima belas bagi Australia pada tahun 2004 (Pudjiastuti 2006). Melengkapi data di atas, menurut Juoro (2007: 65-66) kerjasama perdagangan Indonesia mengalami perkembangan pesat. Pada tahun 2006, total perdagangan Australia-Indonesia mencapai A$ 9 juta meningkat A$ 0.5 juta dari 61

73 tahun Jika pada tahun 2004, Indonesia merupakan rekan dagang nomor lima belas, pada tahun 2006, Indonesia menjadi rekan dagang nomor sepuluh bagi Australia. Hal ini menunjukan bahwa Indonesia merupakan pasar yang potensial bagi Australia, karena setiap tahun perdagangan Australia-Indonesia mengalami peningkatan. Hal ini dapat dilihat dari grafik di bawah ini: 3.4 Grafik Perdagangan Indonesia-Australia Tahun (dalam juta A$) Sumber: Juoro (2007: 66) Selain perdagangan barang, jasa pendidikan Australia merupakan salah satu pilihan utama bagi para siswa dan mahasiswa Indonesia. oleh sebab itu, untuk menjaga dan mempromosikan pasar ke dua negara tersebut, secara rutin kedua negara menyelenggarakan The Australia-Indonesia Ministrial Forum yang telah berlangsung sejakn tahun Selain itu, Australia-Indonesia juga 62

74 menandatangani Trade and Investment Framework (TIF) yang bertujuan untuk mengurangi hambatan tarif dan non tarif di antara ke dua negara. Sebagai negara yang memiliki potensi pasar yang besar bagi Australia menyebabkan Australia menaruh perhatian lebih bagi kesehatan iklim investasi Indonesia. Oleh sebab itu, Australia memberikan berbagai bantuan kepada Indonesia. Di dalam laporan LIPI tahun 2004 yang ditulis oleh Elizabeth (2004) Indonesia merupakan negara yang menerima bantuan terbesar dari Australia melalui AusAID. Menurut Bhakti (dalam Majalah Tempo, 21 September 1996) bantuan dan kerjasama ekonomi antara Australia-Indonesia melalui AusAID terutama program beasiswa, pada dasarnya bukan hanya menguntungkan Indonesia tetapi, juga menguntungkan Australia. Dengan program beasiswa tersebut Australia berharap agar tumbuh kelompok intelektual Indonesia yang berguna bagi pembangunan Indonesia dan juga citra politik dan perkembangan ekonomi Australia. Dengan program beasiswa ini, Australia menjadi salah satu tujuan utama siwa dan mahasiswa Indonesia non-beasiswa yang pada tahun 2008 mencapai pelajar (lihat juga Profil negara Australia dalam situs resmi KBRI). Bukan hanya melalui program beasiswa, bantuan Australia juga difokuskan ke Kawasan Timur Indonesia (KTI). Hal ini dilakukan untuk mencegah terjadinya political upheavals atau pergolakan politik di kawasan tersebut yang dapat berdampak negatif bagi Australia karena kawasan tersebut berbatasan langsung dengan Australia. Program ini juga bukan hanya menguntungkan dan membantu Indonesia, akan tetapi juga merupakan upaya 63

75 Australia untuk mencegah migrasi ke Australia (Bhakti dalam Tempo, 21 September 1996). Sedangkan menurut Pudjiastuti (2006) bantuan Australia ke Indonesia mengalami peningkatan sejak terjadinya Bom Bali I pada tahun 2002, Bom di Kedutaan Besar Australia pada tahun 2004 dan saat terjadinya Tsunami di Indonesia tahun 2004, Australia semakin meningkatkan perhatian dan bantuannya ke Indonesia. Dari pemaparan di atas terlihat bahwa pada awalnya kebijakan luar negeri Howard terhadap Indonesia bersifat high profile, lebih dekat dengan AS dan menjaukan diri dari Asia serta kurang peduli terhadap permasalahan yang terjadi di Indonesia (Wuryandari 2001 dan Pudjiastuti 2006). Hal ini disebabkan selain oleh pergantian pemerintahan dari Buruh di bawah Paul Keating yang memiliki kebijakan luar negeri yang low profile juga oleh krisis yang melanda negaranegara Asia termasuk Indonesia pada tahun Akibatnya, Indonesia mengalami keterpurukan ekonomi dan kekacauan politik serta jatuhnya rezim Soeharto yang menyebabkan Indonesia mengalami penurunan citra politik di mata dunia termasuk Australia. Akibatnya posisi tawar Indonesia menjadi lemah. Hal ini dimanfaatkan oleh pemerintahan Howard untuk segera menuntaskan masalah Timor Timur yang berlarut-larut. Dengan sikap Howard yang menulis surat kepada Habibie pada tahun 1999 yang menyinggung perasaan Presiden Habibie membuat lepasnya Timor Timur dari Indonesia pada tahun itu. Namun, seiring berjalannya waktu kebijakan luar negeri Australia di bawah Howard terlihat lebih kooperatif. Hal ini juga dipicu oleh berbagai masalah 64

76 dan adanya perubahan ancaman di lingkungan baik regional maupun internasional mulai dari kasus Imigran gelap, kasus terorisme di AS dan Indonesia, serta tsunami yang melanda Indonesia pada tahun 2004 menyadarkan pemerintahan Howard akan pentingnya meningkatkan kerjasama dengan Indonesia. Pergeseran ancaman dari konvensional dengan meningkatnya berbagai ancaman non konvensional dari peristiwa terorisme yang melanda AS pada tahun 2001 dan juga Indonesia menyadarkan serta meningkatkan pengalaman Howard untuk lebih memberi perhatian kepada negara tetangga terdekatnya Indonesia. Selain itu, pergantian kepemimpinan di Indonesia pada tahun 2004 dari Megawati ke Susilo Bambang Yudhoyono semakin membuat hubungan kedua negara membaik. Pasalnya Howard menilai bahwa SBY pada saat itu merupakan Presiden Indonesia yang paling baik (Wesley 2007 yang dikutip oleh Noor, Suara Karya Online 8 Oktober 2008). Pada dasarnya Indonesia memiliki posisi penting bagi Australia yang menjadi benteng sekaligus ancaman bagi keamanan Australia. Ditambah dengan pengalaman yang semakin matang dari pemerintahan Howard membuat kebijakan luar negari Australia di bawah pemerintahan koalisi Liberal semakin halus hingga berakhirnya pemerintahan Howard (Kelly 2006). Namun, penulis menilai bahwa membaiknya hubungan Australia- Indonesia dimulai sejak Presiden SBY naik menggantikan Megawati. Hal ini dikarenakan pada masa Presiden SBY, selain kondisi dalam negeri Indonesia yang lebih kondusif, hubungan Indonesia dengan AS juga sedang erat. Australia yang memang sangat dekat dengan AS dan memiliki hubungan khusus terutama ketika 65

77 pemerintahan koalisi Liberal menjabat pada akhirnya harus juga menjaga hubungan baik dengan Indonesia dengan tidak bersikap keras terhadap Indonesia, seperti pada pemerintahan Menzies yang telah penulis jelaskan sebelumnya, yang harus berbalik mendukung Indonesia pada saat Papua dipermasalahkan oleh Belanda karena AS dan Inggris lebih membela Indonesia yang pada saat itu dipimpin oleh Presiden Soeharto menggantikan Soekarno. Seperti yang sudah penulis jelaskan di awal bahwa pergantian kepemimpinan dari kedua negara memang kerap mempengaruhi hubungan Australia-Indonesia. Kemudian, pada sub bab selanjutnya penulis membahas tentang kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia di bawah pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh. B. Kebijakan Luar Negeri Australia di Bawah Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh Kevin Micheal Rudd resmi menjadi Perdana Menteri Australia ke-26 dan menggantikan John Howard pada 3 Desember 2007 setelah partainya yakni Partai Buruh Australia (Australian Labour Party-ALP) memenangkan pemilihan umum pada 24 November Kemenangan ini sekaligus menandakan berakhirnya masa kekuasaan Partai koalisi Liberal/Nasional ( ) di Australia. Kevin Rudd lahir di Nambour, Queensland pada 21 September 1957, ia merupakan seorang mantan diplomat dan politisi senior Australia (Bhakti, 2008: 18). 66

78 Pergantian pemerintahan di Australia dari pemerintahan Partai Liberal- Nasional ke pemerintahan Partai Buruh yang dipimpin oleh Kevin Rudd ini menjadi era baru dari komitmen peningkatan hubungan Australia dengan negaranegara Asia Pasifik termasuk Indonesia. Di dalam situs resmi Kementrian Luar Negeri Republik Indonesia disebutkan bahwa komitmen baru dalam meningkatkan hubungan Australia dengan negara-negara Asia didasarkan pada kebijakan luar negeri Partai Buruh pada masa Kevin Rudd bertumpu pada tiga pilar yaitu : pertama, aliansi dengan Amerika Serikat. Kedua, engagement (memperat hubungan) dengan PBB. Ketiga, engagement (mempererat hunbungan) dengan Asia (lihat profil negara Australia dalam situs resmi Kementrian Luar Negeri Indonesia, 2010; Hermawan, 2008). Sejalan dengan penjelasan di atas Hermawan (2008: 2) mengungkapkan bahwa ketiga pilar utama di atas yang juga telah penulis jelaskan merupakan arah utama bagi sikap Australia di kawasan regional dan global. Sebelum menjadi Perdana Menteri Kevin Rudd telah memakai pendekatan tiga pilar ini dan ia berargumen bahwa inilah yang membedakannya dengan John Howard yang menekankan pada satu pilar saja. Dalam Frost (2002: 20-22) yang dikutip Hermawan (2008: 3) argumen Rudd tersebut muncul ketika ia menanggapi white paper politik luar negeri dan perdagangan Australia di tahun 2003: As a matter of philosophical orientation, we differ fundamentally from the conservatives who rely on one pillar and one pillar alone that is, the alliance with the United States. For Labor, the alliance is fundamental to our security policy and our foreign policy. It is not, however, the totality of our security policy and our foreign policy. (Sebagai suatu masalah dari orientasi filosofi, kami berbeda secara mendasar dari konservatif yang menekankan pada satu pilar saja, yakni kedekatan dengan Amerika Serikat. Untuk Buruh, aliansi dengan 67

79 Amerika Serikat merupakan dasar kebijakan keamanan dan kebijakan luar negeri kita. Akan tetapi, ini bukanlah totalitas dari kebijakan keamanan dan kebijakan luar negeri kita) (terjemahan penulis). Lebih lanjut menurut Hermawan (2008: 2) untuk melihat apakah ada perubahan atau perbedaan kebijakan luar negeri yang diambil dari pemimpin suatu negara adalah melihat visi dan misinya. Bhakti mengatakan bahwa pada dasarnya visi dan misi Kevin Rudd tidak berbeda dibanding pemimpin-pemimpin Australia sebelumnya ataupun pemimpin dunia lainnya yakni untuk melindungi kepentingan nasional Australia. Namun, komitmen Rudd untuk menjadikan Australia a strong, prosperous and outward-looking (kuat, sejahtera dan memiliki pandangan ke luar) yang dikemukakannya dalam pidato kemenangan pada tahun 2007 lalu membuatnya berbeda dengan pemimpin sebelumnya yakni John Howard. Kevin Rudd menyampaikan komitmen tersebut dengan lugas dan tegas. Hal inilah yang membedakan kebijakan luar negeri Rudd dengan Howard. Seperti yang penulis telah diungkapkan pada sub bab sebelumnya bahwa kebijakan luar negeri Howard terkesan tidak jelas karena lebih inward looking dan juga terkesan hanya menjaga aliansinya dengan Amerika serta mengabaikan engagement (keeratan hubungan) dengan Asia (lihat juga Wuryandari 2001: 50-58; Suryanarayana, 2001). Sedangkan Gyngell (2008) mengatakan bahwa Kevin Rudd tidak memiliki hubungan yang terlalu dekat dengan AS seperti Howard. Lebih jauh lagi, Gyngell mengatakan bahwa walaupun pilar pertama kebijakan luar negeri Rudd ialah aliansi dengan AS, namun kebijakan luar negeri Rudd sama halnya dengan pendahulu-pendahulunya dari Partai Buruh yanga akan memilih kedekatan dengan 68

80 Asia. Hal ini terlihat dengan upayanya yang meningkatkan pengajaran bahasa Asia di sekolah-sekolah Australia. Senada dengan Gyngell, Bongiorno (2007 dalam Hermawan 2008) mengatakan bahwa Kevin Rudd merupakan pemimpin Partai Buruh yang Asianis karena latar belakang pendidikannya, karirnya sebagai diplomat dan profesinya yang membuat dekat dengan Asia. Senada dengan pendapat di atas, di dalam Buletin Berita (1 Juli 2008) yang penulis kutip dari situs resmi Kedutaan Besar RI-Canberra diungkapkan bahwa kebijakan luar negeri Australia sering berubah seiring dengan perubahan pemerintahan di Canberra, hal itu bisa juga mempengaruhi hubungan Australia dengan Indonesia dan juga negara-negara tetangga di utara lainnya. Di masa pemerintahan John Howard hubungan Australia-Indonesia banyak menemui masalah seperti kasus Timor Timur tahun 1999 yang berakibat lepasnya Timor Timur dari Indonesia dan semakin memanasnya hubungan kedua negara, adanya kasus Imigran gelap pada tahun 2001 (kasus Tampa), kasus Tragedi Bom bali tahu 2002 dan kasus Bom di depan Kedutaan Australia di Indonesia tahun 2004, serta kasus suaka politik 42 warga negara Papua oleh pemerintah Australia. Sedangkan, kebijakan luar negeri Australia pada masa Kevin Rudd cenderung lebih kondusif untuk membangun kerjasama dengan Indonesia dibandingkan dengan pemimpin sebelumnya John Howard. Hal tersebut tidak lain karena Rudd memiliki tiga pilar kerjasama yang jelas yang salah satunya adalah keterikatan dengan Asia. Namun, ada bebarapa kasus yang terjadi di masa pemerintahan Howard yang harus diselesaikan oleh pemerintahan Rudd yakni, masalah pemberian suaka 42 warga kasus Papua dan juga kasus terpidana mati enam 69

81 warga negara Australia akibat tertangkap membawa heroin 8,2 kg di Bali pada tahun 2005 dan ditetapkan hukuman mati pada tahun 2006 (kasus Bali Nine). Selanjutnya, Australia di bawah pemerintahan Kevin Rudd pada tanggal 7 Februari 2008 melakukan pertukaran nota Lombok Treaty yang telah ditandatangani sebelumnya pada 13 November Hal ini merupakan tindak lanjut nyata dari Australia untuk mempererat jalinan kerjasamanya dengan Indonesia terutama terkait masalah keamanan. Pertukaran nota yang dilakukan Menlu Hassan Wirjuda dan Menlu Stephen Smith menandai bahwa Lombok Treaty ini mengikat kedua negara secara resmi (lihat juga profil negara Australia dalam situs resmi Kementrian RI, 2010). Dalam melihat landmarks penting hubungan bilateral Australia-Indonesia pada masa pemerintahan Kevin Rudd, penulis kembali mengambil data-data dari situs resmi Kementrian Luar Negeri RI. Landmarks penting tersebut, antara lain, pertemuan bilateral antara Presiden Yudhoyono dengan Perdana Menteri Kevin Rudd di Bali pada tanggal 11 Desember 2007 di sela-sela United Nations Conventions on Climate Change (UNCCC), pertemuan tersebut menegaskan bahwa pemerintah baru di Australia tetap menjadikan Indonesia prioritas utama hubungan luar negeri Australia. Pada tanggal Juni 2008 kembali Perdana Menteri Kevin Rudd melakukan kunjungan kenegaraan ke Indonesia. Kunjungan tersebut menghasilkan, antara lain, Joint Announcement mengenai Carbon Partnership dan juga penandatanganan antara pemerintah Australia dengan pengurus besar Nahdatul Ulama mengenai pengembangan kapasitas sekolah 70

82 Islam. Bukan hanya itu, Perdana Menteri Kevin Rudd juga bersedia menjadi cochair pada Bali Democracy Forum. Sementara itu, pada tingkat kementrian, antara tanggal Agustus 2008 Menlu Smith melakukan kunjungan bilateral resmi pertamanya ke Indonesia. Hasil kunjungan tersebut, antara lain, adanya kerjasama pembangunan untuk Indonesia sebesar A$ 2,5 milyar, bantuan pemerintah Australia pada perbaikan gedung sekolah dasar di Sulawesi Selatan dan komitmen people to people contact tujuannya adalah untuk memperkokoh hubungan kedua negara (lihat profil negara Australia dalam situs resmi Kementrian Republik Indonesia). Hubungan bilateral antara Australia-Indonesia pada masa pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dapat dikatakan tidak menemui permasalahan yang mengakibatkan hubungan kedua negara ini memanas. Pada masa pemerintahan Rudd hubungan Australia-Indonesia didominasi oleh permasalahan Terorisme, Imigran gelap, kasus 42 warga Papua dan kasus Bali Nine. Permasalahan ini tidak serta merta membuat hubungan keduanya memburuk, bahkan adanya permasalahan ini membuat kedua negara mempererat kerjasamanya. Hal menarik yang patut diperhatikan dari beberapa kali kunjungan Rudd ke Indonesia ini ternyata bukan hanya ingin mempererat hubungan dengan Indonesia yang pada masa pemerintahan Howard, hubungan Australia-Indonesia sempat mengalami penurunan terkait beberapa kasus yang telah penulis jelaskan. Namun, kunjungan tersebut merupakan sebuah diplomasi yang dilakukan Rudd terkait masalah kasus 42 warga Papua yang mendapat suaka politik di Australia dan juga terpidana mati warga negara Australia (kasus Bali Nine). Kasus yang 71

83 merupakan kerikil bagi hubungan kedua negara ini mendapat perhatian khusus di publik Australia di mana pemerintah Rudd dituntut untuk dapat membebaskan kesembilan warga negaranya dari hukuman mati serta memberikan secara halus status permanen bagi 42 warga Papua tersebut (lihat Konstelasi edisi 6, Januari 2008). Pasca pertemuan bilateral antara Presiden Yudhoyono dan Perdana menteri Rudd tahun 2007 lalu, Mahkamah Agung menerima peninjauan kembali kasus tiga terpidana mati narkoba asal Australia yang dikenal dengan kasus Bali Nine. Peninjauan kembali kasus ini membuat para terpidana hanya dituntut dengan hukuman seumur hidup di tingkat Pengadilan Negeri dan vonis 20 tahun penjara pada tingkat banding (Sutarto, Tempo Interaktif, 06 Maret 2008). Sedangkan menurut Kuncara (2010: 77-80) kemampuan Australia untuk membantu Indonesia dalam melaksanakan kebijakan-kebijakan dan programprogram utamanya semakin hari semakin mudah untuk dilakukan. Australia mengharapkan perkembangan ekonomi Indonesia karena hal itu dapat mempermudah dalam pembentukan jaringan antar pemerintah sekaligus kemitraan dengan Indonesia. Oleh karena itu, Pemerintah Australia mendukung program-program yang dilakukan oleh Indonesia, salah satunya melalui Strategi Kerjasama Pembangunan Australia-Indonesia Program yang diumumkan oleh Perdana Menteri Kevin Rudd saat kunjungannya ke Indonesia pada 13 Juni 2008, yang bertujuan untuk menghadapi imigrasi ilegal dan penyelundupan imigran ke Australia. Imigran gelap dan penyelundupan manusia merupakan salah satu isu yang mengancam bagi kepentingan nasional Australia. 72

84 Permasalahan ini semakin mengancam, mengingat posisi Indonesia sebagai negara transit para imigran ilegal yang ingin ke Australia. Maka dari itu, Australia sangat mendukung program kerjasama ini. Peningkatan kerjasama antara Australia-Indonesia pada masa pemerintahan Kevin Rudd sudah terlihat jelas ketika pada tahun 2007, Australia mengajak Indonesia untuk bergabung dalam inisiatif Asia Regional Trafficking in People (ARTIP). ARTIP adalah program bantuan pemerintah Australia yang dikoordinasikan oleh AusAID. Bantuan yang diberikan senilai AU$ 21 juta, yang bertujuan untuk menghentikan penyelundupan manusia di Asia Pasifik. Lebih jauh lagi, secara garis besar hubungan bilateral Australia-Indonesia pada masa pemerintahan Kevin Rudd mengalami kemajuan ke arah yang lebih baik. Hal ini juga termasuk hubungan perdagangan Australia dengan Indonesia mengalami peningkatan dari tahun ke tahun walaupun tidak dengan perdagangan Indonesia ke Australia, seperti yang tertera dalam neraca perdagangan tahun berikut ini : 73

85 4. Tabel Neraca Perdagangan Indonesia-Australia tahun (dalam US$ 000) Uraian Jan-Des Jan-Des Perubahan (%) Total perdagangan , , , ,3 24,52 Migas , , ,9 16,89 Non-migas , , , ,6 26,95 Ekspor , , , ,9 30,03 Migas , , ,9 21,16 Non migas , , , ,1 38,08 Impor , ,5 19,30 Migas , , , ,10 Non migas , , ,5 21,30 Neraca , , , ,4-184,61 perdagangan Migas , , , ,8 25,77 Non migas , , , ,2 4,03 Sumber: Kementrian Perdagangan Republik Indonesia (2010). Dari neraca perdagangan tersebut terlihat bahwa perdagangan Australia ke Indonesia semakin mengalami peningkatan. Meskipun terjadi penurunan pada tahun 2009 namun, pada tahun 2010 kembali meningkat. Berdasarkan data di atas terlihat semakin tahun pasar di Indonesia semakin berpotensi bagi Australia. Hal ini juga salah satu alasan mengapa Australia harus menjaga hubungan baiknya dengan Indonesia termasuk Australia di bawah pemerintahan Kevin Rudd. Dari pemaparan di atas, penulis berpendapat bahwa kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia di bawah pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh mengedepankan strategi diplomasi yang halus, seperti pada kunjungan Kevin Rudd beberapa kali terkait dengan Bali Forum Democracy dan juga 74

86 upayanya membebaskan warga negara Australia dari hukuman mati dengan cara bernegosiasi dan menawarkan berbagai bantuan bagi Indonesia. Pendekatan kebijakan luar negeri Rudd memiliki tipe yang sama dengan pendahulunya Whitlam, Hawke dan Keating, yakni lebih bersahabat dan menekankan pendekatan yang halus. Atau dengan kata lain, kebijakan luar negeri Australia di bawah Kevin Rudd bersifat low profile. Diplomasi Rudd dalam memainkan kebijakan luar negerinya terhadap Indonesia sangatlah baik. Perdana Menteri Rudd memilih untuk datang langsung menemui Presiden Yudhoyono untuk menyelesaikan masalah yang ada di antara kedua negara. Hal ini sangatlah berbeda jika dibandingkan dengan sikap Howard yang memilih untuk mengirim surat terkait masalah Timor Timur tahun Selanjutnya penulis menilai, jika kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia di bawah pemerintahan Howard dari Partai koalisi Liberal pada awalnya mengalami stagnasi, yang dikeranakan oleh sifat awal pemerintahan Howard yang inward looking dan kekurang pahaman Howard tentang konsep kebijakan luar negeri serta kurangnya empati Howard terhadap Asia membuat kebijakan luar negeri Howard menjauh terhadap Asia termasuk Indonesia dan lebih memilih untuk mendekat dengan AS. Selain itu, pasca krisis tahun 1997 yang melanda Asia dan juga Indonesia membuat Indonesia mengalami penurunan citra di mata dunia termasuk Australia sehingga Indonesia tidak memiliki posisi tawar terhadap Australia, hal ini membuat kebijakan luar negeri Australia di bawah Howard terhadap Indonesia bersifat high profile. 75

87 Berbeda dengan kebijakan luar negeri Howard yang awalnya mengalami keragu-raguan. Kebijakan luar negeri Rudd dari Partai Buruh telah memiliki arah yang jelas. Begitu pula dengan kebijakan luar negerinya terhadap Asia dan Indonesia yang lebih low profile dan menganggap Indonesia merupakan mitra penting Australia serta diplomasi yang sangat baik yang dimainkan oleh Rudd dalam menyelesaikan permasalahan dengan Indonesia semakin memperjelas perbedaan kebijakan luar negeri Australia pada masa pemerintahan John Howard dari Partai Koalisi Liberal dengan pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh. Pada dasarnya, tujuan politik luar negeri dari pemerintahan Howard dari Partai koalisi Liberal dan pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh yakni untuk melindungi dan meningkatkan kepentingan nasional Australia. Terkait dengan Kepentingan nasional Australia, pada Bab II penulis telah jelaskan bahwa tidak ada perbedaan antara kepentingan nasional dari pemerintahan koalisi Liberal dengan pemerintahan Buruh, namun dalam mencapai serta meningkatkan kepentingan nasional Australia kedua pemerintahan tersebut memiliki penekanan dan pendekatan yang berbeda. Hal ini menyebabkan adanya perbedaan kedua pemerintahan tersebut dalam menjalankan kebijakan luar negerinya. Meskipun begitu, ada beberapa kebijakan luar negeri yang harus dipertahankan dan tidak berubah yang bersifat fundamental bagi Australia, contohnya kerjasama keamanan dengan Indonesia dalam Lombok Treaty 2006 yang terus dipertahankan oleh pemerintahan Howard dan pemerintahan Rudd. Adanya perbedaan serta perubahan gaya dalam memainkan politik luar negeri antara pemerintahan Howard dengan pemerintahan Rudd membuat 76

88 semakin eratnya hubungan Australia-Indonesia pada masa Rudd berkuasa, walaupun sebenarnya hubungan kedua negara pada akhir masa Howard juga sudah membaik namun, terpilihnya Kevin Rudd membawa suasana dan harapan baru bagi masa depan hubungan Australia-Indonesia yang lebih erat dan tidak mudah goyah dengna isu-isu yang akan terjadi nantinya. Semakin membaiknya hubungan Australia-Indonesia juga diungkapkan wartawati radio Australia, ABC, asal Indonesia, Dian menulis bahwa sejak Howard kalah dalam Pemilu akhir 2007 lalu, sikap para pejabat dan masyarakat Australia terhadap Indonesia sangat bersahabat. Begitu pula dengan laporanlaporan media Australia tentang Indonesia pun, dirasakannya berubah dalam arti cenderung positif (Manangka 2011). Perubahan gaya kepemimpinan dari John Howard dari Partai koalisi Liberal dan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh inilah yang selanjutnya pada Bab IV akan penulis bahas. 77

89 BAB IV ANALISA PENGARUH GAYA KEPEMIMPINAN JOHN HOWARD DARI PARTAI KOALISI LIBERAL DAN KEVIN RUDD DARI PARTAI BURUH DALAM KEBIJAKAN LUAR NEGERI AUSTRALIA TERHADAP INDONESIA Pada bab ini penulis akan menganalisa pengaruh gaya kepemimpinan John Howard dari Partai koalisi Liberal dan juga Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh dalam kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia dengan menggunakan konsep kebijakan luar negeri model adaptif milik Rosenau, selain itu penulis juga mengelaborasi konsep tersebut dengan faktor-faktor internal dan eksternal dari Bhakti yang sudah penulis jelaskan pada Bab II. Pada Bab I penulis telah menjelaskan model adaptif ini melihat kebijakan luar negeri bukan hanya dipengaruhi oleh perubahan faktor eksternal dan faktor internal (perubahan struktural), namun juga dipengaruhi oleh kepemimpinan (leadership) suatu pemerintahan. Terkait dengan pemaparan penulis mengenai faktor eksternal yang mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia ialah perubahan konstelasi politik, ekonomi dan keamanan regional dan internasional. Pada Bab II dan Bab III telah dijelaskan bahwa pasca krisis 1997 yang melanda kawasan Asia termasuk Indonesia menyebabkan perubahan image dan posisi tawar dari pemerintah Indonesia (Chauvel 2004 dalam Mar iyah 2005). Pengaruh Indonesia di ASEAN 78

90 kian menurun pasca krisis tersebut dan turunnya Presiden Soeharto pada tahun Perubahan image yang dialami Indonesia membuat melemahnya hubungan Australia-Indonesia dan posisi tawar Indonesia di mata Internasional termasuk Australia yang menyebabkan Australia di bawah Howard mengambil kesempatan untuk menyelesaikan permasalahan Timor Timur. Selain krisis ekonomi pada tahun 1997, perang terhadap terorisme pasca tragedi World Trade Center di AS pada September 2001 dan juga tragedi serangkaian Bom di Indonesia juga menjadi faktor eksternal yang mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia menjadi lebih peduli terhadap Indonesia dan meningkatkan kerjasamanya dengan Indonesia. Sedangkan pada masa pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh, tidak banyak isu-isu atau masalah-masalah yang terjadi yang merubah konstelasi politik, kemanan dan ekonomi kecuali isu mengenai lingkungan dan bangkitnya Cina. Pada masa pemerintahan Kevin Rudd perkembangan konstelasi politik, keamanan dan ekonomi tidak mengalami perubahan yang drastis. Hanya ada beberapa kasus terkait dengan Indonesia yang ditinggalkan pemerinathan Howard yang pada akhirnya bisa diselesaikan dengan damai, seperti kasus Papua dan Bali Nine. Hal ini yang juga menjadi faktor mengapa kebijakan pemerintahan Kevin Rudd terhadap Indonesia semakin hari semakin erat dan membuat hubungan kedua negara bisa dikatakan stabil dan baik dari awal hingga akhir ia menjabat. Kemudian, selain faktor eksternal, faktor lain yang mempengaruhi perbedaan nuansa politik dari kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia 79

91 pada pemerintahan Howard dan pemerintahan Rudd ialah adanya pergantian pemerintahan di Australia yang termasuk dalam faktor internal. Pada Bab I penulis telah menjelaskan bahwa meskipun Perdana Menteri biasanya adalah orang yang berpengaruh dan memiliki kekuasaan yang lebih di antara anggota-anggota kabinet. Namun, perlu diketahui bahwa Perdana Menteri Australia bukanlah seorang Presiden yang terpilih dengan hak mereka sendiri. Perdana Menteri (termasuk juga Perdana Menteri Bayangan dari oposisi) adalah para pemimpin partai yang dipilih oleh anggota-anggota parlemen dari partainya. Hal ini yang menyebabkan adanya unsur ketergantungan antara Perdana Menteri dengan partai yang mengusungnya (Chauvel 1992). Pergantian dari pemerintahan John Howard yang berasal Partai koalisi Liberal kepada pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh juga menjadi sebab mengapa kebijakan kedua pemerintahan dari kedua Partai ini berbeda. Pada Bab II penulis telah menjelaskan bahwa pada dasarnya kepentingan nasional dari pemerintahan koalisi Liberal dengan pemerintahan Buruh tidaklah memiliki perbedaan. Hanya saja seperti yang telah penulis jelaskan pada Bab I dan II bahwa terdapat nuansa politik di dalam mencapai kepentingan nasional Australia (Bhakti 2008). Selain itu, perbedaan pilar-pilar kebijakan luar negeri pemerintahan koalisi Liberal dengan pemerintahan Buruh seperti yang telah penulis jelaskan pada Bab III, di mana pemerintahan koalisi Liberal hanya berpijak pada kedekatannya dengan AS menomorduakan negara-negara Asia. Sedangkan, pemerintahan Buruh lebih internasionalistik dengan memandang Asia penting tanpa mengabaikan perlindungan AS. 80

92 Hal ini terkait dengan pertama, adanya perbedaan ideologi antara Partai koalisi Liberal dengan Partai Buruh. Terkait dengan penjelasan mengenai partai politik pada Bab II bahwa Partai Buruh merupakan partai yang berideologi sosialis demokratis dalam pengertian menghendaki beberapa prinsip sosialisme yang dicapai melalui proses-proses parlementer yang demokratis. Secara formal, pemerintahan Partai Buruh ialah pelayan dari kaukus. Hal ini dapat dilihat dari pusat kekuasaan kaukus dalam menentukan menteri-menteri kabinet. Hal ini merupakan bagian dari nilai-nilai egaliter dan demokratis yang merupakan bagian intrinsik dari ideologi sosialisme demokratis, di mana pemimpin adalah the first amongst equals (pertama di antara yang sama), dan keputusan kebijakan ditentukan oleh mayoritas kaukus (Woodward 1987: 155 dalam Hamid 1999: 213). Oleh sebab itu, anggota-anggota parlemen Partai Buruh harus mengikuti aturan-aturan serta kebijakan-kebijakan partai yang telah ditetapkan dalam Konferensi Nasional (Hamid 1999: ). Selain itu menurut, Bhakti dalam wawancara dengan penulis pada 28 Maret 2011, bahwa pemerintahan Buruh memiliki Platfrom yang jelas yang menjadi pedoman dalam melakukan kebijakan domestik dan luar negeri. Lebih lanjut, Bhakti mengatakan bahwa dalam kaitannya dengan Indonesia Partai Buruh memiliki ikatan batin yang kuat dengan Indonesia, hal ini disebabkan oleh dukungan yang diberikan kepada perjuangan kemerdekaan Indonesia, baik oleh Serikat Buruh Australia maupun pemerintahan Buruh saat itu yang dipimpin oleh J.B Chifley dan Menteri Luar Negerinya Herbert Evart. 81

93 Berbeda dengan Partai Buruh yang memiliki ideologi partai yang lebih sosialis demokratis, Partai koalisi Liberal mengklaim berideologi liberal, namun pada kenyataannya Partai koalisi Liberal memiliki ideologi konservatis. Seperti yang telah penulis jelaskan pada bab II bahwa faksi dominan di partai ini ialah faksi konservatif oleh sebab itu, Partai ini juga dikenal sebagai Partai Konservatif yang memilih pendekatan historis daripada geografis dan memandang dunia ini anarkis. Hal ini membuat Partai koalisi Liberal memiliki ikatan yang kuat dengan AS dan Inggris untuk menjadi pelindung bagi Australia dalam menghadapai lingkungan luarnya. Tidak dapat dipungkiri bahwa hal itu menjadi pengaruh bagi sikap pemimpin partainya dalam memainkan kebijakan luar negeri Australia termasuk Howard. Akan tetapi, berbeda dengan Partai Buruh, anggota-anggota Partai Liberal tidak terlalu terikat pada prinsip-prinsip ideologi partai. Hal ini berdampak pada penerapan kebijakan partai, seorang anggota partai misalnya, dalam posisi apapun termasuk perdana menteri dapat bebas menafsirkan sesuai dengan kenyataan dan keadaan yang berkembang, seperti dalam Pemerintahan Partai Liberal seorang perdana menteri dapat memutuskan sendiri siapa yang akan menempati kursi kabinetnya (Hamid 1999: 232). Selanjutnya, kedua, gaya kepemimpinan Perdana Menteri ikut mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia seperti yang terlihat pada masa pemerintahan Howard dari Partai koalisi Liberal dan pemerintahan Kevin dari Partai Buruh. Menurut Malhotra (2004) hal ini disebabkan karena di dalam prakteknya kebijakan luar negeri sebagian besar dimainkan oleh Perdana Menteri (eksekutif). Senada dengan Malhotra, Smith 82

94 (1992) bahwa di Australia peran utama kebijakan luar negeri dimainkan oleh eksekutif yang memiliki hak prerogratif. Lebih lanjut, Smith menjelaskan bahwa Perdana Menteri Australia merupakan aktor utama dalam pembuatan kebijakan luar negeri. Namun demikian gaya pada tiap Perdana Menteri yang memimpin berbeda-beda. Dari penjelasan pada Bab III yang telah penulis uraikan bahwa menurut Kelly (2006) Howard merupakan seorang Perdana Menteri yang berkuasa sebagai pemula kebijakan luar negeri. Dia merupakan seorang amatir yang pada saat ia berkarir di parlemen selama 22 tahun, ia sangat dikenal dengan fokus dan ketertarikannya terhadap isu-isu domestik serta kurang memiliki perhatian terhadap dunia luas. Lebih jauh lagi, Kelly mengatakan bahwa dalam menentukan kebijakan luar negerinya ia dipandu oleh gaya dan keyakinannya. Sikap Howard merupakan campuran dari ideologinya, latar belakang, penilaian dan prasangkanya yang disatukan oleh sikapnya yang keras. Pandangan Partai Liberal adalah sintesis dari kebijakan luar negeri Australia tradisional dan sikap Howard. Sedangkan menurut Bhakti (2008) pandangan Partai Liberal biasanya memilih kedekatan sosio kultural, yakni kedekatannya dengan AS dan Inggris serta memandang bahwa dunia ini anarkis. Penulis menilai bahwa gaya kepemimpinan Howard serta cara dia memandang terhadap dunia yang membuat kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia bersifat high profile dan kurang kooperatif. Sehingga banyak masalah yang timbul yang menyebabkan hubungan kedua negara mengalami penurunan. Hal ini terlihat jelas ketika John Howard mengirim surat kepada Presiden Habibie dalam bernegosiasi tenteng masalah Timor Timur. 83

95 Berbeda dengan Howard yang berkuasa sebagai pemula dan amatir dalam pembuatan kebijakan luar negeri. Kevin Rudd merupakan seorang diplomat karir, ia juga seorang menteri luar negeri bayangan sewaktu Partai Buruh menjadi oposisi. Kebijakan luar negeri bukan hal yang asing bagi Rudd. Terbukti di dalam pemerintahannya ia sangat dominan dalam pembuatan kebijakan luar negeri. Pemerintahannya juga tidak inward looking melainkan outward looking. Selain itu, Rudd merupakan seorang yang condong terhadap Asia. Serta lebih menginginkan kemandirian politik luar negeri Australia (Gyngell 2008). Gaya kepemimpinan yang berbeda antara Howard dan Rudd terlihat pada pendekatan kebijakan luar negerinya. Howard hanya memakai satu pilar pendekatan yakni aliansi dengan AS serta skeptis terhadap organisasi-organisasi internasional dan juga pendekatan multilateral serta lebih memilih pendekatan bilateral. Sedangkan Rudd memilih tiga pendekatan yakni aliansi dengan AS, keterikatan dengan Asia, dan keterikatan dengan PBB dengan melakukan pendekatan multilateral (Kelly 2006 dan Gyngell 2008). Berbeda dengan Howard yang merupakan sintesis dari Partai Liberal, Kevin Rudd merupakan seorang pemimpin Partai Buruh yang memiliki pandangan lebih internasional dan mandiri serta memilih kedekatan dengan Asia, namun tidak berarti meninggalkan aliansinya dengan AS. Hal ini yang menyebabkan kebijakan luar negeri Australia di bawah pemerintahan Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh lebih kooperatif dan low profile dengan Indonesia. Hal ini dituangkan Rudd ketika bernegosiasi dengan Presiden SBY terkait masalah Papua dan Bali Nine, di mana Rudd mendatangi langsung Presiden SBY serta 84

96 menawarkan dan memberikan sejumlah bantuan dan kerjasama yang telah penulis jelaskan pada Bab III. Dari penjelasan di atas, penulis menilai bahwa kebijakan luar negeri Australia terhadap Indonesia pada pemerintahan Howard dari Partai koalis Liberal yang berkuasa sejak tahun 1996 hingga tahun 2007 merupakan akibat dari perubahan yang terjadi baik di lingkungan eksternalnya seperti adanya krisis di Asia pada tahun 1997 dan perubahan ancaman global pasca tragedi 11 september 2001 maupun di lingkungan internalnya seperti tuntutan media dan juga masyarakat Australia terhadap penyelesaian masalah Timor Timur dan pemberian suaka politik untuk 42 warga Papua. Selain itu persepsi, gaya kepemimpinan dan cara pandangnya terhadap Indonesia juga mempengaruhi ia dalam melakukan kebijakan. Sama halnya dengan Howard, kebijakan luar negri Australia di bawah pemerintahan Kevin Rudd ( ) berpijak pada perubahan-perubahan yang terjadi di lingkungan eksternal dan internal serta gaya kepemimpinannya Rudd juga ikut memepengaruhi. Gaya kepemimpinan, persepsi dan cara pandang John Howard yang merupakan sintesis dari Partai koalisi Liberal dan Kevin Rudd yang memiliki pandangan mandiri dan internasionalistik mempengaruhi kebijakan luar negeri Australia khususnya pada Indonesia. Hal ini dikarenakan kebijakan luar negeri Australia menurut Smith (1992: 23) sebagian besar memang dimainkan oleh Perdana Menteri yang memiliki hak prerogatif dan merupakan aktor utama dalam pembuatan kebijakan luar negeri. 85

97 Dari pemaparan di atas terlihat bahwa kebijakan luar negeri Australia bukan hanya dipengaruhi faktor-faktor internal dan eksternal. Namun, juga dipengaruhi oleh gaya kepemimpinan dari tiap Perdana Menteri. Pemaparan tersebut sejalan dengan model adaptif kebijakan luar negeri milik Rosenau, yakni kebijakan luar negeri merupakan konsekuensi dari perubahan yang terjadi di lingkungan eksternal, lingkungan internal dan juga kepemimpinan (leadership). 86

98 BAB V PENUTUP A. Kesimpulan Pergantian pemerintahan di negara manapun termasuk Australia akan berdampak terhadap perubahan kebijakan. Namun demikian, perubahan tersebut tetap berupaya untuk menjaga kebijakan pemerintahan sebelumnya baik domestik maupun kebijakan terkait lingkungan eksternalnya. Hal ini juga terlihat dalam kebijakan luar negeri Australia ketika John Howard dari Partai Koalisi Liberal digantikan oleh Kevin Rudd dari Partai Buruh. Pada dasarnya, kebijakan luar negeri kedua Perdana Menteri dari dua Partai yang berbeda ini memiliki pedoman yang sama dalam melaksanakan kebijakan luar negerinya, yakni bertujuan melindungi dan meningkatkan kepentingan nasional Australia. Namun, meski substansi dari politik luar negerinya sama ada perbedaan yang signifikan dalam nuansa penekanan pada politik luar negeri serta gaya kepemimpinan yang diambil kedua Perdana Menteri tersebut. Perbedaan tersebut pada kenyataannya sangat mempengaruhi tujuan dari politik luar negeri pemerintahan Howard dan pemerintahan Rudd. Seperti yang sudah penulis jelaskan pada Bab III bahwa Howard seorang yang amatir dalam kebijakan luar negeri yang pada masa pemerintahannya harus berhadapan dengan perubahan-perubahan situasi di lingkungan regional dan internasional dan berbagai masalah yang masih menjadi kerikil, yakni masalah Timor Timur dengan Indonesia. Sikap Howard yang kaku dan arogan terbawa dalam gayanya 87

99 memimpin dan melaksankan kebijakan luar negeri Australia. Howard merupakan seorang yang lebih memilih kedekatan dengan AS karena ia memiliki empati yang sedikit terhadap Asia. Hal ini berdampak pula terhadap kebijakan luar negeri Howard terhadap Indonesia dalam berbagai masalah yang dihadapi kedua negara. Kurangnya pemahaman akan konsepsi kebijakan luar negeri membuatnya bertindak beradasarkan keyakinnanya yang memang sangat dipengaruhi oleh pandangan Partai Koalisi Liberal yang konservatif dan kedekatannya dengan AS. Sedangkan, Kevin Rudd yang merupakan seorang Perdana Menteri dari Partai Buruh dan juga seorang diplomat karir sudah sangat mengerti tentang cara bernegosiasi, melakukan diplomasi yang baik dalam kebijakan luar negerinya terhadap Indonesia yang bertujuan untuk mencapai dan meningkatkan kepentingan nasionalnya. Selain pada masa pemerintahan Rudd perkembangan lingkungan regional dan internasional lebih stabil dibanding pada masa pemerintahan Howard, gaya kepemimpinan Rudd yang low profile memang merupakan ciri dari gaya pemerintahan Buruh yang tidak membedakannya dengan Whitlam dan Paul Keating, yakni lebih mengutamakan kerjasama dan diplomasi dalam pencapaian tujuan dan kepentingan nasional Australia serta lebih dekat ke Asia termasuk Indonesia yang merupakan negara tetangga terdekat dan terbesar Australia. 88

100 DAFTAR PUSTAKA Australian Labor Party, History. Lihat: < [20 Desember 2010]. Bhakti, Ikrar Nusa 1992, Facing the 21st Century: Trends in Australia Relations With Indonesia, The Indonesia Quarterly, vol. XX, second quarter. Bhakti, Ikrar Nusa 2001, Faktor-Faktor Yang Mempengaruhi Kebijakan Luar Negeri dan Pertahanan Australia, dalam Indonesia dalam Kebijakan Luar Negeri dan Pertahanan Australia , eds. Wuryandari, Ganewati, LIPI, Jakarta. Bhakti, Ikrar Nusa 2006, Merajut Jaring-Jaring Kerjasama Keamanan Australia- Indonesia, LIPI, Jakarta. Bhakti, Ikrar Nusa 2008, Indonesia-Australia: Tantangan dan Peluang, Jurnal Luar Negeri, vol 25, no.1. Bhakti, Ikrar Nusa & Alami, Atiqah Nur 2005, Evolusi kebijakan Pertahanan Australia ( ): dari Strategi Kontinental ke Strategi Maritim, dalam Kebijakan Pertahanan Australia dan Respon Negara-negara Asia Timur dan Selandia Baru, LIPI, Jakarta. Bhakti, Ikrar Nusa, Wuryandari, Ganewati, Muna, Riefqi 1997, Persetujuan Pemeliharaan Keamanan Republik Indonesia-Australia, LIPI, Jakarta. Bhakti, Ikrar Nusa 1996, PM Australia John Howard ke Indonesia, Tempo, 21 September. Lihat: < [20 Desember 2010]. Bhakti, Ikrar Nusa 1999, Timor-Timur di antara Indonesia dan Australia, Kontan, 20 September. Burchill, Scott 2005, The National Interest in International Theory, Palgrave Macmillan, New York, hh.3. Chauvel, Ricard 1992, Budaya dan Politik Australia, Yayasan Obor Indonesia, Jakarta. Chauvel, Richard 2004, Hubungan Bertetangga Dua Negara Demokratis: Indonesia dan Australia dalam Indonesia-Australia: Tantangan dan Kesempatan dalam Hubungan Politik Bilateral, ed. Mar iyah, Chusnul, Granit, Jakarta. 89

101 Chauvel, Richard 2004, Lingkungan Strategis Australia: Masalah Papua, dalam Indonesia-Australia: Tantangan dan Kesempatan dalam Hubungan Politik Bilateral, ed. Mar iyah, Chusnul, Granit, Jakarta. Cresswell, J.W 1998, Qualitative Inquiry and Research Design, Sage Publications Inc, California. Crithchley, Susan 1995, Hubungan Australia dengan Indonesia, UI Press, Depok. Department of Defence 1987, The Defence of Australia, Australian Government Publishing Service, Canberra. Department of Defence 1997, Australia s Strategic Policy, Commonwealth of Australia, Canberra. Department of Defence 2000, Our Future Defence Force, Commonwealth of Australia, Canberra. Department of Defence 2003, Australia s National Security, Commonwealth of Australia, Canberra. Department of Defence 2009, Defending Australia In The Asia Pacific century, Commonwealth of Australia, Canberra. Department of Foreign Affairs and Trade 1997, In the National Interest-Australia s Foreign and Trade Policy,Commonwealth of Australia, Canberra. Downer, Alexander 1998, Australia s Foreign Policy: Advancing Our National Interest, speech to the Joint Services Staff College, Canberra. Lihat: < [7 Juni 2011]. Dubes Hamzah Kembali ke Australia, Tempo Interaktif, 11 Juni. Lihat: < [17 April 2011] Evans, Gareth 1991, Australia s Foreign Relations, Melbourne University Press, Melbourne. Firth, Stewart 2005, Australia in International Politics, Allen and Unwin, Sydney. Frankel, Joseph 1979, International Relations in a Changing World, Oxford University Press. 90

102 Gyngell, Allan 2008, Ambition: The Emerging Foreign Policy of the Rudd Government, Lowy Institute for International Policy Hamid, Zulkifli 1999, Sistem Politik Australia, PT. Remaja Rosdakarya, Bandung. Hanggarini, Peni 2008, Hubungan Bilateral Australia-Indonesia Pasca 11 september 2001, Widya, Tahun 25, No.274. Lihat:< [31 Agustus 2011]. Hermawan, Yulis Purwadi 2008, Kevin Rudd dan Inovasi Baru Menghadapi Kekuatan Global dan Multilateralisme, Jurnal Luar Negeri, Vol 25, No.1. Hudson, W.J 1988, The Australian People and Foreign Policy, dalam In Persuit of National Interests: Australian Foreign Policy in the 1990s, eds. Mediansky, FA & Palfreeman, AC, Pergamon Press, Sydney Ibnudin, Agus 2010, Mencermati Geostrategis Geopolitik Indonesia, Pikiran Rakyat, 22 Maret. Juoro, Umar 2007, Kemitraan Indonesia-Pasifik Selatan, Jurnal Luar Negeri, Vol. 24, No. 23. Kedutaan Besar Republik Indonesia 2010, Profil Negara dan Kerjasama Australia. Lihat: < [13 Maret 2011]. Kelly, Paul 2006, Howard s Decade, Lowy Institute for International Policy paper 15, Longueville, Sydney. Kementrian Perdagangan Republik Indonesia 2011, Neraca Perdagangan Indonesia- Australia , Lihat: < _dagang/>. [13 Maret 2011] Komisi Penerimaan, Kebenaran dan Rekonsiliasi Timor-Leste (CAVR) 2005, Hak Penentuan Nasib Sendiri, Laporan Chega, CAVR, Dili. Kuncara, Tatra Mochamad 2010, Upaya-upaya Diplomasi Australia Terhadap Indonesia dalam Mengahadapi Imigrasi Ilegal dan Penyelundupan Imigran Gelap, Jurnal Imliah Hubungan Internasional, vol 6, No.2. 91

103 Liberal Party of Australia, Our History. Lihat: < History.aspx>. [20 Desember 2011] Lombok Treaty 2006, Newsletter, Edisi 3. Lihat: < [13 Juni 2011]. Malhotra, VK 2004, International Relations, Anmol Publications Pvt Ltd, New Delhi. Manangka, Derek 2011, Dibalik Membaiknya Australia, Inilah.com, 22 Juli. Lihat: < [23 Juli 2011]. Mar iyah 2005, Indonesia-Australia: Tantangan dan Kesempatan dalam Hubungan Politik Bilateral, Granit, Jakarta. Moon, Jeremy, Sharman, Campbell 2003, Australian Politics and Government, Cambridge University Press, Cambridge. Noor, Zainulbahar 2008, The Rudd Paradox, Suara Karya Online 8 Oktober. Lihat: < [7 Juli 2011). Parnohadiningrat, Sudjadnan 2002, Paparan Duta Besar Luar Biasa dan berkuasa Penuh Indonesia untuk Australia Sudjadnan Parnohadiningrat di depan Civitas Akademik Universitas Muhammadiyah Yogyakarta. Lihat: < [31 Agustus 2011]. Partai Buruh, Permintaan Suaka dan Kasus Bali Nine 2008, Konstelasi, Edisi ke-6 Januari. Lihat: < [16 Maret 2010]. Pudjiastuti, Tri Nuke 2006, Dinamika Persoalan Perbatasan dan Hubungannya dengan Ekonomi Politik Indonesia-Australia, dalam Kebijakan Pertahanan Australia dan Respon Negara-Negara Asia Timur dan Selandia Baru, LIPI, Jakarta. Rosenau, James N 1974, Comparing Foreign Policy: Theories, Findings, and Methods, Sage Publications, New York. Rosenau, James N 1981, The Study of Political Adaptation: Essay on the Analysis of World Politics, Nicholas Publishing, New York. 92

104 Rosenau, James N, Boyd, Gavin, Thompson, Kenneth W 1976, World Politics: An Introduction, The Free Press, New York. Rudd, Kevin 2000, Disengagement from Asia: Five Years of Foreign Policy under the Howard Government, speech to the Parlementary Labor Party Policy Committee on National Security and Trade. Lihat: < disengagement_from_asia_five_years_of_foreign_policy_under_the_howard_gov ernment?sq_design_name=text&sq_action=set_design_name>. [27 Mei 2011] Ryan, Mark 1995, Advancing Australia, The Speeches of Paul Keating, Prime Minister, Big Pictures Publications, Sydney. Siboro, J 1989, Sejarah Australia, Tarsito, Bandung. Smith, Hugh 1992, International Politics and Foreign Policy, dalam Australia in a Changing World, ed. Mediansky, FA, Maxwell Macmillan, Sydney. Sulistiyanto, Priyambudi 2010, Indonesia-Australia Relations in the Era of Democracy: The View from the Indonesian Side, Australian Journal of Political Science, vol 45, No. I, Routledge, London. Suryadinata, Leo 1998, Politik Luar Negeri Indonesia di Bawah Soeharto, LP3ES, Jakarta. Suryanarayana, P.S 2000, An Awakening Australia, The Hindu, 18 Agustus. Lihat: < [7 Juli 2011]. Sutarto 2008, MA Ubah Vonis Bali Nine jadi Seumur Hidup, Tempo Interaktif, 6 Maret. Lihat:< [16 Maret 2011]. Tewes, Alex 2005, Australia s Maritime Strategy in the 21st Century, Foreign Affairs, Defence and Trade Section, Parliement of Australia, Parliement Library, Research Brief no , Canberra. Lihat: < [12 Januari 2011]. 93

105 Thayeb, Hamzah 2008, Hubungan Indonesia-Australia Pasca Kemenangan Partai Buruh, Jurnal Luar Negeri, Vol 25, No.1. Trood, Russell 1997, Perspective on Australian Foreign Policy-1997, Australian Journal of International Affairs, Vol. 52, No. 2. Wuryandari, Ganewati 2001, Gaya dan Substansi Politik Luar Negeri Australia dalam Kebijakan Luar Negeri dan Pertahanan Australia , eds. Wuryandari, Ganewati, LIPI, Jakarta. 94

106

107 Commonwealth of Australia 2009 This work is copyright. Apart from any use as permitted under the Copyright Act 1968, no part may be reproduced by any process without prior written permission from the Department of Defence. Announcement statement may be announced to the public Secondary release may be released to the public All Defence information, whether classified or not, is protected from unauthorised disclosure under the Crimes Act Defence information may only be released in accordance with the Defence Security Manual and/or Defence Instruction (General) OPS 13-4 Release of Classified Information to Other Countries, as appropriate. ISBN:

108 ERRATA The following changes have been made to the text in this edition Page 16 Paragraph 1.7 has been amended to read: 1.7 Since 2000, we have seen the terrorist attacks on the United States in September 2001, followed by terrorist attacks across many parts of the world, including London, Madrid, Bali, Jakarta, and Mumbai. Australians were tragically killed and injured in many of these attacks. We have seen the commitment of Australian forces to Afghanistan, Iraq and the wider Middle East region, as well as closer to home in East Timor, Aceh (in response to the Indian Ocean Tsunami), Papua New Guinea (for its humanitarian assistance needs), Solomon Islands and Tonga. Page 48 Paragraph 6.19 has been amended to read: 6.19 In terms of military strategy, it means the ability to conduct independent military operations in the defence of Australia by way of controlling the air and sea approaches to Australia, and denying an adversary the ability to operate, without disruption, in our immediate neighbourhood, to the extent required to ensure the security of our territory and people. This approach is spelled out in greater detail in Chapter 7.

109 CONTENTS MINISTER S PREFACE EXECUTIVE SUMMARY Chapter One: THE GOVERNMENT S APPROACH TO DEFENCE PLANNING The Purpose of the Defence White Paper The Long-Term Nature of Defence Planning Why Do We Need a White Paper Now? Future Organisational Challenges A Comprehensive Approach to Defence Planning The Preparation of the White Paper Defence and the Australian Community Transparency in Defence Planning Chapter Two: DEFENCE AND NATIONAL SECURITY Defence and the Government s Broader Approach to National Security Force in the International System in the Twenty-First Century The Use of Military Power The Future Role of Armed Forces The Future of Major War The Future of Intra-State Conflict Threats from Non-State Global Actors Domestic Security and Emergency Response Humanitarian Assistance and Disaster Relief Chapter Three: MANAGING STRATEGIC RISK IN DEFENCE PLANNING The Limits of Military Power: Balancing Strategic Weight with Resources Managing Strategic Risk Defence Planning and Strategic Risk Management Strategic Warning Fundamental Changes in Our Strategic Outlook Strategic Hedging in Defence Planning Regular White Papers and Improved Defence Strategic Planning Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

110 Chapter Four: AUSTRALIA S STRATEGIC OUTLOOK The Global Strategic Environment The Global Economic Crisis US Strategic Primacy The Strategic Environment in the Asia-Pacific Region The Strategic Implications of the Rise of China Southeast Asia Indonesia The South Pacific and East Timor The Middle East and Africa South Asia Afghanistan Islamist Terrorism Future Military Capabilities in the Asia-Pacific Region Proliferation of Weapons of Mass Destruction New Security Concerns: Climate Change and Resource Security Chapter Five: AUSTRALIA S STRATEGIC INTERESTS What are Strategic Interests? A Secure Australia A Secure Immediate Neighbourhood Strategic Stability in the Asia-Pacific Region A Stable, Rules-Based Global Security Order Australia s Strategic Interests in Afghanistan Why Does Geography Matter to Strategy? Chapter Six: AUSTRALIA S DEFENCE POLICY Australia s Strategic Posture Defence Policy Choices Australia s Defence Policy The Likelihood of an Attack on Australia? Force Structure Implications The Australia-US Alliance and our Defence Working in Coalitions with Others The ADF s Primary Operational Environment Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

111 Chapter Seven: PRINCIPAL TASKS FOR THE ADF Deterring and Defeating Attacks on Australia Australia s Military Strategy Supporting Domestic Security and Emergency Response Efforts Contributing to Stability and Security in the South Pacific and East Timor Contributing to Military Contingencies in the Asia-Pacific Region Contributing to Military Contingencies in Support of Global Security High Intensity Land Warfare in the Middle East ADF Operations in Afghanistan Chapter Eight: THE FUTURE DEVELOPMENT OF THE ADF The White Paper Force Structure Review Making Force Structure Choices Defending Australia Forces Required for Other Tasks What Types of Forces Do We Need? Maritime Forces Land Forces Air Power Strategic Strike Information Superiority Force Projection Joint Enablers Support to Domestic Security and Emergency Response Emerging Capability Priorities Determining the Weight and Reach of our Forces Future Directions for the ADF Enhancing our Maritime Forces Enhancing and Remediating the Rest of the ADF Major Power Adversaries? Force Structuring for Wider Strategic Interests? Maintaining a Strategic Capability Advantage Force Attributes and Capability Development Principles Precise Force Application Networked Capability Operational Flexibility Fully Developed Capability Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

112 Capability Advantage Survivable and Robust Capability Interoperable Capability Cost-Effective Capability Building the Future Joint Force Superior Leadership and Professional Mastery An Improved Force Structure Development Process Chapter Nine: CAPABILITY PRIORITIES FOR FORCE 2030 Maritime Forces Submarines Surface Combatants Naval Combat Aviation Anti-Submarine Warfare Offshore Combatant Vessels Amphibious Capability Sea Logistic Support and Replenishment Support Capability Land Forces The Structure of the Army The Adaptive Army: Next Steps Land Force Survivability, Mobility and Communications Battlefield Lift Capability Fire Support Land Operations in Complex Environments Special Forces Air Power Air Combat Capability The Broader Air Combat System Maritime Surveillance and Response Air Lift Capability Strategic Strike Information Superiority Intelligence, Surveillance and Reconnaissance Situational Awareness Cyber Warfare Electronic Warfare Command, Control, Communications and Battlespace Management Building the Networked Force Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

113 Emerging Capability Priorities Space Situational Awareness and Mission Assurance Missile Defence Counter-Weapons of Mass Destruction Capabilities Future Capability Options Chapter Ten: HOW PREPARED DOES THE ADF NEED TO BE? Preparedness Force Levels and Preparedness Goals Improving Preparedness The Use of Reserves The Use of Contractors on Operations Mobilisation Chapter Eleven: ALLIANCES AND INTERNATIONAL DEFENCE RELATIONSHIPS Importance of Alliances and International Defence Relationships The US Alliance Joint Facilities The Wider Asia-Pacific Region Southeast Asia New Zealand South Pacific and East Timor South Asia The Middle East and Africa The United Kingdom Europe and NATO Multilateral Security Chapter Twelve: DEFENCE INTELLIGENCE Long-Term Strategic Warning Crisis Warning and Support to Operations Intelligence Support to Capability Development Defence s National Intelligence Role Defence Intelligence Review Defence Intelligence Capability Accountability and Oversight Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

114 Chapter Thirteen: DEFENCE MANAGEMENT AND REFORM The Need for Reform The Strategic Reform Program Improved Accountability A New Budget Management Model Improved Planning Better Managing Defence Costs Enhanced Productivity Implementing the Strategic Reform Program Chapter Fourteen: PEOPLE IN DEFENCE A Key Strategic Priority - Our People Defence s Strategic Approach to Building our Workforce Remuneration Supporting Defence Families ADF Housing and Accommodation Health and Rehabilitation Diversity Better Management - An Integrated Workforce Retention Recruitment Internal Workplace Reform Chapter Fifteen: SUPPORTING THE ADF Information and Communications Capability The Defence Estate Infrastructure Enhancements to Support Capability Defence Support Services Joint Logistics Chapter Sixteen: PROCUREMENT, SUSTAINMENT AND INDUSTRY SUPPORT Procurement Reform Smart Maintenance International Defence Materiel Relationships Industry Capacity Defence Industry Policy Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

115 Chapter Seventeen: DEFENCE SCIENCE AND TECHNOLOGY Australia s Strategic Capability Advantage: The Science and Technology Dimension The White Paper Review of Defence Science and Technology The Defence Science and Technology Organisation DSTO Support to ADF Operations DSTO Support to the Current Force Supporting Effective Capability Decision Making Long Range Defence Research Activities Building the DSTO of the Future Enhanced Governance Arrangements for the DSTO Improved DSTO Funding and Business Processes A Reinforced DSTO Workforce Delivering Defence Support to Non-Defence National Security Enhancing External Engagement Chapter Eighteen: FUNDING DEFENCE IN THE FUTURE Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

116 8 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

117 MiNiSTEr S PrEfaCE There is no greater responsibility for a national government than the defence of the nation, its people and their interests. Successfully meeting that obligation requires sound long-term planning, guided by regular and thoughtful assessments of the country s strategic outlook and potential threats to our sovereign interests. The last Defence White Paper was developed a decade ago yet the world has changed significantly over that period of time. The decade brought the terrorists attacks of September 11, 2001 in the United States and subsequent events in London, Madrid, Bali, Jakarta and more recently, Mumbai. Over the same period wars raged in Iraq and Afghanistan and fragility in Pacific Island countries grew more apparent. The nuclear ambitions of North Korea and Iran focused our minds, as did the prospect of weapons of mass destruction falling into the hands of non-state actors. Cyber warfare has emerged as a serious threat to critical infrastructure, piracy has re-emerged as a threat to maritime security and space is being used by more nations for strategic purposes. But the biggest changes to our outlook over the period have been the rise of China, the emergence of India and the beginning of the end of the so-called unipolar moment; the almost twodecade-long period in which the pre-eminence of our principal ally, the United States, was without question. The 2009 White Paper was developed in the midst of a global recession. The Government has demonstrated the premium it puts on our national security by not allowing the financial impact of the global recession on its Budget to affect its commitment to our Defence needs. This White Paper produces a substantial additional investment in the capability of our Navy,Army and Air Force. Force 2030 is a balanced force, capable of meeting every contingency the Australian Defence Force may be required to meet in the coming two decades. I thank all those who contributed to the project. It s an outcome that protects the security of all Australians. Joel Fitzgibbon Minister for Defence Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

118 10 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

119 EXECUTiVE SUMMarY Defence planning is, by its very nature, a complex and long-term business. Defence planning is one area of public policy where decisions taken in one decade have the potential to affect, for good or ill, Australia's sovereignty and freedom of action for decades to come. The Government must make careful judgements about Australia's long-term defence needs. Such judgements are even more important in times of fiscal or strategic uncertainty. The global economic crisis is the most fundamental economic challenge facing this Government. At times such as these, the Government must be fiscally responsible. It would be reckless to commit substantial new resources to Defence while uncertainty surrounding the crisis remains. This new Defence White Paper explains how the Government plans to strengthen the foundations of Australia's defence. It sets out the Government's plans for Defence for the next few years, and how it will achieve those plans. Most importantly, it provides an indication of the level of resources that the Government is planning to invest in Defence over coming years and what the Government, on behalf of the Australian people, expects in return from Defence. Ultimately, armed forces exist to provide Governments with the option to use force. Maintaining a credible defence capability is a crucial contributor to our security, as it can serve to deter potential adversaries from using force against us or our allies, partners and neighbours. It is the Government's policy that the main role of the Australian Defence Force (ADF) should continue to be an ability to engage in conventional combat against other armed forces. The ADF must also be prepared to play its part in dealing with intra-state conflict, an enduring feature, and assessed to be the most common form of conflict in the period to Australia's armed forces must also be able to contend with non-state global actors. Defence's vital role in supporting domestic security and emergency response efforts will continue, and Defence will support these areas of Commonwealth responsibility. From the outset, we need to have a clear view of how much strategic risk Australia is prepared to bear, and hence how much military power we should seek to develop. The more Australia aspires to have greater strategic influence beyond our immediate neighbourhood - that is to say the ability to exert policy influence that is underpinned by military power - the greater the level of spending on defence we need to be prepared to undertake. If we want to back up strategic influence with military power, we have to be prepared to invest the resources required, and to be confident that the security benefits outweigh those costs. As in other areas of public policy, the more balanced our portfolio of capabilities, the more we will be able to hedge and re-balance as required. The key issue is to have a solid foundation upon which to build, adapt and take advantage of opportunities. We need to review periodically and rigorously whether the mix and scale of our capabilities are appropriate to the emerging challenges in our strategic outlook. The Government intends to prepare a new Defence White Paper at intervals no greater than five years. This quinquennial White Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

120 Paper development process will be the centrepiece of the Government's new strategic risk-based approach to defence planning. Defence policy must be based on clear objectives. Not all strategic risks necessarily require our full attention, while those that are the most remote might require our fullest attention because of their potential consequences. We have to be very clear about what matters most, so that we can provision against the right risks and do not waste resources. Australia's most basic strategic interest remains the defence of Australia against direct armed attack. This includes armed attacks by other states and by non-state actors with the capacity to employ strategic capabilities, including weapons of mass destruction (WMD). This most basic strategic interest abides irrespective of the perceived intentions of others, and is a function of our geography and levels of current and future capability in the region around us. Before we attend to anything else, we must secure this strategic interest. Our next most important strategic interest is the security,stability and cohesion of our immediate neighbourhood, which we share with Indonesia, Papua New Guinea, East Timor, New Zealand and the South Pacific island states. While we have a wide range of diplomatic, economic, cultural and other links with those countries, from a strategic point of view, what matters most is that they are not a source of threat to Australia, and that no major military power, that could challenge our control of the air and sea approaches to Australia, has access to bases in our neighbourhood from which to project force against us. Beyond our immediate neighbourhood, Australia has an enduring strategic interest in the stability of the wider Asia-Pacific region, which stretches from North Asia to the Eastern Indian Ocean. In particular, we have a deep stake in the security of Southeast Asia. Strategically, our neighbours in Southeast Asia sit astride our northern approaches, through which hostile forces would have to operate in order to sustainably project force against Australia. A stable and cohesive Southeast Asia will mitigate any such threat and is in our strategic interests. More broadly, we have a deep stake in the maintenance of an Asia-Pacific regional security environment that is conducive to the peaceful resolution of problems between regional countries and can absorb the rise in strategic and military power of emerging major players. Beyond our region, Australia cannot be secure in an insecure world. We have a strategic interest in preserving an international order that restrains aggression by states against each other, and can effectively manage other risks and threats, such as the proliferation of WMD, terrorism, state fragility and failure, intra-state conflict, and the security impacts of climate change and resource scarcity. The Government has decided that Australia's defence policy should continue to be founded on the principle of self-reliance in the direct defence of Australia and in relation to our unique strategic interests, but with a capacity to do more when required, consistent with those strategic interests that we might share with others, and within the limits of our resources. This posture entails the maintenance of alliances and international defence relationships that enhance our own security and allows us to work with others when we need to pool our resources. In terms of military power, this defence policy means that we must have the capacity to: 12 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

121 act independently where we have unique strategic interests at stake, and in relation to which we would not wish to be reliant on the combat forces of any foreign power; lead military coalitions where we have shared strategic interests at stake with others, and in relation to which we would be willing to accept a leadership role, in part to compensate for the limited capacity or engagement of others; and make tailored contributions to military coalitions where we share wider strategic interests with others and are willing to accept a share of the burden in securing those interests. The principal task for the ADF is to deter and defeat armed attacks on Australia by conducting independent military operations without relying on the combat or combat support forces of other countries. This means that the ADF has to be able to control our air and sea approaches against credible adversaries in the defence of Australia, to the extent required to safeguard our territory, critical sea lanes, population and infrastructure. After ensuring the defence of Australia from direct attack, the second priority task for the ADF is to contribute to stability and security in the South Pacific and East Timor. This involves conducting military operations, in coalition with others as required, including in relation to protecting our nationals, providing disaster relief and humanitarian assistance and, on occasion, by way of stabilisation interventions. The next most important priority task for the ADF is to contribute to military contingencies in the Asia- Pacific region, including in relation to assisting our Southeast Asian partners to meet external challenges, and to meeting our alliance obligations to the United States as determined by the Australian Government at the time. The strategic transformation of the region will mean that Australia should be prepared to make contributions - including potentially substantial ones - to such military contingencies in support of our strategic interests. Finally, the ADF has to be prepared to contribute to military contingencies in the rest of the world, in support of efforts by the international community to uphold global security and a rules-based international order, where our interests align and where we have the capacity to do so. As a result of these priorities, the ADF of 2030 will need to be a more potent force in certain areas, particularly undersea warfare and anti-submarine warfare (ASW), surface maritime warfare (including air defence at sea), air superiority, strategic strike, special forces, Intelligence Surveillance and Reconnaissance (ISR), and cyber warfare. It is the Government's judgement that these are the crucial areas which require particular attention to secure our unique strategic interests. The major new direction that has emerged through consideration of current and future requirements is a significant focus on enhancing our maritime capabilities. By the mid-2030s, we will have a more potent and heavier maritime force. The Government intends to replace and expand the current fleet of six Collins class with a more capable class of submarine, replace the current Anzac class frigate with a more capable Future Frigate optimised for ASW; and enhance our capability for offshore maritime warfare, border protection and mine countermeasures. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

122 While focusing on building our maritime capabilities, the Government has also been able to make provision for the enhancement of other key elements of the ADF, including our air combat capability (by proceeding with the acquisition of fifth-generation multirole combat fighters); strike capability (through the acquisition of long-range, land-attack strike missiles); the Army's fleet of heavy protected vehicles and other land force capabilities; the capabilities of our special forces; and in the emerging area of cyber warfare. In addition, the Government has made provision for remediation of the current and projected force, by addressing crucial deficiencies and gaps that might limit the size and duration of deployments, or create unacceptable risks in some more demanding scenarios in which the weight, reach and relative combat power of major capabilities would make a crucial difference. Finally, the Government has also made provision for remediating Defence's critical 'backbone', such as facilities and infrastructure, information and communications technology (ICT) systems, and warehousing and distribution system. To give effect to this remediation and reform, the Government has endorsed a Strategic Reform Program comprising a comprehensive set of reforms that will fundamentally overhaul the entire Defence enterprise, producing efficiencies and creating savings of about $20 billion. The Strategic Reform Program will deliver Australia a genuinely strategic national advantage: savings will be reinvested in capability and Defence's call on national resources will be constrained. The Strategic Reform Program will drive efficiencies without compromising effectiveness. It draws on detailed analysis of almost every aspect of the Defence enterprise. Through the Strategic Reform Program, the Government will improve the development, procurement, maintenance and management of: military capability; ICT; the Defence estate; science and technology support; and general goods and services. Enterprise support services will be centralised, standardised and simplified. And through the introduction of an integrated workforce management system, Defence will make better use of the taxpayers' dollar by better matching the skills and competencies of its people to the jobs that need to be done. 14 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

123 ChapTEr ONE: THE GOVErNMENT'S approach TO DEfENCE PLaNNiNG The Purpose of the Defence White Paper 1.1 This new Defence White Paper explains how the Government plans to strengthen the foundations of Australia's defence so that we are ready to meet the challenges of an uncertain strategic future. It sets out the Government's future plans for Defence, and how it will achieve those plans. 1.2 In particular, this new Defence White Paper lays out the Government's future plans for the development of Force 2030, including the major capability investments that will need to be made in the coming years. Most importantly, it explains the level of resources that the Government is planning to invest in Defence over coming years and what the Government, on behalf of the Australian people, expects in return from Defence. The Long-Term Nature of Defence Planning 1.3 Defence planning is, by its very nature, a complex and long-term business. This is driven by the nature of military technology, the very long lead times involved in developing defence systems, which often take many years to acquire, the significant sums of public money involved, and not least, the complicated challenge of managing strategic risk in the face of future global and regional uncertainty. 1.4 Moreover, defence planning is one area of public policy where decisions taken in one decade have the potential to affect, for good or ill, Australia's sovereignty and freedom of action for decades to come. And, should we require defence capabilities in a crisis or conflict, they cannot be acquired overnight. 1.5 For these reasons, we have to make careful judgements about Australia's long-term defence needs. We have to clearly spell out what tasks we need Defence to be able to do, and what, and how much, is required by Defence in order to carry out these tasks. Such judgements, and the very clear guidance to Defence that results, are even more important in times of fiscal or strategic uncertainty. The global economic crisis is the most fundamental economic challenge facing this Government at the current time. Why Do We Need a White Paper Now? 1.6 Much has happened since 2000, when the last Defence White Paper was published, and more than enough to justify a new White Paper. For Australia to be well placed to meet the new strategic challenges of the 21st century, a new White Paper is essential. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

124 1.7 Since 2000, we have seen the terrorist attacks on the United States in September 2001, followed by terrorist attacks across many parts of the world, including London, Madrid, Bali, Jakarta, and Mumbai. Australians were tragically killed and injured in many of these attacks. We have seen the commitment of Australian forces to Afghanistan, Iraq and the wider Middle East region, as well as closer to home in East Timor, Aceh (in response to the Indian Ocean Tsunami), Papua New Guinea (for its humanitarian assistance needs), Solomon Islands and Tonga. 1.8 Changes in the distribution of global power have become obvious in the past decade. China's rise in economic, political and military terms has become more evident. Pronounced military modernisation in the Asia-Pacific region is having significant implications for our strategic outlook. 1.9 State fragility, including in the South Pacific and East Timor, has demanded Australia's attention. We have had to further adapt our armed forces to operate in environments where partnerships between the ADF, civilian agencies and non-government organisations have become especially important. In the past decade we have also become increasingly more conscious of the potential security impacts of changing climate patterns, resource and energy scarcity, and persistent patterns of poverty and poor governance in many parts of the world We have also seen the more evident emergence over the past decade of new areas of risk, such as cyber warfare, space warfare and the remote possibility that weapons of mass destruction (WMD) might be borne directly to Australia by long-range ballistic missiles launched short of a nuclear war - more of a risk during the Cold War - or by terrorist groups that might seek access to such destructive weapons An additional layer of complexity was added during the preparation of this White Paper by the global financial crisis that began to be felt in earnest in the latter part of The Government has, quite properly, been concerned primarily with the economic and financial implications of this crisis. The impact of the crisis on long-term security trends has also been assessed and, as appropriate, factored into defence planning. This is further discussed in Chapter 4. Future Organisational Challenges 1.12 In addition to these external challenges, Defence faces a series of organisational and resource challenges that demand long-term reform and remediation. We need to ensure that Defence's people and systems are up to the challenges we are likely to face over coming years. Recruiting and retaining the skilled people needed by Defence will require long-term and deliberate strategies in the labour market of tomorrow. Effective management of Defence's supporting systems, such as logistics, facilities, and ICT, without which there is no effective defence capability, will be critical The pressure of the higher operational tempo that Defence has experienced since 2000 has put stress on Defence's capabilities, from wear and tear on equipment to the sustained higher activity levels faced by Defence's people. Too often the tempo of current operations has taken precedence over 16 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

125 proper planning for our personnel and capability needs in the future. We need strategies to ensure that our capabilities - and especially our people - can sustain that which we ask of them Some decisions on significant aspects of Australia's defence capability must be taken over the next few years, especially in relation to the next generation of our air combat and submarine forces, each of which are multi-billion dollar decisions requiring very long lead-times for project development, acquisition and entry into service We need to address these challenges as effectively and efficiently as possible. Highly effective budget and resource management in Defence can create a strategic national advantage, freeing up resources for investment in the capabilities we need, and reducing the pressure for increased defence spending. A Comprehensive Approach to Defence Planning 1.16 The Government decided from the outset to take a comprehensive approach to the development of a Defence White Paper. Determining our strategic policy goals, and deriving from these goals broad capability priorities, are necessary but not sufficient elements of a comprehensive approach to defence planning Today, more than ever, defence planning needs to be done in a 'whole of enterprise' way, with clear links between strategy, priorities and resources.the Government decided to develop a single integrated plan for the entire Defence enterprise, based on a clear strategic framework and a realistic budget. The Preparation of the White Paper 1.18 At each key stage of the White Paper's development, the National Security Committee of Cabinet met to discuss the central issues and provide specific strategic guidance and direction First, the Government examined the foundations of our defence policy and our strategic outlook. This included consideration of a comprehensive suite of intelligence assessments, and an assessment of the threats and risks that matter most for defence planning purposes. It also examined Australia's strategic interests, as well as the role played by our alliances and international defence relationships in enhancing our security Based on that examination, the Government reviewed the appropriate roles of our armed forces, Australia's strategic posture, and the capabilities we have today and are likely to need in the future. To this end, the Government considered the results of a comprehensive force structure review, which evaluated the ability of the force structure to achieve the strategic tasks required of it and presented options to address any force structure imbalances. The outcomes of the review are outlined in this White Paper The Government also examined the critical support functions required by our armed forces, through a comprehensive analysis of the Defence enterprise, including an independent audit of the Defence Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

126 Budget undertaken by Mr George Pappas. Based on this analysis, the Government has established a blueprint for further reform within Defence, to ensure that productivity is increased and further efficiencies are found in the critical support functions, and the maximum possible level of resources are directed to the development of capability. Defence and the Australian Community 1.22 The Government sought the views of the Australian community on our defence needs through the White Paper Community Consultation Program, led by Mr Stephen Loosley. This was an extensive effort to engage Australians from all walks of life, as well as defence specialists, academics, business and industry representatives and State and Territory governments. The Report of Findings of the Community Consultation Program was released by Government on 15 April The Community Consultation Panel conducted 30 public meetings and 35 private meetings, and received 450 written submissions. These revealed a diversity of opinions about the future direction of Australia's defence policy. The Community Consultation Program found that the Australian community continues to support the concept that the ADF's primary function is to defend Australia and its interests. There is a broad consensus that the present strategic environment is relatively benign in terms of a major military threat to Australia. Given changing geostrategic circumstances, however, caution is also evident. Many in the community expect governments to maintain an effective military posture while ever the possibility of threat of attack, however remote, remains. Most Australians continue to support the alliance with the United States A significant number of people in the community agree that the ADF should have a force structure that will provide a credible deterrent and a capacity to protect Australia and our interests. Many expect that the ADF would be increasingly called upon to undertake regional stabilisation, humanitarian and disaster relief operations. This leads many to argue that Defence should be considered in a wholeof-government security context that includes aid programs and diplomacy, and contributions by nongovernment organisations The Community Consultation Panel was encouraged by the strength of the community's regard for the ADF and its personnel. Concern that the Australian Defence Force (ADF) is being stretched to unsustainable levels by a high operational tempo pervaded meetings and written submissions, and many contributors believe that generating and sustaining personnel capability would continue to demand focus and investment. The Community Consultation Panel also noted the special relationship that many communities have with Defence. There is overwhelming support for Defence's presence in regional communities and a desire to see investment in those communities and in a healthy defence industry base more generally. 18 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

127 Transparency in Defence Planning 1.26 The Government is confident that this extensive process of review and consultation has resulted in a White Paper that gives all those with an interest in Australia's defence - the Australian community at large, members of the Defence organisation (both ADF and civilian), business and industry, and Australia's allies, partners and neighbours - a comprehensive account of our approach to Defence This accounting is important from a number of perspectives.taxpayers and their elected representatives should have a clear idea of where their defence dollars are going and how the Government plans to manage strategic risks in the years ahead. Businesses with an interest in defence activities are entitled to sufficient information to guide their own investment and business planning decisions Other nations need to have a clear sense of why and how we develop our armed forces. Transparency in strategic affairs is crucial in building confidence in the international community. White Papers are valuable because they can increase the transparency of defence policymaking in ways that can help to build trust between nations. Australia needs to show by deed that it is serious about such transparency Finally, but no less importantly, members of the ADF and other parts of the Defence organisation should have a clear sense of what is expected of them. White Papers provide Defence's people with Government's policy directions, strategic priorities and expectations, offering a clear sense of the mission to which all Defence employees contribute The White Paper is written with all of these important audiences in mind. While being alert to the necessary levels of confidentiality required in relation to some aspects of defence planning, it seeks to set out the picture in as much detail as possible. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

128 ChapTEr TwO: DEfENCE and NaTiONaL SECUriTY Defence and the Government's Broader Approach to National Security 2.1 National security is concerned with ensuring Australia's freedom from attack or the threat of attack, maintaining our territorial integrity and promoting our political sovereignty, preserving our hard-won freedoms, and sustaining our fundamental capacity to advance economic prosperity for all Australians. Defence is one element of our broader approach to national security, underpinning our capacity to act in the world by providing options when Government contemplates the use of force. 2.2 This Chapter is principally concerned with how Defence contributes to our broader national security, and in particular how the Government views the use of force in the context of our national security framework. Force in the International System in the Twenty-First Century 2.3 The first and best defence of the nation lies in the maintenance of a positive international environment in which states interact to mutual advantage and sources of potential conflict are dealt with before they evolve to the point where military responses are required. 2.4 Ultimately, however, the potential use of force by states is why, at the most basic level, armed forces exist. One of the most fundamental questions that the Government addressed in considering the White Paper was the issue of the use of force in the international system. 2.5 Under the Charter of the United Nations, states are required to 'refrain, in their international relations, from the threat or use of force against the territorial integrity or political independence of any state'. However, the use of force is permitted in certain circumstances - for example, where authorised by the United Nations Security Council or in self-defence. The manner in which force is employed in those circumstances is itself subject to constraints under international law. 2.6 Australia has a proud record of contributing to the development of a post-world War II international order that seeks to restrain aggression in the international system. States should always conform to their international obligations when making decisions about the use of force, in order to establish the legal basis for that use as well as the nature and method of force used. Failure to do so could inevitably lead to a loss of legitimacy by the state, or coalition of states, using force. 2.7 As a matter of policy, the Government seeks to avoid, wherever possible, having to employ force or threaten its use. We must be especially careful to recognise that not all responses to security challenges should be military ones involving the use of force. There will be many occasions when other means provide better responses. 20 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

129 The Use of Military Power 2.8 For all of that, the Government recognises the need to maintain and, on occasion, use military power as a means to back up and give effect to Australia's policy aims. Maintaining a credible defence capability is a crucial contributor to our security, as it can serve to deter potential adversaries from using force against us or our allies, partners and neighbours. 2.9 Should Australia have to use force, we would have regard for our foreign relations and international standing, including our active membership of the United Nations and our support for a rules-based global security order Should force have to be used or threatened, it should always be employed with precision, in a manner consistent with our international obligations, with clear goals in mind, and with a clear appreciation of the long-term consequences of its use. Assessing the consequences of the use of force, and planning to secure the peace and the post-conflict environment, are vital elements of effective statecraft - and often more important than the planning and conduct of military operations. The Future Role of Armed Forces 2.11 The Government considered very carefully the question of the future role of our armed forces, what they should be structured to do, and how to balance their different potential roles - roles that place differing demands on Defence's people, systems and capabilities Traditionally, inter-state wars, involving conflict between armed forces purpose-built for engaging in conventional combat, have been the main focus of defence planning. In recent years, intra-state conflict among different political or ethnic groups has come more to the fore in places such as Afghanistan and elsewhere, where conventional military forces have had to work alongside civilian agencies and nongovernment organisations. Moreover, threats from some non-state global actors, such as al-qaeda, have meant that armed forces have had to be employed against new types of adversaries How to balance these different demands on the ADF is the subject of the following sections of this Chapter. The Future of Major War 2.14 The Government specifically considered the issue of major war and whether, after the tragedies of the twentieth century, major war has had its day. This is a crucial question for defence planning, as the answer has the potential to reshape the way in which we consider the structure and role of our armed forces War among highly advanced militaries is the most complex, and dangerous, strategic challenge faced by nations. Preparing for it requires the investment of very significant materiel, technological and human resources. If we take the view that the risk of war in the traditional sense, especially among the major powers, is remote to the point of being unthinkable, we would be able to radically change the way Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

130 we think about our armed forces. We would be able to free up at least some of the significant resources required to maintain sophisticated armed forces and use those resources for other purposes We need to make a judgement about this very carefully, because being able to fight high intensity wars, and to what degree and extent, is the most difficult judgement to make in defence planning terms. This is because being able to fight and win on your terms in high intensity wars depends ultimately on having the right force structure and military capabilities After careful examination, it is the Government's view that it would be premature to judge that war among states, including the major powers, has been eliminated as a feature of the international system. While growing economic and other interdependencies between states will act as a brake on the resort to force between them, and high-intensity wars among the major powers are not likely over the period to 2030, such wars cannot be ruled out Shows of force by rising powers are likely to become more common as their military capabilities expand. Growing economic interdependence will not preclude inter-state conflicts or tensions short of war, especially over resources or political differences. Moreover, there is a risk that the constraints on major war imposed by the international system might break down unexpectedly and relatively quickly, were it to be the case that major power interests were fundamentally at stake in a crisis, and if one or more were to miscalculate the reaction of others at such a time For these reasons, it is the Government's policy that the main role of the ADF should continue to be an ability to engage in conventional combat against other armed forces. This is not to say that the ADF cannot or will not be used for other purposes, as the following sections make clear. The Future of Intra-State Conflict 2.20 The Government considered the issue of intra-state conflict and what it means for our armed forces. It has judged this type of conflict will be an enduring feature, and the most common form, in the period to 2030 and that the ADF needs to be prepared to play its part in dealing with such contingencies ADF deployments into situations of armed conflict short of conventional war may be required. These could be in the form of humanitarian,stabilisation,counter-insurgency,peacekeeping and reconstruction interventions, such as we have undertaken over recent years in Cambodia, Namibia, Bougainville in Papua New Guinea, Somalia, Rwanda, East Timor, Solomon Islands, southern Iraq and Afghanistan In such circumstances, the ADF has a particular focus on establishing a secure environment in conflict zones. These could involve separating warring ethnic or other groups or deterring or defeating insurgents or terrorists fighting a legitimate government and intimidating local populations Our current combat operations in Afghanistan are an example of such a deployment. Like other counter-insurgency operations, Afghanistan is proving to be a protracted, intensive process. Success will be crucially dependent on ensuring that the local population is protected and separated from the insurgents, economic and social reconstruction occurs, indigenous security capacity is strengthened, insurgent networks are disrupted and the prospects for a long-term political solution are enhanced. 22 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

131 2.24 The military forces required for conventional combat against other military forces are not always well suited for conflicts within societies, where combatants may not be easily distinguishable and where military and civilian agencies need to work side-by-side to secure and rebuild broken communities The ADF will tend to be superior in combat power to most opponents encountered in such conflicts, because of its strengths in areas such as intelligence, surveillance, precision targeting, manoeuvre and firepower. But the ability of irregular opponents such as insurgents and terrorists to exploit new technologies means that, in relatively low-risk and effective ways, those groups can prevent security being established in strife-torn environments and make the delivery of essential services and longterm reconstruction difficult if not impossible As we can see in Afghanistan, security objectives in intra-state conflict situations are increasingly interdependent with broader political,humanitarian,economic and development goals.these operations require a 'whole-of-government' response on the part of military and civilian agencies, extending beyond individual agency operations, and integrating security and other objectives into comprehensive political-military strategies. The ADF's capacity to deploy rapidly and establish a basic level of security at the outset of a crisis situation will often be an essential element of any comprehensive approach - but it will, in nearly all cases, not be a sufficient response in itself In this context, it will be crucial to ensure that the ADF can work effectively alongside civilian agencies that specialise in law enforcement, development assistance, humanitarian relief, health, correctional services, municipal services (such as water and infrastructure), education, and political and administrative governance. Operations in such environments will tend to be personnel-intensive, and require a significant physical presence on the ground to provide visible reassurance to the population being protected and supported The Government is committed to building Australia's capacity in these areas to ensure that we are well placed to deal with the challenges posed by intra-state conflict. The Asia Pacific Civil-Military Centre of Excellence will inform Australia's response to these challenges through research, education and doctrine development drawn from the accumulated experience of the ADF and other parts of the Australian Government, the United Nations, other nations and non-governmental organisations. Threats from Non-State Global Actors 2.29 Beyond being equipped to deal with conventional war and intra-state conflict, increasingly our armed forces have to be able to contend with non-state global actors. Groups like al-qaeda and its associates will continue to employ terror across the globe. These groups are not necessarily the same as those to be found in intra-state conflict, although they might form partnerships, such as that between al-qaeda and the Taliban in Afghanistan. Non-state global actors would gain greater strategic significance than they currently possess were they to attain WMD. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

132 2.30 The main effort against such groups will continue to be undertaken by our law enforcement and intelligence agencies. From a defence planning perspective, ADF capabilities will have a supporting role in countering non-state opponents by assisting in their disruption and defeat where necessary. This might, for instance, take the form of operations against terrorist camps and havens, such as the ADF undertook in Afghanistan soon after the attacks on the United States in September We might need to be prepared to intercept, disrupt, and possibly destroy WMD in circumstances where civilian agencies do not have the means or reach to take appropriate action. Defence needs to be able to support such efforts and, where necessary, lead them The capabilities of the ADF provide the basis for sophisticated counter-terrorism operations against such non-state groups, especially where there might be a need for highly specialised intelligence, surveillance and reconnaissance (ISR) capabilities, or precision targeting and strike. Domestic Security and Emergency Response 2.32 Of course, our national security involves many concerns other than those involving the use of armed force. The security of our community, our nation's economy and the integrity of our environment can all be threatened by illegal activities (such as people smuggling, illegal fishing and the drug trade), by pandemic disease outbreaks and by quarantine breaches. Natural disasters such as cyclones, earthquakes, floods and bushfires can also threaten the security and safety of the Australian people The ADF and other agencies of Defence have significant capabilities that can be used to support domestic security, border protection, counter-terrorism, emergency response and disaster recovery. Defence support to these contingencies is available under either the 'Defence Assistance to the Civil Community' mechanism, or as 'Defence Force Aid to the Civilian Authority', as provided under Part IIIAAA of the Defence Act, Defence's vital role in supporting domestic security and emergency response efforts will continue, and Defence will continue to support these areas of Commonwealth responsibility. In addition, Defence will continue to provide a substantial component of the nation's air traffic management system, manage several joint-user and Defence-owned airports used by the civilian aviation sector, and provide Australia's hydrographical and maritime charting service. Humanitarian Assistance and Disaster Relief 2.34 Australia is a rich and prosperous nation. We are well placed to assist other nations in times of distress, particularly those within our immediate region. In recent years, Australia has been able to deploy defence capabilities to aid regional humanitarian assistance and disaster relief efforts. The ADF provided critical disaster recovery assistance following events such as the Boxing Day tsunami of 2004, the 2005 earthquake in Pakistan, and the floods caused by cyclone Guba in Papua New Guinea in Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

133 2.35 The Government's policy is that Defence will continue to provide a range of specialised capabilities on a scale and of a kind available from no other Australian agency. These capabilities can also be deployed in support of regional humanitarian assistance and disaster relief. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

134 ChapTEr ThrEE: MaNaGiNG STraTEGiC risk in DEfENCE PLaNNiNG The Limits of Military Power: Balancing Strategic Weight with Resources 3.1 Defence planning cannot take place in a resource-free environment. No sensible approach to defence planning simply starts with a blank sheet in budgetary terms and assumes that unlimited funds will be found to fund every capability aspiration. We need to establish very carefully, at the outset, the level of resources we can reasonably afford to devote to defence purposes. We also have to be realistic about our strategic weight and reach, our capacity to influence international affairs militarily beyond our immediate neighbourhood, and the limits of our resources, particularly in relation to the size of our population and the scale of our economy and industrial base. 3.2 The Government's ability to fund the nation's defence over the medium to long-term will be determined by the relative priority given to defence compared with other competing demands on the Commonwealth budget. Over time, it will also be constrained by a range of factors that impact on the affordability of defence spending, such as changing economic and demographic conditions, the ageing of the population, and rising health and pension costs. 3.3 Of course we should not spend less on defence than prudence would dictate, taking into account our strategic outlook and our willingness to accept only a certain degree of risk to our security. 3.4 How to balance competing national priorities is central to the Government's decisions about the future defence needs of the nation. Managing Strategic Risk 3.5 From the outset, we need to have a clear view of how much strategic risk Australia is prepared to bear, and hence how much military power we should seek to develop. The more Australia aspires to have greater strategic influence beyond our immediate neighbourhood - that is to say the ability to exert policy influence that is underpinned by military power - the greater the level of spending on defence we need to be prepared to undertake. If we want to back up strategic influence with military power, we have to be prepared to invest the resources required - and be confident that the security benefits outweigh those costs. 3.6 Alternatively, decreasing the level of investment in Defence means accepting the risk that our strategic circumstances might, in the future, deteriorate more quickly than we could develop the forces we might need to deal with such a situation. 26 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

135 3.7 The key problem in defence planning is how to take account of strategic risk. Today, Australia is one of the most physically secure countries in the world. But that does not mean we are destined forever to be secure from external threat. We have to consider the possibility of potentially adverse changes in our strategic outlook, especially in the Asia-Pacific region. The probabilities of such changes occurring are low, but not so low as to be beyond contemplation. 3.8 Such changes need not come in a rush. Over time, there may be developments that, individually, do not fundamentally alter the balance of risks we face, but cumulatively change our strategic outlook for the worse. For example, major powers with different interests from ours might steadily increase their access to facilities and operating opportunities in our approaches, though at present this is a remote prospect. Another example might be the steady acquisition by our neighbours of commercially available technologies that might materially erode our traditional strategic capability advantages. In such circumstances, we would need to assess very carefully the impacts on the ADF's ability to operate in our immediate region, and possibly adjust our plans as a consequence. 3.9 Major strategic surprises are always possible, and strategic shocks should be expected at some stage over the foreseeable future. In the early 1980s, no-one was seriously predicting the end of the Cold War or the disintegration of the Soviet Union a decade later. It would be unwise to act on the basis that there is no credible risk of the international environment changing in ways that would increase the threat of armed attack on Australia or otherwise threaten our strategic interests in significant ways. Defence Planning and Strategic Risk Management 3.10 A key element in defence planning is to establish clear parameters within which to judge risks and threats in our strategic outlook. Above all, we must decide which of these risks or threats are likely to require non-discretionary attention by Australia, and which can be managed in more selective and discretionary ways Without such a framework we are likely to respond only to the perceived risks and threats of today, leaving unattended more enduring risks. This could drive flawed force structure decisions that would have impacts over several decades. When making force structure and capability decisions it is especially important to focus not only on risks that, today, appear to be more likely than others In defence planning, as in other areas of public policy, we cannot eliminate all possibilities and risks, as resources are always going to be constrained and strategic surprises are almost certain. Strategic Warning 3.13 Strategic warning is a crucial element of defence planning. We must remain alert to developments in the world around us. Through high-quality intelligence assessment and policy development work, we are likely to get strategic warning of major changes in our strategic outlook - but not necessarily in time to build the capabilities that we might need to deal with those changes. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

136 3.14 Australia has an enduring strategic interest in ensuring that any attempt by nearby states to develop the capacity for sustained military operations against us would be detected with as much warning time as possible. This would preferably be at least a decade, given the amount of lead-time involved in building defence capabilities We can be confident of getting this amount of strategic warning time, in part because of our current level of military capability relative to our region. The threshold of military modernisation required, on the part of all but the major powers, to develop a capacity to significantly affect our strategic interests would make any such attempt detectable We also need to pay attention to military modernisation in specific capability areas.while not necessarily generating significant improvements in the capacity of others to sustain complex operations against us, such improvements could nonetheless significantly increase the demands on the ADF in other situations. As others in the region build their military capabilities, we cannot be confident that we would have long warning of changes to their ability to significantly challenge the ADF in specific capability areas. The increased prevalence of high-speed anti-ship cruise missiles and advanced torpedoes are two examples of this phenomenon. Such changes in military capability are going on all the time and we need to anticipate them and plan accordingly in our force development process. Fundamental Changes in Our Strategic Outlook 3.17 We also need to consider the circumstances of a more dramatic and, in defence planning terms, sudden deterioration in our strategic outlook. While currently unlikely, a transformation of major power relations in the Asia-Pacific region would have a profound effect on our strategic circumstances. Of particular concern would be any diminution in the willingness or capacity of the United States to act as a stabilising force In circumstances where a global transformation in economic power and commensurate redistribution of strategic power continued to the point where its cumulative effect required us to alter our assumptions about the weight and reach of US strategic primacy, the planning assumptions underpinning this White Paper would require fundamental reassessment Whatever the cause of any significant deterioration in our strategic circumstances, it would likely require a more powerful force than the one presently contemplated. The ADF required to undertake the tasks outlined in this White Paper would represent a sound basis for building such a force, particularly in relation to our strike, maritime, air combat and special forces capabilities. The Government is confident that, as a result of the decisions taken in this White Paper, it has provided a significant strategic hedge against future uncertainty. Strategic Hedging in Defence Planning 3.20 We cannot have perfect knowledge of the future, and the range of uncertainties is disconcertingly wide. As new information becomes available and we reassess our strategic outlook, we need to be prepared 28 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

137 to adjust the balance of our portfolio of capabilities and the way in which we hedge against different types of risk For example, it might become increasingly apparent over time that we have to acquire more capability in relation to the heightened risk of inter-state war. In this instance, we might acquire more advanced submarines than we are currently planning to, or more air combat fighters. Alternatively, experience might indicate a requirement for more capacity in relation to stabilisation tasks in our immediate neighbourhood, where potentially more complex operations might increasingly become a feature of our operational environment It might become evident that the risk of cyberattack is even greater than we had first thought, and so we might decide to build on a foundation in this area by further enhancing our cybersecurity capabilities. Other risks such as the development of ballistic missiles by rogue states or the acquisition of WMD by terrorists might become more pronounced, and would need to be countered. It might also become apparent that newer, smarter ways of achieving our strategic objectives are becoming available - for instance, as a result of our research and development work - such that we are able to free up resources for other purposes, or do more with the resources we have As in other areas of public policy, the more balanced our portfolio of capabilities, the more we will be able to hedge and re-balance as required. The key judgements the Government has drawn from these consideration is firstly that we need to have a solid foundation upon which to build, adapt and take advantage of opportunities. Secondly, that we need to review periodically and rigorously whether the mix and scale of our capabilities are appropriate to the emerging challenges in our strategic outlook. Regular White Papers and Improved Defence Strategic Planning 3.24 In order to periodically adjust the lens through which we view the challenges in our strategic outlook, the Government intends to prepare a new Defence White Paper at intervals no greater than five years. This quinquennial White Paper development process will be the centrepiece of the Government's new strategic risk-based approach to defence planning To ensure the development of future Defence White Papers is as comprehensive as possible, the Government intends to conduct, in the year prior to any White Paper, a formal strategic risk assessment, comprehensive force structure review, and an independent audit of the Defence enterprise to ensure the affordability of Defence plans, and the efficiency and effectiveness of resource usage by Defence. These processes will review the continued efficacy of Defence management, support and enabling functions and the affordability of Defence's future program of work. The capacity to develop regular White Papers will also be strengthened by an improved internal strategic planning process within Defence, something discussed more fully later in this White Paper. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

138 ChapTEr FOur: australia's STraTEGiC OUTLOOK 4.1 This Chapter sets out in the plainest possible terms Australia's strategic outlook and, in particular, the defence planning conclusions that have been drawn from assessments of that outlook. It is based on a comprehensive suite of White Paper intelligence assessments and a strategic risk assessment of the threats that matter most for defence planning purposes. The Global Strategic Environment 4.2 Since World War II, Australia's strategic outlook and defence planning have been shaped most fundamentally by the global distribution of power, and in particular the strategic primacy of the United States. The United States has played a stabilising role across the world and especially so in the Asia- Pacific region. This has not, of course, meant that Australia has been able to avoid attending to its own basic defence needs, something successive Australian governments have recognised since the 1970s. 4.3 Australia's strategic outlook over the coming decades will continue to be shaped by the changing global distribution of economic, political and military power, and by the future role and weight of the United States. We are not likely to see the emergence of an alternative political and economic system to rival the network of liberal, market-based democracies that emerged after World War II, as the communist system attempted to do last century during the Cold War. Globalisation will ensure that economic interdependence links states and regions together more closely. 4.4 We will, however, see changed strategic power relativities and an increasingly 'multipolar' global order, driven by changing patterns of underlying economic power and political influence. Our long-term planning will have to recognise that the range of even moderately likely strategic futures is wide. 4.5 Further complicating this picture, the convergence of trends such as global demographic change and population movements, environmental and resource pressures (whether caused by climate change or other dynamics), global public health risks and even transnational crime will increase the risk of conflict over resources, political instability in fragile states and potentially destabilising mass migration flows. Intra-state conflict, such as civil war and conflict involving non-state actors, is likely to be the most common form of conflict over the period considered by this White Paper. 4.6 Regional conflicts, such as in the Middle East and Africa, will likely continue to be a risk in the international system. Clashes between and within states in these regions are likely to arise for diverse reasons, such as the breakdown of fragile states; disputes over territory; access to resources, water 30 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

139 and energy; population movements, environmental crises or food shortages; conflicts between ethnic or religious communities; or efforts to promote ideological or nationalist goals. 4.7 Changing climate patterns, combined with booming population growth, will sharpen competition for scarce food, water and energy resources in many parts of the world, particularly in Africa and the Middle East, and are likely to exacerbate existing population and infrastructure problems in developing countries in those regions, straining their capacity to adapt and cope. Large-scale strategic consequences of climate change are, however, not likely to be felt before The Global Economic Crisis 4.8 The world is currently facing the most serious global economic and financial crisis in decades. The crisis is still unfolding, as are its strategic impacts. The strategic effects of the crisis will depend on its duration, depth and the differences in its impacts across nations and regions. The longer the crisis persists, the greater the strategic consequences could be. Many nations are facing recession or at least a dramatic slowdown in growth. Within some nations, this has already led to low levels of instability and protest. Globally, because the degree of potential economic damage will differ from nation to nation, it is possible that we could see significant shifts in relative economic power between nations over time. 4.9 Developed countries will suffer the largest reductions in growth. Those developing nations that have struggled, even in good times, to integrate into the global economy or that are heavily dependent on exports to advanced economies or remittances will be very seriously affected. Fragile and vulnerable nations, particularly in our region, maintain few significant reserves with which to buttress their economies from the crisis. Such nations may struggle to meet the demands of their citizens, and may be easier targets for foreign influence in ways that might be unfavourable to long-term strategic stability The global economic crisis also presents the potential for extremists in Southeast and South Asia, and elsewhere, to seek to capitalise on resentment fuelled by economic woes as governments struggle with diminished revenues and are forced to cut budgets, including in critical areas such as health programs, food and fuel subsidies, or even counter-terrorism activities For nations better able to weather the crisis, budgetary constraints are likely to be felt in some armament programs, within our region and globally, impacting on the longer-term trends in military modernisation that have typified the recent past. The crisis could also, with its associated uncertainty and volatility, reinforce existing insecurities. Some nations could thus respond to a more uncertain strategic environment by increasing their military budgets.within our region, these different approaches can change the relative strategic weight of nations as some nations fall further behind, while others continue ongoing, or commence new, modernisation programs The global economic crisis is likely to accelerate some established trends such as the shift of economic weight to the Asia-Pacific region. Differences in timing and strength of recovery between regions Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

140 and states could alter some economic trajectories, while continued budgetary pressure will have consequent impacts on power relativities. In the Asia-Pacific region, the likely effect of the crisis on military modernisation will be to delay planned capability acquisitions and improvements and curtail exercising and operational budgets. In Northeast Asia, China is likely to be able to continue to afford its foreshadowed core military modernisation. Over the long term, this could affect the strategic reach and global postures of the major powers. There are many potential strategic scenarios that could emerge. Any future that might see a potential contraction of US strategic presence in the Asia-Pacific region, with a requirement for allies and friends to do more in their own regions, would adversely affect Australian interests, regional stability and global security. Even so, the United States has large interests in remaining strategically engaged in the Asia-Pacific region Looking beyond the immediate challenges of this crisis, by 2030, any changes in economic power will affect the distribution of strategic power. Stability in any multipolar global order will most likely result from economic interdependence and pragmatic political cooperation among the major powers. While the potential for those powers to cooperate to manage their relationships and global stability is high, it is by no means certain. Tensions could arise. If nothing else, the potential always remains for nations to miscalculate the interests and reactions of other nations. US Strategic Primacy 4.14 The United States will remain the most powerful and influential strategic actor over the period to politically, economically and militarily. Its strategic primacy will assist in the maintenance of a stable global strategic environment. China, India, Russia, Japan and the European Union will exercise global influence in differing degrees and acquire varying levels of military strength to promote their interests While the United States will maintain the capability to project force globally from its own territory, it will likely continue to judge that its forward deployed forces, including in the Western Pacific and the Middle East, provide reassurance to allies and partners, as well as providing operational flexibility in crises Balancing the capabilities required for unconventional operations such as counter-insurgency and stabilisation, while retaining strong high-technology conventional forces, will be a major challenge for US defence planners, and the United States will continue to seek further deepening of its strategic relationships with capable potential coalition partners, such as Australia. Within the timeframe of this White Paper, the United States will continue to rely on its nuclear deterrence capability to underpin US strategic power, deter attack or coercion by other nuclear powers, and sustain allied confidence in US security commitments by way of extended deterrence Will the United States continue to play over the very long term the strategic role that it has undertaken since the end of World War II? It remains the case that no other power will have the military, economic or strategic capacity to challenge US global primacy over the period covered by this White Paper. But 32 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

141 the United States might find itself preoccupied and stretched in some parts of the world such that its ability to shift attention and project power into other regions, when it needs to, is constrained. This is likely to cause the United States to seek active assistance from regional allies and partners, including Australia, in crises, or more generally in the maintenance of stable regional security arrangements. The Strategic Environment in the Asia-Pacific Region 4.18 Economic growth in the Asia-Pacific region should help to build a sense of shared purpose and strategic interests, which in turn will assist stability and security in our wider region. While the region has enjoyed strong economic conditions since the 1997 Asian financial crisis, the global economic crisis has resulted in new challenges that will affect medium-term economic prospects, as discussed earlier Developments in our wider region are critical to our security. There are likely to be tensions between the major powers of the region, where the interests of the United States, China, Japan, India and Russia intersect. As other powers rise, and the primacy of the United States is increasingly tested, power relations will inevitably change. When this happens there will be the possibility of miscalculation. There is a small but still concerning possibility of growing confrontation between some of these powers The wider Asia-Pacific region will see the continued evolution of mechanisms aimed at building confidence among the major powers, providing tools for managing crises or misunderstandings, developing cooperative approaches to issues of regional concern, and strengthening strategic dialogue and transparency. The evolution of the security environment in Northeast Asia will turn particularly on how the strategic dynamics between the United States, China and Japan are managed over this period Japan is, and will remain, a significant military power. Within its alliance with the US, Japan is likely to expand slowly its strategic engagement, including by way of contributions to UN operations and multinational coalitions. Japan's alliance with the United States has been a key stabilising feature of the postwar regional security environment and will continue to play a vitally important role. Were Japan unable to rely on that alliance, its strategic outlook would be dramatically different, and it would be compelled to re-examine its strategic posture and capabilities A major conflict on the Korean peninsula remains a possibility, but other scenarios are more likely. Even though the North Korean regime has proven resilient, its collapse cannot be ruled out. That event would require deft management by the Korean people, but also by the major powers of the region. Any integration across the 38th parallel would be a considerable economic burden on any reunited Korean nation and other countries in the region. All states would have a common interest in assisting the Korean people to successfully manage any reunification of the peninsula. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

142 The Strategic Implications of the Rise of China 4.23 Barring major setbacks, China by 2030 will become a major driver of economic activity both in the region and globally, and will have strategic influence beyond East Asia. By some measures, China has the potential to overtake the United States as the world's largest economy around However, economic strength is also a function of trade, aid and financial flows, and by those market-exchange based measures, the US economy is likely to remain paramount The crucial relationship in the region, but also globally, will be that between the United States and China. The management of the relationship between Washington and Beijing will be of paramount importance for strategic stability in the Asia-Pacific region. Taiwan will remain a source of potential strategic miscalculation, and all parties will need to work hard to ensure that developments in relation to Taiwan over the years ahead are peaceful ones. The Government reaffirms Australia's longstanding 'One China' policy China has a significant opportunity in the decades ahead to take its place as a leading stakeholder in the development and stability of the global economic and political system. In coming years, China will develop an even deeper stake in the global economic system, and other major powers will have deep stakes in China's economic success. China's political leadership is likely to continue to appreciate the need for it to make a strong contribution to strengthening the regional security environment and the global rules-based order China will also be the strongest Asian military power, by a considerable margin. Its military modernisation will be increasingly characterised by the development of power projection capabilities. A major power of China's stature can be expected to develop a globally significant military capability befitting its size. But the pace, scope and structure of China's military modernisation have the potential to give its neighbours cause for concern if not carefully explained, and if China does not reach out to others to build confidence regarding its military plans China has begun to do this in recent years, but needs to do more. If it does not, there is likely to be a question in the minds of regional states about the long-term strategic purpose of its force development plans, particularly as the modernisation appears potentially to be beyond the scope of what would be required for a conflict over Taiwan. Southeast Asia 4.28 A secure and stable Southeast Asia is in Australia's strategic interests as neither a source of broad security threat, nor as a conduit for the projection of military power against us by others. Southeast Asia should remain largely stable, and reform-minded enough to sustain reasonable rates of development. The global financial and economic downturn is likely to impinge on political stability in regional countries to varying degrees Power relativities in Southeast Asia will shift, but less than in Northeast Asia. Southeast Asia will benefit from its proximity to China and India, but will also feel their competitive pressure. China will make 34 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

143 its presence felt through soft as well as economic power, including aid, multilateral diplomacy and extensive bilateral cultural and educational links. But China will have even more interest in convincing regional countries that its rise will not diminish their sovereignty Economic progress and social development will continue to be priorities for the countries of Southeast Asia. They will continue, in differing degrees, to be beset by security problems such as terrorism, insurgency and communal violence, but regional governments as a general rule appear to be able to contain these problems. Burma remains a serious challenge for the region with the potential for instability to spill across its borders Counter-terrorism responses in Southeast Asia will most probably continue to limit the expansion of local Islamist extremist networks; although vigilance will be required for many years yet before the threat can be declared to have diminished to negligible levels. The risk of terrorist attacks in Southeast Asia with a potential to affect Australian interests, or threaten Australians, will remain of concern for the foreseeable future. Indonesia 4.32 Indonesia has made remarkable gains in the past decade. It has managed a successful transition to multiparty democracy, embarked on the long journey of economic reform, and proven to be a strong partner in the fight against terrorism. It is likely that these positive trends will continue, and that Indonesia will continue to evolve as a stable democratic state with improved social cohesion. As the largest country in Southeast Asia, it will continue to play a crucial role in the Association of Southeast Asian Nations (ASEAN), while also seeking other avenues to play a constructive role more broadly in global affairs Although considerably less likely, a weak, fragmented Indonesia beset by intractable communal problems, poverty and failing state institutions, would potentially be a source of threat to our own security and to Indonesia's other neighbours. An authoritarian or overly nationalistic regime in Jakarta would also create strategic risks for its neighbours. Indonesia's democratic development therefore continues to be very welcome. The evolution of democracy gives Indonesia a sound foundation for long-term stability and prosperity, and positive relationships with its neighbours. This is in keeping with Australia's strategic interests. The South Pacific and East Timor 4.34 Australia is linked to the South Pacific and East Timor by shared geography and history. For both humanitarian and strategic reasons, Australia has an enduring interest in helping to build stability and prosperity in this region. Australian interests are inevitably engaged if countries in the region become vulnerable to the adverse influence of strategic competition Unfortunately, many South Pacific island states and East Timor will continue to be beset to some degree by economic stagnation and political and social instability. Weak governance, crime and social Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

144 challenges will continue to jeopardise economic development and community resilience, against a background of climate change (to which many of these states are vulnerable) and more frequent natural disasters. On occasion, these factors will cause security problems of the kind to which Australia may need to respond directly with appropriate forms of humanitarian and security assistance, including by way of ADF deployments Papua New Guinea's long-term prospects are enhanced by its significant resources and relatively large population and land area. But it faces huge challenges, including very high unemployment, criminality and rates of HIV/AIDS. Many of Papua New Guinea's basic social and economic indicators are declining from an already low base. Major efforts are required to build and maintain basic infrastructure, improve law and order, and improve education and health standards East Timor is likely to remain, for some time, challenged by significant hurdles to progress in political, security and social reform, as well as difficulties in ensuring food security, adequate infrastructure and employment. Enduring cultural and political divisions will create the conditions for potential periodic outbreaks of violence. Solomon Islands will continue to face significant political, social, economic and security challenges. Fiji, which has the resources and population base to be the most self-sufficient of the island states, is plagued by a military that illegally interferes in the democratic process. This has had serious consequences for living standards, economic prospects and the rule of law. The Middle East and Africa 4.38 The Middle East will remain violent over the period to Iran's strategic ambitions, and nuclear aspirations, will, if unchecked, be a source of instability in the region and beyond. A number of these states will enhance their defence capabilities and, in some cases, seek greater levels of security assurance from the United States. If regional Middle East peace efforts are unsuccessful, continued tensions between Israel and the Palestinians, and with its neighbours including Lebanon, will cause further turbulence in the Middle East, and may lead to conflict In Africa, there are reasonable prospects for better economic growth, governance and reduced frequency of conflict. Africa is also growing in relative importance as a source of the world's energy supplies. At the same time, economic development is likely to be uneven and insecurity and instability are likely to continue in some countries, exacerbated by environmental pressures. This will lead to calls for international assistance in addressing intra- or inter-state conflicts, either directly or through support for African peace-making and peacekeeping. The growth of Islamist extremist groups in North Africa and the Horn of Africa poses a risk to security regionally and beyond. South Asia 4.40 India's expanding economy and greater external engagement will give it a stronger voice and stake in strategic affairs. It is becoming more important economically and strategically. By some measures, India is expected to overtake Japan as the third largest global economy in around five years. Like China, it 36 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

145 will be focused on fostering development while seeking recognition as a major power with increasingly global interests. It will also seek defence capabilities commensurate with its strategic weight and widening interests, including through the modernisation of its armed forces and the maintenance of a credible nuclear arsenal Pakistan will remain a pivotally important state. Its prospects will continue to be of concern, given its possession of nuclear weapons, its centrality to success in Afghanistan and the havens for Islamist terrorist networks located in Pakistan and, however remote at present, the risk of a radical Islamist capture of the state The prospect of miscalculation between India and Pakistan leading to conflict and, in the worst case, massive escalation, remains of significant concern The Indian Ocean will have greater strategic significance in the period to It will become an increasingly important global trading thoroughfare, particularly for energy supplies between Asia and the Middle East. There are a number of significant inter-state and intra-state conflicts along its periphery that have the potential to draw in other powers. Over time, and in response to these factors as well as transnational security issues such as piracy, the Indian Ocean is likely to host a larger military (particularly naval) presence. A number of major naval powers are likely to increasingly compete for strategic advantage in this crucial maritime region. Over the period to 2030, the Indian Ocean will join the Pacific Ocean in terms of its centrality to our maritime strategy and defence planning. Afghanistan 4.44 Afghanistan will require significant international support over the next decade or more. It will remain a challenged state and a potential source of ongoing instability in the region. This weakness will have broader implications because of Afghanistan's potential as a base for global Islamist terrorism and its role in the narcotics trade Success in Afghanistan will require the implementation of a genuinely integrated political-military strategy to address security, economic reconstruction and development, and political governance issues, coupled with the conduct of effective counter-insurgency operations and the building of capable indigenous security forces. This will require sustained and coordinated engagement on the part of the coalition of nations, which includes Australia, assisting Afghanistan Any solution to the problems faced by Afghanistan will need to address the issue of insurgent safehavens located in Pakistan, and there will need to be found a comprehensive solution to the problems of cross-border movement between Afghanistan and Pakistan by al-qaeda terrorists and Taliban insurgents. Islamist Terrorism 4.47 Islamist terrorism will likely remain a destabilising component of the global security environment for at least a generation. For the foreseeable future, the most concentrated presence of terrorist groups Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

146 and activity will likely be in the Middle East, North and East Africa, and South and Central Asia, where weak states and the continued resonance of those groups' ideologies will provide them with a relatively permissive operating environment and a supply of recruits Islamist terrorism will continue to pose a direct threat to Australia and Australian interests. Due to the sustained efforts of governments and their counter-terrorism activities, the danger in Southeast Asia will probably diminish but by no means disappear. There is no margin for complacency in our efforts to combat this threat Despite its potential to cause mass casualties and catastrophic attacks on infrastructure, Islamist terrorism will continue to have inherent limitations as a strategic threat. Terrorists will keep aspiring to develop or acquire chemical, biological, radiological and even nuclear weapons. A WMD attack by a non-state actor in the coming decades cannot be ruled out A factor to be considered in Australian defence planning terms is the likely response by our allies and partners to mass casualty attacks in the United States or Europe, which could see robust coalition operations against the geographical source of the attack. In such a case, Australia would have to consider contributing military forces, as occurred in the aftermath of the attacks on the United States in September Future Military Capabilities in the Asia-Pacific Region 4.51 As the Asia-Pacific region becomes more prosperous, we will see a corresponding increase in the region's military capability, but developments will be uneven across the region. The economic growth of recent years across the region has contributed to increases in defence budgets for many regional armed forces. As nations grow and become more affluent, they also upgrade their military forces The modernisation of military forces in Asia in the recent past has been characterised by significant capital acquisition programs, which are introducing more sophisticated capabilities into the region, such as advanced air combat aircraft and submarines. The ability of some regional military forces to employ such systems will be enhanced by their acquisition of advanced communications, command, computing, ISR and electronic warfare (EW) systems. Over time, more regional militaries will be able to network a range of weapon systems and develop the operational proficiency to be able to do so in militarily effective ways However, and particularly in the light of the global economic crisis, most regional nations will be constrained in their military development programs by fiscal and technological factors. Many regional militaries will continue to be hampered by uneven supporting skills, logistics, infrastructure and sustainment. Most are only slowly developing the military, industrial and management skills necessary to convert new systems into effective capability, especially that required for the projection of military power Nonetheless, we need to be alert to the fact that regional economic growth, the changing global and regional distribution of power (and changing strategic perceptions and military priorities), the 38 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

147 development over time of industrial and management capacity, and readier access to technology, will complicate our long-term strategic planning challenge Of itself, this should not be cause for immediate concern to Australia. The more capable our regional partners, the less they will feel compelled to rely upon the strategic assistance of major powers, some of whose interests may be inimical to ours. Also, more capable partners make for more effective coalitions when we come together and work towards common objectives However, we need to remain alert to developments in military capability in the region so that we get as much warning as possible of the emergence of strategic risks, as well as developments that might pose a significant challenge to ADF activities in particular areas. Proliferation of Weapons of Mass Destruction 4.57 The number of states with WMD over the next 20 to 30 years is likely to increase, with the possible addition of Iran to the group of states with nuclear weapons, if efforts to dissuade it from moving down that path are not successful. The number of states with a 'break out' capability to rapidly produce WMD will also probably increase with the proliferation of dual-use infrastructure WMD proliferation networks will continue to operate in the face of counter-proliferation and export control regimes, and the pace of WMD proliferation is unlikely to moderate. Military power will continue to play an important role in the disruption of WMD proliferation activity, for example through maritime interdiction, consistent with the international obligations of states. But it will remain the case that the best defence against WMD proliferation will continue to be found in security assurances, including US extended deterrence, and in the efforts of law enforcement agencies, customs and export control regimes, and counter-proliferation activities It is the Government's judgement that stable nuclear deterrence will continue to be a feature of the international system for the foreseeable future, and in this context extended deterrence will continue to be viable. The challenge will be to deter rogue states of concern, some of which may develop a level of capability in terms of long-range ballistic missiles, coupled potentially with WMD warheads. Iran and North Korea, and possibly others in the future, will continue to pursue long-range ballistic missile programs that could pose a direct, though remote, risk to our own security. New Security Concerns: Climate Change and Resource Security 4.60 The Government also considered new security risks that might arise from the potential impact of climate change and resource security issues, involving future tensions over the supply of energy, food and water. These issues are likely to exacerbate already significant population, infrastructure and governance problems in developing countries, straining their capacity to adapt Uncertainty about the effects of climate change and the period of time over which potential impacts may develop makes it difficult to assess its strategic consequences. Large-scale strategic consequences Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

148 of climate change are not likely to be felt before The security effects of climate change are likely to be most pronounced where states have limited capacity to respond to environmental strains. The greater frequency of such events, together with the systemic impacts of sea-level rise, changed rainfall patterns and drought, will place greater pressure on water and food security, including on local fisheries Many countries in our immediate neighbourhood will be especially vulnerable to these effects. Countries in the Pacific may find themselves threatened by severe climatic events such as more intense cyclonic and extreme weather events. Some South Pacific nations will be placed under significant stress as a consequence of the impacts of climate change. They may require external assistance to manage the consequences of climate change, and to respond to natural or man-made humanitarian crises or disasters The main effort against such developments will of course need to be undertaken through coordinated international climate change mitigation and economic assistance strategies,and concerted international action to assure energy supply and distribution, which will need to be at the forefront of Australia's policy responses Should these and other strategies fail to mitigate the strains resulting from climate change, or resource security issues, and they exacerbate existing precursors for conflict, the Government would possibly have to use the ADF as an instrument to deal with any threats inimical to our interests It may be that the new potential sources of conflict related to our planet's changing climate, or resource scarcity, give rise to very old forms of confrontation and war, such as clashes between states over resources. From a defence planning point of view, the key issue concerns the nature of such conflicts and the implications for defence capabilities, rather than their cause. More frequent and severe natural disasters and extreme weather events will also increase demands on the ADF and other government agencies to provide humanitarian assistance and disaster relief assistance in the future. 40 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

149 ChapTEr FivE: australia's STraTEGiC interests What are "Strategic Interests"? 5.1 Defence policy must be based on clear objectives. Not all strategic risks necessarily require our full attention, while those that are the most remote might require our fullest attention because of their potential consequences. We have to be very clear about what matters most, so that we can provision against the right risks and do not waste resources. 5.2 The Government examined the issue of how best to frame clear objectives for defence planning and decided to base them on our abiding strategic interests - those that endure irrespective of specific passing threats that may complicate our outlook from time to time. Strategic interests are those national security interests that concern the structure and features of the international order that ensure our security from armed attack - and in relation to which Australia might contemplate the use of force. Strategic interests are a narrower set of interests than our national security interests, but basing our defence planning on our strategic interests helps us to secure our national security interests. 5.3 This Chapter explains the Government's decisions about Australia's strategic interests, and the defence policy settings that flow from these strategic interests. A Secure Australia 5.4 Our most basic strategic interest remains the defence of Australia against direct armed attack. This includes armed attacks by other states and by non-state actors with the capacity to employ strategic capabilities, including WMD. This most basic strategic interest abides irrespective of the perceived intentions of others, and is a function of our geography and levels of current and future capability in the region around us. Before we attend to anything else, we must secure this strategic interest. 5.5 This means that we have a fundamental interest in controlling the air and sea approaches to our continent, if necessary by defeating hostile forces in their bases or staging areas, or attacking them in transit. We also need to be able to prevent non-state actors from attacking us, particularly with strategic capabilities, using military power if we need to. Efforts against non-state actors are best led by civilian agencies, often working with international partners, but Defence can play a role in preventing or responding to such attacks. 5.6 Our strategic outlook would be altered profoundly if we were faced with the prospect of major powers with potentially inimical interests operating on a sustained basis in our air and sea approaches, or if they were otherwise able to project force against us in relatively uninhibited ways. In terms of securing Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

150 our most basic strategic interest, such developments and potentialities would be our most challenging problems from a defence planning point of view, and the ones that warrant closest scrutiny in terms of future risk-based strategic and force development planning. A Secure Immediate Neighbourhood 5.7 Our next most important strategic interest is the security, stability and cohesion of our immediate neighbourhood, which we share with Indonesia, Papua New Guinea, East Timor, New Zealand and the South Pacific island states. While we have a wide range of diplomatic, economic, cultural and other links with those countries, from a strategic point of view what matters most is that they are not a source of threat to Australia, and that no major military power that could challenge our control of the air and sea approaches to Australia has access to bases in our neighbourhood from which to project force against us. 5.8 Australia has an enduring strategic interest in preventing or mitigating any attempt by nearby states to develop the capacity to undertake sustained military operations within our approaches. That means that it would be important for any such developments to be detected with as much warning time as possible. Our military superiority in the immediate neighbourhood would increase the threshold of military modernisation required by nearby states to be able to develop such a capacity. 5.9 We would also be concerned about challenges to the stability and cohesion of our neighbours, not least because that could make them vulnerable to external influences that might be inimical to Australia's interests. Australia should continue to play a leading role in supporting internal stability and effective governance within the countries of our immediate neighbourhood, which makes sense from both a humanitarian and a strategic perspective Of particular salience in this regard is the continued stability of Indonesia, one of the most important features of our strategic outlook. It is in Australia's vital strategic interests to see a stable and cohesive Indonesia. The Government's policy remains one of strong commitment to Indonesia's territorial integrity. A weak and fragmented Indonesia would be a strategic liability for our security and would almost certainly require a heightened defence posture on Australia's part. The Government was conscious of this when considering the future development of the ADF We share many of these strategic interests with New Zealand, and maintaining a strong bilateral defence and broader security relationship with that country is itself in our strategic interests in terms of ensuring a secure immediate neighbourhood. Strategic Stability in the Asia-Pacific Region 5.12 Beyond our immediate neighbourhood, Australia has an enduring strategic interest in the stability of the wider Asia-Pacific region, which stretches from North Asia to the Eastern Indian Ocean. In particular, we have a deep stake in the security of Southeast Asia. Strategically, our neighbours in Southeast Asia sit astride our northern approaches, through which any hostile forces would have to operate in 42 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

151 order to sustainably project force against Australia. These approaches could also be used to threaten or constrain Australia's trade with the world and the supply of critical resources, such as fuels. So we would be concerned by external aggression against the nations or the critical sea lanes of the region, or the threat of strategic intrusion into the region by potentially hostile powers able to project military power against Australia. A stable and cohesive Southeast Asia will mitigate any such threat and is in our strategic interests More broadly, we have a deep stake in the maintenance of an Asia-Pacific regional security environment that is conducive to the peaceful resolution of problems between regional countries and can absorb the rise in strategic and military power of emerging major players To this end, we would be concerned about the emergence of a security environment dominated by any regional power, or powers, not committed to the same shared goals. It would be in our strategic interests in the decades ahead that no power in the Asia-Pacific region would be able to coerce or intimidate others in the region through the employment of force, or through the implied threat of force, without being deterred, checked or, if necessary, defeated by the political, economic or military responses of others in the region The Government's approach to enhancing strategic stability in the Asia-Pacific region is to work to strengthen the regional security architecture so that it embraces the United States, Japan, China, India, Indonesia and other regional states within a community that is able to engage in the full spectrum of dialogue, cooperation and action on economic and political matters, as well as future challenges related to security. The Government has proposed the development of an Asia Pacific Community by 2020 as a means of strengthening political, economic and security cooperation in the region in the long-term. Success in that endeavour will bring many benefits, not least by easing our defence planning challenges A crucial element of this approach is the continued engagement and presence in the Asia-Pacific region of the United States. The Government's judgement is that strategic stability in the region is best underpinned by the continued presence of the United States through its network of alliances and security partnerships, including with Japan, the Republic of Korea, India and Australia, and by significant levels of US military capability continuing to be located in the Western Pacific. A Stable, Rules-Based Global Security Order 5.17 Beyond our region, Australia cannot be secure in an insecure world. We have a strategic interest in preserving an international order that restrains aggression by states against each other, and can effectively manage other risks and threats, such as the proliferation of WMD, terrorism, state fragility and failure, intra-state conflict, and the security impacts of climate change and resource scarcity The United Nations and the UN Charter are central to the rules-based global security order. This means that where we are able, and within the limits of our military power, we should continue to support the Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

152 efforts of the United Nations and the international community in dealing with such problems, including through ADF deployments on occasion For a rules-based global security order to work, occasionally it is necessary to act to restore order. Within the UN context, the 'responsibility to protect' principle, which is currently at an important stage of development, holds that states are responsible for the protection of their own citizens from mass atrocities, and that the international community should encourage and assist states to exercise that authority. Australia supports the principle, and recognises that, on occasion, it may be necessary for other states to intervene, under the auspices of a UN Security Council resolution, if a state cannot or will not protect its population We also have an interest in supporting effective non-proliferation regimes, especially to counter the spread of WMD. We will continue to actively support a range of measures in this regard, including multilateral treaties, diplomatic engagement, controls over access to sensitive technologies, sanctions against states with programs of proliferation concern, intelligence cooperation, and, where required, the interdiction of illicit shipments of proliferation-sensitive technology, including by military means The global leadership role played by the United States since the end of World War II has provided the strategic underpinning for the postwar global order. Where the interests of Australia and the United States align, we should also continue to support the United States in maintaining global security, including through ADF deployments, such as those in the first Gulf War ( ) and in Afghanistan after the attacks of September This of course does not mean unconditional support for all the policies of the United States, but does imply a recognition that Australia needs to play its part in assisting the United States to deal with global security challenges. This is explained more fully in the next Chapter. Australia's Strategic Interests in Afghanistan 5.22 When it is in Australia's clear strategic interests to do so, the Government will deploy the ADF beyond our region in support of achieving our policy ends. Our commitment to operations in Afghanistan bears this out. At the time of publication of this White Paper, that deployment is our major combat commitment. We have a crucial strategic stake in the future of the conflict against global Islamist terrorism, and real strategic interests to consider We cannot insulate ourselves from the consequences that would flow if Afghanistan were again to be abandoned to a brutal Taliban regime providing haven and support to terrorist groups such as al-qaeda. The terrorist attacks in Bali and on the Australian Embassy in Jakarta were perpetrated by individuals with direct links to the terror training grounds of Afghanistan We therefore have a direct interest in denying terrorists unfettered access to training camps and operating bases in Afghanistan. By working with our partners in Afghanistan we also demonstrate that we are committed to doing our fair share to tackle global security challenges. 44 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

153 Why Does Geography Matter to Strategy? 5.25 These strategic interests are presented in geographical terms, as a hierarchy that reflects both relative priorities for action from a defence planning perspective, and our realistic capacity for influence through the employment of military power. They are interlocking - a stable rules-based global security order increases the likelihood of strategic stability in the Asia-Pacific region, which in turn makes more likely the maintenance of a secure immediate neighbourhood and ultimately a secure Australia This geographical approach to our strategic interests recognises that in military terms we have to be prepared to both act decisively close to home, while being ready where necessary to contribute further away from our shores. Close to home, it would be more likely that we would be able to do something decisive about contingencies that require military responses, and that no-one else would have as deep an interest in acting. Further away, such as in Afghanistan, it would be likely that our capacity to act decisively through military means on our own would be more limited, and others would in any event almost certainly be involved with as great, if not greater, stakes Of course, Australia might be greatly affected by developments far away, and even serious developments close to home might not always have a significant impact on Australian national life. Taking a geographical approach to our strategic interests is not to ignore any of this - it is simply to recognise that, all other things being equal, our capacity for influence and our imperative for action are going to be a function of proximity. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

154 ChapTEr Six: australia's DEfENCE POLiCY Australia's Strategic Posture 6.1 A nation's 'strategic posture' is the expression of how it seeks to secure its strategic interests, including by reducing the risk of conflict in the first place, and how it would potentially use force in relation to its strategic interests. 6.2 In terms of strategic posture, an Australian government might take the view that armed neutrality was the best approach in terms of securing its territory and people. That posture would require us to disengage from alliances, such as that which we have with the United States, and probably to increase defence expenditure significantly. 6.3 A government might alternatively take the view that it should rely predominately on the multilateral security system, with the United Nations at its pinnacle, to safeguard its territory and people, and its strategic interests. 6.4 It could take another view altogether that its strategic interests would best be secured by focusing primarily on military operations with like-minded partners against common threats, across the globe - on the implicit assumption that these partners would render assistance if our security was threatened. 6.5 It could take yet another view - the one espoused by this Government - that the most effective strategic posture continues to be a policy of self-reliance in the direct defence of Australia, as well as an ability to do more when required, consistent with our strategic interests and within the limits of our resources. Defence Policy Choices 6.6 As these choices are so fundamental, the Government has decided to explain in this White Paper why it has adopted the defence policy stance outlined in this Chapter, and why it has rejected other approaches. 6.7 The debate about Australian defence policy is often framed as being a choice between a 'continental' or 'defence of Australia' approach, and a 'global' or 'expeditionary' approach. In the Government's view, this is a false distinction that does not aid sensible defence planning. We need to combine elements of both within a policy framework which is underpinned by our strategic interests. 6.8 Why are we not able to rely solely on a 'global' or 'expeditionary' approach to secure the full range of our strategic interests? The international community has many common interests, not least in relation to the security of its member states from attack and, as explained in Chapter 5, Australia has an abiding strategic interest in the maintenance of a stable, rules-based global security order. 46 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

155 6.9 Notwithstanding substantial efforts since 1919 with the emergence of the League of Nations in the aftermath of the tragedy of World War I, and again since 1945 with the birth of the United Nations out of the cataclysm of World War II, human affairs are not yet - and might never be - at the point where nations can afford to cede to a world body the direct responsibility for the defence of their territory and people, or for securing their strategic interests What about working with other like-minded countries to maintain global security? Coalitions are becoming increasingly important means of dealing with many security challenges, including insurgencies, terrorist networks and outbreaks of political and ethnic violence. Such coalitions are vehicles by which different countries can pool their resources according to their comparative military strengths and capacity to contribute. Being willing to contribute - even modestly at times - sends a message to allies and others alike that we are prepared to shoulder common strategic burdens We need to be alert to ways in which we might be able to 'pull our weight' in terms of contributing to global security, and we have a proud record of doing so. We will have a clear interest in contributing to coalitions where such operations are likely to have a positive effect on global security, and where our strategic interests coincide. Our substantial contribution to operations in Afghanistan should be seen in this light The point, however, is that we would not make such contributions at the cost of providing for our own security. A defence policy founded on an implicit bargain that others would come to our aid with combat forces if we were threatened or attacked is simply too uncertain a basis for providing for our security and an irresponsible abrogation of Australia's strategic sovereignty By the same measure, the Government takes the view that basing our defence policy on a narrow 'defence of Australia' approach would also be an irresponsible abdication of our responsibility as a capable middle power that is able to contribute to global and regional security, including by way of military means During the preparation of this White Paper, the Government specifically considered the issue of whether effective maintenance of our alliance with the United States might to some extent depend on Australia's readiness and capacity to join coalitions to fight alongside US forces in distant theatres The Government will always weigh up very carefully any request to send the ADF to fight alongside the armed forces of the United States. We have a proud record of fighting alongside one another in many campaigns. As the United States itself would expect, we would always reserve the right to take a decision based on prevailing circumstances at the time. The Government recognises that Australia can and should play its part in assisting the United States in dealing with global and regional security challenges, and we have a demonstrated capacity and willingness to do so. However, we must never put ourselves in a position where the price of our own security is a requirement to put Australian troops at risk in distant theatres of war where we have no direct interests at stake. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

156 Australia's Defence Policy 6.16 The Government has decided that Australia's defence policy should continue to be founded on the principle of self-reliance in the direct defence of Australia and in relation to our unique strategic interests, but with a capacity to do more when required, consistent with those strategic interests that we might share with others, and within the limits of our resources.this posture entails the maintenance of alliances and international defence relationships that enhance our own security and allows us to work with others when we need to pool our resources In terms of military power, this defence policy means that we must have the capacity to: act independently where we have unique strategic interests at stake, and in relation to which we would not wish to be reliant on the combat forces of any foreign power; lead military coalitions where we have shared strategic interests at stake with others, and in relation to which we would be willing to accept a leadership role, in part to compensate for the limited capacity or engagement of others; and make tailored contributions to military coalitions where we share wider strategic interests with others and are willing to accept a share of the burden in securing those interests Central to this policy would be a capacity and willingness on Australia's part to employ military power when required to deter and defeat armed attack on Australia without relying on foreign combat or combat support forces In terms of military strategy, it means the ability to conduct independent military operations in the defence of Australia by way of controlling the air and sea approaches to Australia, and denying an adversary the ability to operate, without disruption, in our immediate neighbourhood, to the extent required to ensure the security of our territory and people. This approach is spelled out in greater detail in Chapter Decisions on our future defence needs, while guided by this posture of defence self-reliance, will need to recognise that some defence capabilities will, for practical purposes to do with the size of our defence budget and our indigenous industry base, remain beyond our reach in terms of completely independent capabilities. For example, this applies to space-based assets and some sensitive special technologies, for which we will continue to rely on our principal ally, the United States For this reason, the policy of defence self-reliance does not preclude us from relying on a degree of international support in some critical enabling functions such as intelligence and surveillance, communications, space systems, resupply and logistics Nor does defence self-reliance mean that we should not accept a degree of dependence on the global supply chain to support the ADF, except in certain areas of defence industry capability which, as explained later in this White Paper, we might need to be prepared to support in order to retain those capabilities in Australia. 48 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

157 The Likelihood of an Attack on Australia? 6.23 The policy of defence self-reliance does not represent a judgement about the likelihood of an attack on Australia. The enduring reality of our strategic outlook is that Australia will most likely remain, by virtue of our geostrategic location, a secure country over the period to We are distant from traditional theatres of conflict between the major powers, and there is an absence of any serious, enduring disputes with our neighbours that could provide a motive for an attack Our maritime approaches give us strategic depth in relation to any conventional military force that might be projected against us. The ADF's capabilities are themselves a deterrent against threats posed by all but a handful of the world's most significant military powers. Our alliances and other international defence relationships, especially with the United States, provide a vital further measure of security Attacks on Australia of an intensity and duration sufficient to seriously threaten our national way of life on an enduring basis would only be possible by forces with access to bases and facilities in our immediate neighbourhood. The likelihood of that occurring is currently very remote. Over the decades ahead, we will retain an abiding strategic interest in ensuring that this remains the case Of the positive factors in our strategic outlook, however, only our strategic geography is abiding. Defence planning must have regard not just to the intentions of others who might be able to affect our strategic interests, but to capability as well. History shows that strategic circumstances can change more rapidly than the time it would take to develop and field the capabilities required to deal with changed circumstances Australia has been a very secure country for many decades, in large measure because the wider Asia- Pacific region has enjoyed an unprecedented era of peace and stability underwritten by US strategic primacy. That order is being transformed as economic changes start to bring about changes in the distribution of strategic power. Risks resulting from escalating strategic competition could emerge quite unpredictably, and is a factor to be considered in our defence planning. Force Structure Implications 6.28 The strategic posture of self-reliance means having the forces required to address our unique strategic interests and those in relation to which we would normally take a leadership role, while keeping open our choices to make military contributions - quite substantial ones, if necessary - to efforts led by others to secure shared wider strategic interests. It does not entail taking the easy path of having elements of everything in our force structure. That would just mean that we end up spreading our resources too thinly without having the focused weight of capabilities in the areas that would matter most if we were called on to engage in hard fighting to secure our strategic interests The ability to deter or defeat armed attack on Australia will continue to be the primary force structure determinant of the ADF. As is explained later in this White Paper, this means focusing predominantly on forces that can exert air superiority and sea control in our approaches. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

158 6.30 The Government agrees with Defence's assessment that by employing the capabilities outlined in this White Paper, we could also make highly effective contributions to UN or coalition operations, in our region and elsewhere However, there may be some instances in which we would need to consider some additional capacity (for example to ensure that we could lead military coalitions to support stability and security in our immediate neighbourhood) or capability enhancements to the forces that we deploy to more lethal or complex environments, especially to increase their survivability or their ability to operate with other coalition partners. These force development and capability considerations are explained in more detail in Chapter 8 of this White Paper. The Australia-US Alliance and our Defence 6.32 Our alliances and international defence relationships are important aspects of our security arrangements and are dealt with in Chapter 11 of this White Paper. There is one aspect however of our alliance arrangements which should be explained here. Defence self-reliance means that Australia would only expect the United States to come to our aid in circumstances where we were under threat from a major power whose military capabilities were simply beyond our capacity to resist. Short of that situation, the United States would reasonably expect us to attend to our own direct security needs and, in any event, we should not expect anything less of ourselves What the alliance means for our direct security is that the associated capability, intelligence and technological partnership, at the core of the alliance, is available to support our strategic capability advantage in our immediate neighbourhood and beyond. This is indispensable to our security It also means that, for so long as nuclear weapons exist, we are able to rely on the nuclear forces of the United States to deter nuclear attack on Australia. Australian defence policy under successive governments has acknowledged the value to Australia of the protection afforded by extended nuclear deterrence under the US alliance. That protection provides a stable and reliable sense of assurance and has over the years removed the need for Australia to consider more significant and expensive defence options. Working in Coalitions with Others 6.35 For reasons spelled out earlier in this Chapter, Australia must also have the capacity to employ military power in collaboration with international allies and partners. We need to be willing to lead military coalitions when that is necessary to secure relevant shared strategic interests, and in other cases to contribute to military coalitions, when it is in our clear interest to do so To that end, it is important that we develop and maintain a network of defence partnerships as an important foundation for being able to work together when required. This includes efforts to increase the interoperability of our forces with those of selected allies and partners, such as the United States, New Zealand, and our partners in the Five Power Defence Arrangements (FPDA), which include 50 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

159 Singapore and Malaysia. These relationships are dealt with in more detail in Chapter 11. Without these efforts being pursued systematically, we would find it difficult, if not impossible, to work together effectively when it really counts Where we are the leading nation in coalition efforts, we will need to be prepared to provide the key military resources, such as logistics support, air and sea lift, and strategic communications, that make it possible for smaller nations to take part in operations, and we will need to factor this into our planning for such operations. Where we are not the leading nation, as a competent military power we would be expected to participate in coalition and multilateral operations with minimal support from the lead nation. The ADF's Primary Operational Environment 6.38 Our strategic interests and defence posture suggest a primary focus for the ADF on tasks in our geographical vicinity. To guide defence planning, the Government has decided that the ADF's primary operational environment extends from the eastern Indian Ocean to the island states of Polynesia, and from the equator to the Southern Ocean. That area contains all Australian sovereign, offshore and economic territories, such as Cocos (Keeling) Islands, Christmas Island, Heard and McDonald Islands, Macquarie Island, Norfolk Island and also waters adjacent to the Australian Antarctic Territory The sea-air gap to our north is at the strategic centre of our primary operational environment. It affords us an opportunity to detect and respond to potentially hostile military incursions at sufficiently long ranges to enable an effective response before an adversary could reach Australian mainland territory and, in particular, key population centres and major infrastructure While this affords us an ability to employ defence in depth, our strategic geography nonetheless poses major defence planning challenges. Northern Australia, with its long coastline, remote population centres, substantial economic resources, and relatively underdeveloped infrastructure, will always command a significant place in our military contingency planning. Most of Australia's reserves of oil and gas are concentrated offshore in the north-west of Australia and the Timor Sea. Many of our key resource extraction facilities are remote and would be vulnerable to interference, disruption or attack. Some of our offshore territories would also be vulnerable to harassment or attack, and their loss or occupation by an adversary would represent a major strategic setback As part of its core business, Defence will need to continue to revise and update contingency plans for the defence of Australia and its approaches, notwithstanding the imperative of managing ongoing operations. This planning work should comprehend especially difficult military problems, such as establishing sea control and air superiority in our approaches, the defence of our offshore territories and resources, and operations on and around our territory The ADF's primary operational environment is a vast area. We need to have comprehensive situational awareness and an ability to operate within this environment with decisive military effect, if required. We need to maintain a strong capability to project military power from mounting bases and forward Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

160 operating bases in northern Australia and, if required, from strategically significant offshore territories, which have enduring defence value. Our expansive strategic geography requires an expeditionary orientation on the part of the ADF at the operational level, underpinned by requisite force projection capabilities The Indian Ocean will have an increasingly strategic role to play within the ADF s primary operational environment. This will include transnational security risks, such as piracy, as well as growing strategic competition within the Indian Ocean, along its periphery, and through the straits leading to and from it. With these factors in mind, and with the centrality of the Indian Ocean s maritime trade routes to the energy security of many Asian states, Defence planners will need to focus increasingly on the operating conditions and demands of this region. More than ever before, short of war, Australian defence planning will have to contemplate operational concepts for operating in the Indian Ocean region, including with regional partners with whom we share similar strategic interests For different reasons, the waters and littoral areas of the South Pacific will remain an important component of the ADF s primary operational environment, including in relation to Australia s assisting with the security and stability of our smaller neighbours located there While we do not judge that there is a credible risk of our national interests in the Southern Ocean and the Australian Antarctic Territory being challenged such that substantial military responses might have to be contemplated over the period of this White Paper, the Government will continue to monitor the strategic implications of international developments in the Antarctic region The concept of a primary operational environment is meant to serve as a guide for Defence, so that appropriate long-term military contingency planning can take place. This area should not be considered to impose a fixed operating boundary. Depending on developments in the Asia-Pacific region over the next two decades, Australia might need to selectively project military power or demonstrate strategic presence beyond our primary operational environment. For example, this might occur in maritime Southeast Asia, should this be necessary to deter or defeat armed attacks on Australia, or protect our strategic interests in the wider Asia-Pacific region, in concert with allies and partners with whom we share similar strategic interests in meeting common security challenges. 52 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

161 ChapTEr SEvEN: PriNCiPaL TaSKS for THE adf 7.1 This Chapter takes the framework of strategic interests and defence policy settings explained in the previous two chapters and sets out the principal tasks for the ADF - in other words, what the Government requires the ADF to be able to do. The next three chapters then deal with the types of capabilities the ADF will need for the tasks being asked of it. Deterring and Defeating Attacks on Australia 7.2 The principal task for the ADF is to deter and defeat armed attacks on Australia by conducting independent military operations without relying on the combat or combat support forces of other countries. This means that the ADF has to be able to control our air and sea approaches against credible adversaries in the defence of Australia, to the extent required to safeguard our territory, critical sea lanes, population and infrastructure. As explained in Chapter 6, our strategic geography poses many defence planning challenges. A particularly difficult aspect of the ADF's principal task would be protecting our sovereignty in the offshore domain, which includes strategically significant offshore territories and economic resources in the remote north-western part of the ADF's primary operational environment. Australia's Military Strategy 7.3 Our military strategy is crucially dependent on our ability to conduct joint operations in the approaches to Australia - especially those necessary to achieve and maintain air superiority and sea control in places of our choosing. Our military strategic aim in establishing and maintaining sea and air control is to enable the manoeuvre and employment of joint ADF elements in our primary operational environment, and particularly in the maritime and littoral approaches to the continent. 7.4 Such a strategy does not necessarily entail a purely defensive or reactive approach. In operational terms, if we have to, we will need to be prepared to undertake proactive combat operations against an adversary's military bases and staging areas, and against its forces in transit, as far from Australia as possible. This might involve using our strike capabilities, including combat aircraft, long-range missiles and special forces. We will aim to control the dynamics of the conflict by setting the pace, scale and intensity of operations, by dissuading an adversary from making any attempt to escalate the conflict, and convincing them that such escalation would come at significant cost. 7.5 The ADF will, as necessary, tailor its operations such that we do not fight in a manner that sees a high rate of attrition and mass casualties among our forces. We will seek to avoid battle on unfavourable terms, apply force in a precise manner, in a way that the adversary is not expecting, and seek to overmatch at decisive points in battle. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

162 7.6 While our approach requires principally a maritime strategy, the nature of our strategic geography is such that we will also have to use conventional land forces to control our approaches, to secure offshore territories and facilities, to defeat any incursions onto Australian territory, to protect bases from which our naval and air forces operate, and potentially to deny the adversary access to staging bases. 7.7 To be able to employ these approaches, the ADF must be joint, integrated, highly deployable and equipped with the capabilities and the people to take maximum advantage of technology. For a relatively small force like the ADF, joint operations are the only way to deliver decisive outcomes. This is explained in more detail in Chapter 8 of this White Paper. Supporting Domestic Security and Emergency Response Efforts 7.8 The ADF will also need to be able to respond to an increasingly complex domestic security environment, in which the lines between traditional concepts of external and domestic security are increasingly blurred. In this context, the ADF has to be able to contribute to the deterrence and defeat of attacks by non-state actors with strategic capabilities, especially should such groups ever acquire WMD, and to support civil authorities in relation to domestic security and emergency response tasks. 7.9 Short of war or other significant military contingencies affecting our direct security, Defence ordinarily plays a supporting role in these circumstances. Contributing to Stability and Security in the South Pacific and East Timor 7.10 After ensuring the defence of Australia from direct attack, the second priority task for the ADF is to contribute to stability and security in the South Pacific and East Timor. This involves conducting military operations, in coalition with others as required, including in relation to protecting our nationals, providing disaster relief and humanitarian assistance, and on occasion by way of stabilisation interventions as occurred in East Timor in 1999 and 2006, and in Solomon Islands in Australia will continue to have particular responsibilities to assist our neighbours in dealing with humanitarian and disaster relief needs, and to support their stability and security. Given our size and resources, Australia will be expected to take a leadership role within the South Pacific if these states are overwhelmed by a natural or man-made crisis Such operations need to be very closely integrated with efforts by civilian agencies, with the ADF taking the lead particularly where there might be a need to demonstrate a willingness and capacity to employ military force, or where its substantial level of capacity is required in circumstances that are beyond that of other agencies. In other cases, the ADF will take a more secondary role, supporting other agencies. The ADF's arrangements for enhancing interoperability and coordination with the Australian Federal Police in such operations are a good example of what needs to be done to build such linkages, and Defence will do more in the area of building civil-military coordination capacity and inter-agency linkages. 54 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

163 Contributing to Military Contingencies in the Asia-Pacific Region 7.13 The next most important priority task for the ADF is to contribute to military contingencies in the Asia-Pacific region, including in relation to assisting our Southeast Asian partners to meet external challenges, and to meeting our alliance obligations to the United States as determined by the Australian Government at the time. The strategic transformation of the region over the period to 2030 will mean that Australia should be prepared to make contributions - including potentially substantial ones - to such military contingencies in support of our strategic interests Operations at the less demanding end of the scale of possible contributions include humanitarian relief, disaster recovery and, on occasion, the evacuation of our nationals. Other operations in the form of counter-terrorism, counter-piracy and resource protection assistance to regional partners, including the protection of critical sea lanes, especially in Southeast Asia, might also be contemplated At the highest end of the scale, Australia might need to be prepared to engage in conventional combat in the region, in coalition with others, in order to counter coercion or aggression against our allies and partners We have an overwhelming interest in working to avoid such conflicts, not just because of the human tragedy which they bring, but because such conflicts do not always remain limited in nature. For all of that, if our allies and partners are attacked, we may need to be prepared to go to their assistance. Any decisions on committing forces will take into account the extent to which our direct strategic interests are engaged as well as any alliance obligations that might be involved For defence planning purposes, we need to assume that we will make appropriately sized contributions to such military contingencies. Of particular relevance in this regard might be our submarine force, special forces, surface combatants and air combat capabilities In making such contributions, our planning will need to take into account our local defence needs in the event of retaliatory action being taken against us, which could not be ruled out if we are engaged in combat operations or if we are providing basing, sustainment and other support for allies and partners. This remote scenario could entail aggressive intelligence collection operations being conducted against us; missile strike, air attack, or special forces raids against Australian territory or offshore facilities; mining of our ports and maritime choke points; threats to or harassment of critical shipping between Australia and its trade partners; hostile submarine operations in our approaches and our waters; and cyberattacks on our defence, government and possibly civil information networks, among other threats. Current defence planning does not assume that Australia would be involved in such a conflict on its own. Nonetheless, in such a circumstance, the ADF needs to hold sufficient forces in and around Australia at heightened levels of readiness to meet such threats. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

164 Contributing to Military Contingencies in Support of Global Security 7.19 Finally, the ADF has to be prepared to contribute to military contingencies in the rest of the world, in support of efforts by the international community to uphold global security and a rules-based international order, where our interests align and where we have the capacity to do so Based on experience and having regard to likely future contingencies, the ADF will need to be prepared to contribute to the enforcement of sanctions imposed by the United Nations, including actions by the international community to deal with ethnic and other forms of internal strife; coalition operations, including in the Middle East and Central Asia, to counter terrorism; and the evacuation of our nationals from trouble spots In some cases, Australia might provide small, tailored contributions to such operations, utilising specialist elements such as command teams for the United Nations, logistics or communications capabilities or mine clearance expertise. On other occasions, such as occurred in the first Gulf War in , Somalia in , Rwanda in and Afghanistan in 2001, it may be in Australia's wider strategic interests to deploy more substantial forces Australia has a long and proud history of helping to keep the peace in many of the world's trouble spots. We have monitored ceasefires, provided security for the delivery of humanitarian aid, election processes and the demobilisation of belligerents, and otherwise helped to bring peace to troubled areas. Our contributions have earned widespread respect, demonstrated Australia's strong commitment to the role of multilateral institutions in promoting peace, security and international order, and reinforced Australia's standing and credibility as a good international citizen. High Intensity Land Warfare in the Middle East 7.23 The Government has decided that it is not a principal task for the ADF to be generally prepared to deploy to the Middle East, or regions such as Central and South Asia or Africa, in circumstances where it has to engage in ground operations against heavily armed adversaries located in crowded urban environments. This entails a requirement to engage in high-intensity close combat which brings with it the risk of an unsustainable level of casualties for an army the size of Australia's If, on occasion, the Government decided that it is in Australia's wider strategic interests to undertake operations in the Middle East or nearby regions, such as those operations underway in Afghanistan, Australia would do so only after the Government had satisfied itself that our forces have the necessary weapons, protection, logistic support, training, combat readiness and force preparation to ensure successful operations with the least risk to our deployed forces. Experience has shown that such operations, if prosecuted with the vigour required, are still likely to entail a significant risk of casualties, and the Australian community would have to be prepared to accept this risk. 56 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

165 ADF Operations in Afghanistan 7.25 The ADF continues to be actively engaged in combat operations in Afghanistan. It is disrupting the Taliban insurgency and hampering the Taliban's freedom of movement and influence; helping to build Afghan institutions, particularly in the security sector, by mentoring the Afghan National Army; developing infrastructure, including facilities for Afghan security forces, as well as schools, hospitals, health centres, bridges and causeways, mosques and other community-based facilities; and generally assisting in the implementation of an integrated political-military strategy in the Oruzgan province, where the ADF is deployed The ADF is making a real difference to security efforts in southern Afghanistan. These operations continue to involve tough fighting and real risk for our troops, particularly as Australia's special forces remain focused on targeting the Taliban leadership and degrading the Taliban's ability to mount attacks and move freely This deployment demonstrates that, where it is in our wider strategic interests to do so and we have at our disposal resources able to be committed, the ADF can operate effectively in support of those interests. In this case, it can do so in a complex counter-insurgency setting, involving close combat; operations among host populations; the establishment of pervasive security; the pursuit of reconstruction in challenging circumstances; the mentoring and development of indigenous security forces; and complex political-military coordination with allies and partners, in this case, our Dutch partners and the broader North Atlantic Treaty Organization (NATO) system. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

166 Chapter Eight: THE future DEVELOPMENT Of THE adf The White Paper Force Structure Review 8.1 In order to determine the nature, size and structure of the armed forces we will need in the future to undertake the tasks which were spelled out in the previous Chapter, the Government commissioned a force structure review. This was a comprehensive review of the current and projected force, evaluated against the strategic framework laid out in the previous Chapters. 8.2 The force structure review examined plausible defence planning contingencies, the capabilities required for successful operations in those contingencies, and the systems and equipment that would deliver the necessary capabilities. From that analysis, the review identified gaps in our current and projected force structure and presented options to remedy these gaps for the Government's consideration. 8.3 The Government is confident that this White Paper is informed by the most comprehensive force structure analysis ever undertaken in support of a White Paper. It provides the basis for pursuing the future development of the ADF in a strategic manner, which both creates the future force we need and remediates the most important gaps and deficiencies in the current and projected force. Making Force Structure Choices 8.4 Under the defence policy described in Chapter 6,Australia needs a force that can meet the requirement for self-reliance for our direct defence and our unique strategic interests, with a capacity to selectively do more in relation to our wider strategic interests. 8.5 This does not mean that we can take the easy option of having elements of everything in our force structure. We have to make choices in favour of focusing on those capabilities that are going to be most relevant to fighting and winning on our terms in independent operations or where we are leading coalitions. That is the point at which having the right balance of military capabilities matters most. No other capability aspiration should be countenanced if we have not developed the types of forces we need, with the necessary weight, reach and structural features, to address the mandatory requirements of securing our unique strategic interests. Defending Australia 8.6 As explained in Chapters 6 and 7, the Government has decided that Defence should focus on developing a force that meets the primary obligation to deter and defeat attacks on Australia. 58 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

167 8.7 This entails a fundamentally maritime strategy, for which Australia requires forces that can operate with decisive effect throughout the northern maritime and littoral approaches to Australia, and the ADF's primary operational environment more generally, as described in Chapter The types of operations which we would need to conduct in order to achieve this are described in more detail in Chapter 7. In summary, our military strategy will be a proactive one in which we seek to control the dynamics of a conflict, principally by way of sea control and air superiority, and also by defeating hostile forces in their bases, in staging areas, or in transit. We will use strategic strike if we have to, and land operations in our approaches. Forces Required for Other Tasks 8.9 Of course, the ADF has to be able to do more. In developing the future force, we must ensure it has sufficient capacity to do other tasks within the framework set out in this White Paper Defence has to be able to provide appropriate support to civil authorities in relation to domestic security and emergency response efforts, such as border protection and counter-terrorism. This does not necessarily create a requirement to maintain an extensive range of specialised capabilities within Defence, as these tasks are primarily the responsibility of civil authorities. Nonetheless, the Government will need to be able to call upon the full breadth of Defence capabilities, where Defence is able to provide relevant assistance In some limited cases, Defence capabilities will need to be designed for and dedicated to domestic security and emergency response tasks where they provide specialised capacities beyond the ability of other Australian Government agencies and other Australian jurisdictions to efficiently develop and maintain. For example, Defence will need to maintain specialised capabilities to deter and defeat attacks on us by non-state actors with strategic capabilities, especially should such groups acquire WMD. While civil authorities might lead initial efforts against such groups, the weight and reach of military power might ultimately have to be employed against them As explained in Chapter 7, the ADF should also be able to contribute to the stability and security of the South Pacific and East Timor, including by way of leading coalitions Such operations create a requirement for predominantly land force elements to conduct combat operations to restore and maintain order; support forces to restore essential services and to assist local populations, in concert with civilian agencies; air and sea lift; and other capabilities necessary for stabilisation and reconstruction operations. The prolonged nature of some stabilisation tasks means that we must maintain depth in certain military capabilities, to allow the rotation and sustainment of forces over time The ADF requires adequate weight and reach to carry out such tasks, and a narrow 'defence of Australia' approach would not necessarily provide sufficient capacity to do so. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

168 8.15 In terms of contributing to military contingencies in the wider Asia-Pacific region and in support of global security, the Government has decided that while the base capability of the ADF is sufficient to give us strategic options to make contributions - including potentially substantial ones - to such operations, the ADF has to be able to adapt to unfamiliar operating environments, by way of missionspecific capability enhancements and modified operational procedures, designed to increase the survivability and interoperability of our deployed forces The ADF also has to be able to undertake humanitarian assistance and disaster relief tasks in our immediate neighbourhood and beyond, and undertake other essential tasks such as the evacuation of Australian nationals from foreign trouble spots, when other Australian Government agencies are unable to fully respond due to capacity constraints or the level of risk associated with such tasks These tasks do not create a requirement for maintaining an extensive range of specialised capabilities within the ADF. The characteristics and structural features of the force we need to undertake the tasks outlined in this White Paper will generate a wide range of capabilities which can be deployed for such tasks with very little warning (for example, amphibious ships, sea and air lift, aero-medical evacuation assets, and logistics and medical support). What Types of Forces Do We Need? 8.18 Against this background, this section sets out the types of forces we need to achieve these objectives. The next section then discusses how we might best determine how much we need of each type of force structure element. The following force structure priorities are not listed necessarily in priority order but constitute the key elements the future force must contain. Maritime Forces 8.19 Major surface combatants (destroyers and frigates), submarines and other naval capabilities, supported by air combat (for air superiority and maritime strike) and maritime surveillance and response assets, are necessary to establish sea control, and to project force in our maritime environment (including for the purposes of maintaining freedom of navigation, protecting our shipping, and lifting and supporting land forces). Land Forces 8.20 Land combat, combat support and combat service support forces (such as infantry, armour, artillery, combat engineers, and aviation), which are able to operate as combined-arms teams and undertake combat in our littoral environment and territory, are necessary to secure offshore territories and facilities, defeat incursions onto Australian territory and potentially deny adversaries access to staging bases from which they could attack us. They are also required to undertake amphibious manoeuvre, and stabilisation and reconstruction operations in our immediate neighbourhood, as well as operations further afield in support of our wider interests, as determined by Government at the time. 60 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

169 8.21 The Army also generates our Special Forces capability. Highly-trained and specially equipped forces such as the Special Air Service Regiment and the Commandos, and enabling capabilities such as special forces capable rotary and fixed wing aircraft, are necessary for strategic surveillance and reconnaissance, offensive action, strategic strike missions, high-end counter-terrorism and counter- WMD operations, hostage recovery, special protection duties in high-threat environments, advanced training for indigenous forces, and other specialised roles, some of which are classified in their entirety. Air Power 8.22 The air combat capability system consists of multirole combat fighters and assets such as Airborne Early Warning and Control (AEW&C) aircraft, air-to-air refuelling aircraft, air bases, and command, control and surveillance capabilities. These capabilities are necessary for air superiority, maritime strike, long-range strategic strike, offensive air support and close air support. Air power assets are also required to conduct maritime surveillance and response; ISR tasks; strategic (inter-theatre) and operational (intra-theatre) air lift; and to otherwise establish and exploit control of the air. Strategic Strike 8.23 A variety of air combat assets, submarines, special forces, long-range land-attack missiles and, potentially, non-kinetic capabilities such as electronic attack are required to conduct land strike operations against various strategic and operational military targets, such as an adversary's operating bases, staging areas and critical military infrastructure. Information Superiority 8.24 ISR capabilities, intelligence collection and assessment systems, space-based surveillance systems including intelligence collection satellites,cyber warfare,ew,strategic communications,and battlespace management and command support systems constitute an information superiority capability. This is required to give our forces a winning edge in comprehensive situational awareness, rapid decision making, networked capabilities, and the precise application of force. Force Projection 8.25 Amphibious and sea-lift ships, strategic (inter-theatre) and operational (intra-theatre) air lift, mounting bases and forward operating bases in northern Australia and our maritime and littoral environment, major fleet bases and ports, expeditionary combat support assets, basing rights in foreign countries and other capabilities are required for strategic mobility for our forces and to provide us with the ability to project military power throughout our primary operational environment and, on occasions, beyond. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

170 Joint Enablers 8.26 Defence-wide 'baseline' enabling capabilities, such as command and control, communications, logistics, transport and movement capabilities, repair and maintenance elements, and health support, are required for all forms of operations from warfighting to humanitarian relief and disaster assistance. Support to Domestic Security and Emergency Response 8.27 This category includes all Defence capabilities which are assigned to, or purpose designed for, supporting whole-of-government border protection efforts to secure our offshore maritime domain; domestic counter-terrorism efforts; disaster relief and emergency consequence management following catastrophic natural or man-made events; and otherwise assisting civil authorities in relation to domestic security and emergency response tasks. Emerging Capability Priorities 8.28 A number of new capability areas require hedging investments, such as space capability assurance against counter-space threats, ballistic missile defence and counter-wmd capabilities (the latter in the event that a rogue state or non-state actor acquires WMD capability that is likely to threaten Australia). Determining the Weight and Reach of our Forces 8.29 These are the types of forces we need. But how much of each element do we need? What structural features and characteristics should these forces possess? To answer these questions, the force structure review examined the level of capacity and the performance levels required in each of the priority force structure areas, in order to undertake the tasks set out in this White Paper in a strategically effective manner The specific defence planning contingencies used in developing the White Paper cannot be described in detail in a public document. For one thing, it would give others, including potential adversaries, too clear a view of our operating parameters and limitations. Every nation undertakes such sensitive defence planning and wargaming, and protects official information associated with those activities The contingencies used in the White Paper process were realistic and hard-edged. They were specifically designed to stretch the ADF of the future to the limits of its operating parameters, across the spectrum of plausible operational contingencies. These encompassed the defence of Australia and its approaches (in challenging circumstances), as well as military operations in the immediate neighbourhood concerned with the security and stability of states around us, in the wider Asia-Pacific region, and in support of global security This process allowed the Government to make clearly informed choices, for today and into the future, about where to invest scarce defence funds to ensure that we are developing the force we need. 62 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

171 8.33 The Government was especially concerned to ensure that the future force will have the necessary combat weight and reach to be able to operate with decisive effect against credible adversaries, as well as the necessary structural features to be able to act independently or as a coalition leader when required, especially in critical areas such as information superiority, force projection and joint enablers which would be integral to all types of ADF operations. Future Directions for the ADF 8.34 This section summarises the new directions which the Government has set for the ADF in order to achieve its primary obligation to build Force 2030 (and remediate the current and projected force) required for the defence of Australia and its approaches, and in relation to our unique strategic interests. In doing so, it has also provided a strategic hedge against future uncertainty. The details of these decisions, as well as others regarding future capability priorities, are contained in the next Chapter As a result of the priorities contained in this White Paper, Force 2030 of the future will be a more potent force in certain areas, particularly in undersea warfare and anti-submarine warfare (ASW), surface maritime warfare (including air defence at sea), air superiority, strategic strike, special forces, ISR and cyber warfare. It is the Government's judgement that these are the crucial areas which required particular attention in this White Paper in terms of securing our unique strategic interests These decisions also address the need over the next few years to consider the long-term replacements for our major defence capabilities (including the air combat force of F-111s and F/A-18s, the Collins class submarines and the Anzac class frigates), all of which will need to be replaced over the next years. Each of these is a long-lead time, multi-billion dollar decision which should properly be taken within the context of a comprehensive strategic review, which only a White Paper can provide In addition, the Government is confident that the priorities expressed in this White Paper for remediation of critical capability and supporting infrastructure will ensure that the ADF has sufficient capacity to undertake foreseeable stabilisation and security tasks in our immediate neighbourhood. In order to ensure that this remains the case, the Government has decided to enhance some relevant capabilities, including in our land forces, and air and sea lift. Our forces could also protect themselves in undertaking such tasks, should they be contested by any credible adversary The Government is also confident that it has provided suitably for areas of Defence support to domestic security, border protection, counter-terrorism and emergency response, as well as other essential tasks such as overseas humanitarian assistance, disaster relief and the evacuation of Australian nationals. Finally, for the reasons spelled out above, the force development planning guidance provided in this White Paper will give us real military options in relation to our wider strategic interests, as the force evolves to meet the planning guidance we have articulated for Force Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

172 Enhancing our Maritime Forces 8.39 The major new direction that has emerged through our consideration of current and future requirements is a significant focus on enhancing our maritime capabilities. By the mid-2030s, we will have a heavier and more potent maritime force. The Government will double the size of the submarine force (12 more capable boats to replace the current fleet of six Collins class submarines), replace the current Anzac class frigate with a more capable Future Frigate optimised for ASW; and enhance our capability for offshore maritime warfare, border protection and mine countermeasures In the case of the submarine force,the Government takes the view that our future strategic circumstances necessitate a substantially expanded submarine fleet of 12 boats in order to sustain a force at sea large enough in a crisis or conflict to be able to defend our approaches (including at considerable distance from Australia, if necessary), protect and support other ADF assets, and undertake certain strategic missions where the stealth and other operating characteristics of highly-capable advanced submarines would be crucial. Moreover, a larger submarine force would significantly increase the military planning challenges faced by any adversaries, and increase the size and capabilities of the force they would have to be prepared to commit to attack us directly, or coerce, intimidate or otherwise employ military power against us. Enhancing and Remediating the Rest of the ADF 8.41 While focusing on building our maritime capabilities, the Government has also been able to make provision for the enhancement of other key elements of the ADF, including our air combat capability (by proceeding with the acquisition of around 100 fifth-generation multirole combat fighters); strike capability (through the acquisition of long-range, land-attack strike missiles); the Army's fleet of heavy protected vehicles and other land force capabilities; the capabilities of our special forces; and in the emerging area of cyber warfare In addition, the Government has made provision for remediation of the current and projected force, by addressing crucial deficiencies and gaps which might limit the size and duration of deployments, or create unacceptable risks in some more demanding scenarios in which the weight, reach and relative combat power of major capabilities would make a crucial difference Finally, the Government has also made provision for remediating Defence's critical 'backbone', such as facilities and infrastructure, ICT systems, warehousing and distribution systems. Major Power Adversaries? 8.44 In making these decisions, the hardest question which had to be addressed was that of determining whether the weight and reach of the ADF would have to comprehend the remote but plausible potential of confrontation with a major power adversary. The more likely this risk, the heavier the force we would need. 64 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

173 8.45 It is conceivable that, over the long period covered by this White Paper, we might have to contend with major power adversaries operating in our approaches - in the most drastic circumstance, as a consequence of a wider conflict in the Asia-Pacific region. In such a circumstance, it is not a current defence planning assumption that Australia would be involved in such a conflict on its own. But we do assume that, except in the case of nuclear attack, Australia has to provide for its own local defence needs without relying on the combat forces of other countries The Government considered such contingencies because although they are unlikely, they are not so remote as to be beyond contemplation. The weight and reach of the force the Government intends to build gives us an acceptable margin of confidence that hostile military operations in our primary operational environment can be contested effectively by the ADF. This includes circumstances where we have to attend to our local defence needs against a major power adversary in the event of our being involved in a wider conflict, and that substantial costs will be imposed on our adversaries In such circumstances, in order to defend ourselves we might also have to selectively project military power beyond the primary operational environment described in this White Paper, for instance in maritime Southeast Asia. The Government is confident that the weight and reach of the force that it intends to build will allow us to do this It is unlikely that contingencies involving major power adversaries could arise in the foreseeable future without a degree of strategic warning. As discussed in Chapter 3 and in more detail in Chapter 10, in the light of such strategic warning, we might have to adjust our strategic posture and force development plans. Force Structuring for Wider Strategic Interests? 8.49 The Government does not intend to purpose-design the ADF for those circumstances in which it might choose to make tailored contributions to military coalitions in support of our wider strategic interests. We would offer such forces as are available from the force structure outlined in this White Paper, subject to concurrency pressures and an assessment of our strategic interests. Should the operating environment and the capabilities of our coalition partners require it, appropriate missionspecific capability enhancements to increase the survivability or interoperability of our forces, over and above the ADF's base level of capacity, may be required The Government has decided that such mission-specific adjustments should not be a means by which the base capability and prescribed performance levels of the ADF are materially changed over time. Our operations in Afghanistan bear out the fact that we can make a difference in coalition operations in support of our wider strategic interests by employing and adapting the forces we need for securing our more direct strategic interests In making decisions about the ADF's force structure, the Government satisfied itself that such forces would generate a range of capabilities available for other tasks in support of our wider strategic interests. Through the process of wargaming and planning work described above, the force structure Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

174 review actively assessed the types of forces that Australia might contribute as tailored contributions to coalition operations in support of regional or global security. Those capabilities are, in the main, subsets of the forces we need to secure our most direct strategic interests For example, the capabilities which we require to assist with humanitarian and stabilisation activities in our immediate neighbourhood also provide a basis for making contributions to similar operations in other parts of the world, including counter-insurgency operations, as demonstrated by our deployment to Afghanistan. Land forces, special forces, medical and logistic support elements, ISR assets, command and communications elements, helicopters, and air and sea transport capabilities among others would, depending on the circumstances, make particularly valuable contributions. Maintaining a Strategic Capability Advantage 8.53 Giving our forces a capability advantage is both desirable and necessary if it prevents conflict, or allows us to prevail in conflict, and minimises our casualties and materiel losses This approach involves maximising our strengths and minimising our weaknesses. Among our strengths are the capacity to exploit technology and the innovative skills and capacities of our people. But Australia also faces challenges due to the inherent limits of our population size, infrastructure and economic resources; and a lack of 'mass' in our armed forces in comparison to the armed forces of some other nations Australia therefore seeks to develop and maintain a capability advantage that can provide a bulwark against strategic uncertainty, makes up for our weaknesses, and reduces the risk of attrition of Australia's limited forces. This approach has been central to Australian defence planning for over 40 years and is accepted in these terms by our neighbours Military modernisation, particularly in the Asia-Pacific region, and the proliferation of advanced military technologies will mean that Australia's ability to maintain a capability advantage will come under increasing challenge. We will have to work harder to ensure that we maintain a capability advantage in the areas that matter most To this end, Defence will explicitly plan to maintain a strategic capability advantage, and to achieve it through capability development strategies, self-reliant defence research, development and innovation, and collaborative programs with scientifically and technologically capable partners. This will include a continued focus on new advanced technologies and their exploitation and application. This aspect is further dealt with in Chapter 17. Force Attributes and Capability Development Principles 8.58 To guide the development of Force 2030, the Government has identified a number of force attributes and capability development principles, which are described below. 66 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

175 Precise Force Application 8.59 The goal for future ADF operations is to achieve precise effects, especially in the discriminate application of kinetic and non-kinetic force, which should seek to minimise unintended consequences to the greatest extent possible. Enhanced precision targeting and discrimination technologies, systems and processes will be especially important in this regard. Achieving precise effects will require the employment of reliable means to locate and identify hostile, friendly and neutral forces, conduct engagements at ranges varying from close to extended distances, and control the extent of damage. Networked Capability 8.60 The future ADF will use modern information technology to link sensors, weapons systems and commanders and their personnel in a networked environment. This will help our people to work more effectively together, provide common battlespace awareness and, most crucially, information superiority over an adversary so that our people can make critical decisions on the battlefield more quickly and with better knowledge than the adversary. This approach will be dependent on a secure high-capacity information network that allows personnel located in different areas to collaborate in real time, and to synchronise their operational actions very precisely. Operational Flexibility 8.61 Australia cannot afford to maintain a large number of narrowly applicable capabilities. The future development of the ADF is to emphasise, wherever possible, operational flexibility and multirole employment in the ADF's systems, platforms and organisations. This might involve, for example, achieving greater platform flexibility by way of inter-changeable modular design and construction techniques. Fully Developed Capability 8.62 While mission-specific capability enhancements will be applied where necessary, as a capability development principle the ADF will acquire fully developed capabilities, which are fully deployable and effective within readiness warning times. Capability Advantage 8.63 Following the earlier discussion of maintaining a strategic capability advantage, the ADF will acquire the most capable platforms and systems we can afford within our policy settings, in order to offset the relatively small size of our forces and give them a war-winning edge. Exploiting and applying new advanced technologies will be crucial to achieve this. Survivable and Robust Capability 8.64 The ADF must be able to protect itself against the range of existing and evolving threats, particularly as the proliferation of threats is unlikely to abate. Continued investments in lower signatures and stealth Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

176 for our capabilities and systems, force protection, countermeasures, protective security, and systems redundancy will be required. Interoperable Capability 8.65 Interoperability is principally concerned with the ability of personnel and systems of different nations and agencies to work effectively together, safely and securely. Where it makes sense to do so, and it is cost-effective and in keeping with the policy settings in this White Paper, capabilities and systems should be designed to be interoperable from conception, not as an afterthought in the capability development process. Cost-Effective Capability 8.66 Defence will continue to drive down the costs of ownership of military capability. This will include greater use of simulation, a more active role for ADF Reserves, smarter maintenance and leaner logistics systems, improved information management, and, where appropriate, a bias towards militaryand commercial-off-the shelf capabilities. These measures are further discussed in later Chapters. Building the Future Joint Force 8.67 Joint operations involving the three Services, other Defence elements, such as the Defence intelligence agencies, and in some cases other Australian Government agencies are the only way in which Australia's relatively small force can successfully undertake operations. A crucial characteristic of the future force will be a joint approach that binds together single-service capabilities and systems into an operationally seamless whole. Joint task forces will be the standard mode of operating Higher command and control arrangements will be inherently joint in nature. The creation of Headquarters Joint Operations Command at Bungendore, New South Wales, has set the benchmark for true joint integration at the operational level. Efforts to build the future joint force will continue on this and other foundations laid in the 1980s, when the ADF as a joint force was effectively created. The creation of a new joint capability coordination function will oversee the implementation of joint capability concepts. Superior Leadership and Professional Mastery 8.69 Building Force 2030 is not just about systems and platforms. Our people give us a winning edge. Australia's recent operational experiences in environments such as East Timor and Afghanistan have highlighted the leadership and professionalism required of ADF personnel to ensure success in combat operations. These traits have been tested and demonstrated in many ways, including by the controlled and measured way in which ADF personnel have responded to crises and combat situations, their disciplined use of force, and their empathetic, positive and friendly engagement with local communities. Such leadership and professionalism are the foundation for strategic success, as well as tactical success in combat operations. 68 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

177 8.70 Investment in recruitment, training, education and the career development of the ADF's junior personnel and leaders will continue to pay substantial dividends in terms of our ability to achieve campaign objectives and reduced casualties, while maintaining the high ethical standards of ADF personnel, and the proud record of the ADF on operations As the ADF becomes a more integrated force, it must do so in a manner that recognises the professional mastery in each of the three single Services in their environmental domains. That mastery has been achieved over decades of practice and experience, and is at the base of the joint force. An Improved Force Structure Development Process 8.72 This Chapter has set out the strategic basis and framework for the future development of the ADF. To build on this guidance and ensure that momentum is not lost, the Government has decided that the future development of the ADF will be driven by an improved force structure and capability development process within Defence. The central feature of that process will be stronger linkages between strategic guidance, force development and capability decisions. The Government will oversee this force structure and capability development process in a way that has not previously occurred Specifically the Government has decided that no force structure option or capability requirement will in future be considered unless it has been generated as a consequence of this new improved process, with proposals to adjust our strategic posture or force structure to be considered by Government through the annual classified Defence Planning Guidance (DPG). This will be the primary means by which the Government will consider how best to manage strategic risk in the defence domain Defence will establish improved internal processes for managing force structure development, the definition of capability requirements, and capability proposal development to give effect to these new arrangements. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

178 ChapTEr NiNE: CaPaBiLiTY PriOriTiES for force This Chapter identifies the Government's key capability priorities for modernising and enhancing the ADF, and in particular the major capabilities that we will need to deliver to build Force 2030, and remediate the current and projected force. Maritime Forces 9.2 This section describes the key capability priorities for modernising and enhancing the Navy. Submarines 9.3 For the reasons spelled out in Chapter 8, the Government has decided to acquire 12 new Future Submarines, to be assembled in South Australia. This will be a major design and construction program spanning three decades, and will be Australia's largest ever single defence project. The Future Submarine will have greater range, longer endurance on patrol, and expanded capabilities compared to the current Collins class submarine. It will also be equipped with very secure real-time communications and be able to carry different mission payloads such as uninhabited underwater vehicles. 9.4 The Future Submarine will be capable of a range of tasks such as anti-ship and anti-submarine warfare; strategic strike; mine detection and mine-laying operations; intelligence collection; supporting special forces (including infiltration and exfiltration missions); and gathering battlespace data in support of operations. 9.5 Long transits and potentially short-notice contingencies in our primary operational environment demand high levels of mobility and endurance in the Future Submarine. The boats need to be able to undertake prolonged covert patrols over the full distance of our strategic approaches and in operational areas. They require low signatures across all spectrums, including at higher speeds. The Government has ruled out nuclear propulsion for these submarines. 9.6 The complex task of capability definition, design and construction must be undertaken without delay, given the long lead times and technical challenges involved. The Government has already directed that a dedicated project office be established for the Future Submarine within Defence, and will closely oversee this project. 9.7 The strategic importance of this capability is such that Australian industry involvement will need to be factored into the design, development and construction phases, and the sustainment and maintenance life cycle of these boats, which will extend well into the 2050s and possibly beyond. The Government 70 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

179 will give early consideration to the complex capability definition and acquisition issues involved in this substantial undertaking. The Government will also consider matters such as basing and crewing, and will seek early advice from Defence on those and other issues. 9.8 For this project to succeed, we need to engage with a number of overseas partners during the design and development phase. In particular, the Government intends to continue the very close level of Australia-US collaboration in undersea warfare capability. This will be crucial in the development and through life management of the Future Submarine. 9.9 The Government has also agreed to further incremental upgrades to the Collins class submarines throughout the next decade, including new sonars, to ensure they remain highly effective through to their retirement. The construction program for the Future Submarines will be designed to provide the Government with the option to continue building additional submarines in the 2030s and beyond, should strategic circumstances require it The Government is determined to respond decisively to deficiencies in the current availability of operationally ready submarines. The Navy will embark on a major reform program to improve the availability of the Collins class fleet, and will also ensure that a solid foundation is laid for the expanded future submarine force. These reforms will change how we attract, remunerate, train and manage the submarine workforce, and improve the deployment and maintenance of the submarines. Surface Combatants 9.11 The Government will proceed with the acquisition of three Air Warfare Destroyers (AWD). In order to enhance the air defence capabilities of the AWDs, the Government will equip them with with the Standard Missile 6 (SM-6) long-range anti-aircraft missile. The SM-6 missile is the most advanced weapon of its type, with a range of more than 200 nautical miles (370 kilometres) and effectively extends the air defence protection offered by these advanced ships. As they enter service, the AWDs will be equipped with a sophisticated Cooperative Engagement Capability (CEC), which enable each vessel to act as part of a wider 'grid' of sensor and weapon platforms that can share surveillance and targeting information. Defence will also investigate fitting CEC to the AEW&C aircraft in order to optimise the capability advantages offered by the SM-6 missile The Government will continue to monitor and assess its capability needs against strategic assessments. As a consequence, the Government will continue to assess the capability need for a fourth AWD in the future against further changes in the strategic assessment and, consistent with that assessment the most rational public investment in further defence platforms The Government will also acquire a fleet of eight new Future Frigates, which will be larger than the Anzac class vessels. The Future Frigate will be designed and equipped with a strong emphasis on submarine detection and response operations. They will be equipped with an integrated sonar suite that includes a long-range active towed-array sonar, and be able to embark a combination of naval combat helicopters and maritime Unmanned Aerial Vehicles (UAV). Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

180 9.14 The Government is also committed to ensuring that the current Anzac class frigates continue to be able to operate effectively until they start being replaced by the Future Frigates. Subject to the successful outcome of at-sea trials on the first ship, the Government will put all of the Anzac ships through the anti-ship missile defence upgrade program, which employs highly innovative Australian-designed digital phased array radar technology. This significant increase in capability will be complemented by upgrades to both the Evolved Sea Sparrow Missile and the Nulka missile decoy system. ASW upgrades on the Anzac class will also be undertaken To ensure our current surface combatants are capable of the range of operations discussed earlier in this White Paper, the Government will equip them with new weapon systems to defend against threats from incoming missiles and close-range asymmetric surface threats such as high speed boats equipped with heavy weapons. Naval Combat Aviation 9.16 As a matter of urgency, the Government will acquire a fleet of at least 24 new naval combat helicopters to provide eight or more aircraft concurrently embarked on ships at sea. These new aircraft will possess advanced ASW capabilities, including sonar systems able to be lowered into the sea and air-launched torpedoes, as well as an ability to fire air-to-surface missiles The Government will introduce 46 new MRH-90 helicopters as a pooled fleet shared between the Royal Australian Navy and the Australian Army to replace the Navy's Sea Kings and the Army's general troop lift Blackhawk fleets. This large state-of-the-art helicopter, equipped with an infrared system for use in low-light conditions, will provide significantly greater load- and troop-carrying capacity. The Navy will operate six MRH-90 helicopters and share a further seven for common flight training for both Services; the balance will be assigned to the Army and fleet maintenance cycles. The MRH-90 will enter service with the Navy in Anti-Submarine Warfare 9.18 The Government intends to place greater emphasis on our capacity to detect and respond to submarines in the ADF's primary operational environment through the acquisition of the Future Submarine, and enhanced ASW capabilities in the surface combatant fleet, the naval combat helicopter and the maritime patrol aircraft. As we develop our information superiority capability, situational awareness in the undersea domain will become relatively more important. The Defence Science and Technology Organisation (DSTO) will enhance its research into underwater sensors and networking to give greater emphasis to underwater situational awareness. Offshore Combatant Vessels 9.19 The Navy currently operates four relatively small fleets of vessels for important tasks such as offshore resource protection, border security, hydrographic and oceanographic environmental assessments 72 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

181 and clearing sea mines. This significantly increases whole-of-life ownership costs and personnel overheads. Smaller vessels also have less seagoing capacity and a reduced scope for installing more capable sensor or weapons systems over time The Government has therefore decided that Defence will develop proposals to rationalise the Navy's patrol boat, mine counter measures, hydrographic and oceanographic forces into a single modular multirole class of around 20 Offshore Combatant Vessels combining four existing classes of vessels. This has the potential to provide significant operational efficiencies and potential savings. The new vessels will be larger than the current Armidale class patrol boats, with an anticipated displacement of up to 2,000 tonnes This concept relies on the use of modular unmanned underwater systems for both mine countermeasures and hydrographic tasks. These systems are envisaged to be containerised and portable modules capable of being used in any port or loaded onto any of the Offshore Combatant Vessels or other suitable vessels The future Offshore Combatant Vessel will be able to undertake offshore and littoral warfighting roles, border protection tasks, long-range counter-terrorism and counter-piracy operations, support to special forces, and missions in support of security and stability in the immediate neighbourhood. Defence will examine the potential for these new ships to embark a helicopter or UAV, to allow a surge in surveillance and response capabilities without the need to deploy additional ships. This increased capability will also ensure that major surface combatants are free for more demanding operations. Amphibious Capability 9.23 Our capacity to deploy and sustain land forces from the sea will be substantially enhanced when the two new Landing Helicopter Dock (LHD) amphibious ships enter service in the coming decade. They will be able to carry a substantial quantity of equipment, stores and personnel. In terms of humanitarian assistance and disaster relief operations, they will most likely be the best means available to provide assistance in our region without becoming a burden on damaged and fragile land infrastructure. They will also provide a significant capacity for maritime manoeuvre of land forces in our littoral environment The Government has decided to enhance this amphibious capability by acquiring a large strategic sealift ship to move stores, equipment and personnel. Based on a proven design, the new ship will have a displacement of 10,000-15,000 tonnes, with landing spots for a number of helicopters and an ability to land vehicles and other cargo without requiring port infrastructure. The new ship will provide ongoing sustainment support for deployed forces, allowing the LHD ships to remain in areas of operations in direct support of the land force ashore The Government will also introduce six new heavy landing craft with improved ocean-going capabilities, able to transport armoured vehicles, trucks, stores and people in intra-theatre lift tasks to augment the larger amphibious vessels. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

182 Sea Logistic Support and Replenishment Support Capability 9.26 The size of the area over which our maritime forces may have to operate, and the extended periods they may be required to remain at sea, means that resupplying our deployed ships is an essential capability. Therefore, the Government intends to replace the older of the Navy's two supply ships, HMAS Success, with a new ship which will enter service at the end of the next decade. Land Forces 9.27 This section describes the key capability priorities for modernising and enhancing the Army. The Structure of the Army 9.28 The Government has considered the range of tasks that may be required of our land forces. While no major change to the size and structure of the Army is warranted, a range of capability improvements are Our conventional land forces will continue to be based on three combat brigades (each around 4,000 troops) consisting of multiple battalion-sized units. The growth of the two additional infantry battalions established under the Enhanced Land Force initiative will continue The Army will be able to combine its combat and combat support units to generate 10 battalion-sized 'battlegroups' tailored for a wide range of operations. The generation of operationally-ready land forces will be enhanced by the formation of Forces Command, located in Sydney, which will be responsible for all individual and group training, to provide troops that are ready to complete final preparation for operations. Forces Command will also take charge of logistics organisations supporting this process, along with a helicopter brigade comprising three battalion-sized units of reconnaissance, lift, and utility helicopters The Army will continue to provide a highly trained Special Forces group consisting of the Special Air Service Regiment, a Commando battalion, the Incident Response Regiment, a reserve commando regiment and supporting specialist troops. Special Forces capabilities are discussed in detail later in this Chapter. The Adaptive Army: Next Steps 9.32 The Government is also determined to further enhance the Army's current reforms under the Adaptive Army initiative. Additional reform will improve the Army's long-term capacity to sustain prolonged operational deployments, and to flexibly surge long lead-time capabilities, should our strategic circumstances require it. To that end, the Government has decided that, in addition to the Enhanced Land Force initiatives, the Army will make more effective use of its part-time components. The Government will also ensure that the Army has the right internal balance (that is in the number, types and mix of land force capabilities and units) to ensure that we have the depth to sustain prolonged operations, and can surge latent capacity should the need arise. 74 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

183 9.33 The Government has directed Defence to develop a detailed implementation plan by the end of 2009, to ensure that the Army's internal balance and mix of full-time and part-time land force elements can meet these objectives.the plan will be developed within the strategic guidance and funding parameters contained in this White Paper. The resources that the Army will need to implement the adaptation will be provided through re-investment of efficiencies realised through these reform measures within Army Among other things, the implementation plan will contain options for: changing the internal balance of full-time and part-time components of the Army, without reducing the overall combat power of our land forces; how the Army's part-time forces can be best provided with a greater operational focus in order to increase the utility of part-time personnel; how part-time force elements might act as a 'repository' of some high-end, longer lead time capabilities for contingencies related to the defence of Australia, as a hedge against strategic risk, and an expansion base should we require it; how the Army might better use civilian skills and ex-regular personnel in its force structure; and a better model for the Army's preparedness which more appropriately balances strategic risk, sustainment and concurrency pressures and future adaptation pressures to ensure we get better value from our full-time and part-time components, including through more effectively utilising the Army Reserve links with regions and local communities The plan will also consider a new form of part-time service based on workforce sponsorship in areas such as in the provision of high technology communications support, simulation systems support, training utilising technical colleges, and the targeting of selected industrial skills bases (for example railways, other transport and apprentice training). The current High Readiness Reserve scheme could be adapted to support such an initiative As part of this plan, Defence will ensure that the Army Reserve will continue to be based on brigade-sized formations, which will be responsible for raising and training units and individuals within the Army force structure of the future. The plan will, however, consider different unit/brigade affiliations to achieve its main aim, which is to improve the Army's overall ability to sustain prolonged operational deployments and to provide additional capability when the regular Army is facing concurrency challenges More detailed discussion on part-time capability issues and employment issues can be found in Chapters 10 and 14 respectively. Land Force Survivability, Mobility and Communications 9.38 The Government places a high priority on the survivability and mobility of our land forces. To meet this priority, Defence intends to acquire a new fleet of around 1,100 deployable protected vehicles. These Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

184 new vehicles will replace existing armoured personnel carriers, mobility vehicles and other combat vehicles which, in the past, have had limited or no protection. These new vehicles will offer greatly improved firepower, protection and mobility, in response to the increasing complexity and lethality of land operations. In the shorter term, Defence will continue to upgrade the protection, mobility and firepower of the M113 Armoured Personnel Carriers, some of which are already in service. By the time this project is completed in late 2011, the Army will have around 430 of these enhanced vehicles Defence will continue a further major vehicle-related project to replace the current deployable support vehicle fleet of wheeled transport and logistic vehicles with a mix of around 7,000 support vehicles. The new vehicles will provide transport, command and control, liaison and logistic support Furthermore, the Government will equip our land forces with enhanced communications, networking and battle management systems, both for the new vehicle fleet and for troops down to the individual level, along with new friendly-force identification systems for soldiers and vehicles Defence will continue to enhance the capabilities of the individual soldier in dismounted close combat to improve combat power, survivability, and command and control right down to the lowest levels within combat teams. The integrated soldier system provides enhanced lethality through the upgrade of current small arms with better day and night surveillance capabilities, and increased survivability through continuous enhancement of personal body armour. Such enhancements will also provide a dismounted and networked command and control battlefield management system. The integrated system will lighten the load on the soldier, increase mobility and enable the soldier to operate more effectively for longer by providing enhanced sustainment methods (rations and power systems). Battlefield Lift Capability 9.42 Operations in our region will generate considerable demands for intra-theatre lift to support dispersed deployments and to access remote areas The Government has decided to replace the current fleet of six CH-47D helicopters with a new fleet of seven CH-47F aircraft, the most modern and capable type of this proven and versatile helicopter. These new medium-lift helicopters will see Australia operating the same aircraft configuration as the US Army, which has a fleet of around 500 aircraft. Not only will these aircraft have improved electronic warfare self-protection systems and maintenance arrangements to increase their operational effectiveness and employability across the battlefield, but future operating costs will be reduced as we take full advantage of the development, engineering, training and spares systems that are in place for the US Army The Army will be the major beneficiary of the 46 MRH-90 helicopters to be introduced as a pooled fleet shared between the Navy and the Army. The Army will operate 30 MRH-90 helicopters to replace its Blackhawk troop lift aircraft, and share a further seven helicopters for common flight training for both Services. This larger and more capable new helicopter will enter service with the Army in Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

185 Fire Support 9.45 The Government has decided to further enhance the direct and indirect combat power available to the Army's combined-arms teams. The Government will proceed with the acquisition of new 155mm artillery systems, both self-propelled and towed type, able to fire precision munitions at very long ranges, and high rates of fire. These systems will comprise a deployable capability of two batteries of self-propelled guns and four batteries of towed guns. The towed guns will be able to be moved by helicopter and transport aircraft Army's mortars will also be replaced with a new and more capable system, and the Government will equip our soldiers with new direct-fire anti-armour as well as automatic grenade launcher systems The Army's fire support will be augmented by the new Australian-assembled 'Tiger' Armed Reconnaissance Helicopters which are currently undergoing operational acceptance testing. Armed with guided missiles, unguided rockets and a 30mm chain gun, the Tiger can provide direct fire support and, using advanced onboard optical and electronic observation systems, can provide precision targeting information When deployed on combat operations, our troops could be exposed to rocket and mortar fire. The Government will replace or upgrade the Army's ground-based air defence system (currently based on the RBS-70 missile) with more advanced systems that will also include a new counter rocket and mortar capability to protect land forces from artillery, rockets and mortar fire. Land Operations in Complex Environments 9.49 The Army will require a greater ability to operate in proximity to civilian populations.the Government has decided that it will further develop the ADF's capacity to deploy specialists to conduct field intelligence and information operations Defence will also broaden the delivery of foreign language training through new regionally-based training facilities and the Melbourne campus of the Defence Force School of Languages To improve the ADF's imagery capability at the tactical level, the Government has decided to establish five Geospatial Imagery Analyst teams and associated training staff. The utility of smaller Tactical Uninhabited Aerial Vehicles has been demonstrated on recent operations and the Government has determined that Defence will enhance its capability in this area. Tactical UAVs will enhance the effectiveness and survivability of ground forces by providing real-time situational awareness directly to forces on the ground The Government has also decided that our deployed troops will have access to an enhanced suite of non-lethal weapons. This will give our troops options short of lethal force, including short-term incapacitating agents, visual and acoustic attention gaining devices, and non-lethal projectiles. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

186 Special Forces 9.53 Australia's Special Forces are among the best trained and most competent in the world, and have an enviable record of courage and skill on operations. They have access to the best equipment and training we can provide. Nonetheless, their equipment and systems must be continually updated The Government will continue the capability edge provided by our special forces through regular acquisition of advanced equipment, provision of state-of-the-art training facilities and the recruitment and retention of high quality soldiers. The acquisitions will include new special operations vehicles; direct fire support weapons; and enhanced chemical, biological, radiological and nuclear protective equipment. Significant improvements will also be made to digital networking within the area of operations to strengthen the capability of deployed forces. Defence will enhance 'stealthy' methods of inserting forces into target areas. Special Forces troops will also benefit from projects principally aimed at the rest of the ADF, such as the acquisition of improved night vision equipment, and enhancements in EW and communications systems The Army will continue to maintain an Incident Response Regiment (IRR) within the Special Forces, with advanced skills and equipment for detecting and responding to chemical,biological,nuclear,radiological and explosive threats. The IRR is able to undertake high-risk search, access and disablement functions in a range of complex environments. The Government is committed to developing these capabilities further. Air Power 9.56 This section describes the key capability priorities for modernising and enhancing the Air Force. Air Combat Capability 9.57 On coming to office, the Government commissioned the Air Combat Capability Review to provide advice on aspects of Australia's air combat requirements. That study and its findings were incorporated into the Force Structure Review The Air Combat Capability Review assessed that the squadron of F/A-18F Super Hornets being acquired as a bridging air combat capability is a highly capable 4.5 generation aircraft and, as long as it retains commonality with the planned US Navy development path, will remain effective until at least The F/A-18F Super Hornet will begin to enter service from the end of The Review concluded that a fleet of around 100 fifth generation multirole combat aircraft would provide Australia with an effective and flexible air combat capability to A further judgement of the review was that the F-35 Joint Strike Fighter (JSF) is the preferred solution for that requirement. Other fourth and fifth generation combat aircraft considered by the Review were judged to be less capable of fulfilling Australia's multirole air combat capability requirements The Government has decided that it will acquire around 100 F-35 JSF, along with supporting systems and weapons. The first stage of this acquisition will acquire three operational squadrons comprising 78 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

187 not fewer than 72 aircraft. The acquisition of the remaining aircraft will be acquired in conjunction with the withdrawal of the F/A-18F Super Hornet fleet, and will be timed to ensure that no gap in our overall air combat capability occurs Australia's future air combat capability will therefore be based on four operational air combat squadrons consisting initially of three JSF squadrons and a squadron of Super Hornet aircraft, which will be replaced by a fourth JSF squadron. Defence will continue to progressively upgrade the systems and airframes of the current F/A-18 aircraft to ensure that they remain capable and sustainable until the JSF enters service with the ADF Maritime strike capability will be provided by the Hornet and Super Hornet fleets using Harpoon missiles, with the Government to acquire a new maritime strike weapon for the JSF. New air-to-air and air-to-surface weapons will also be acquired There has been considerable public interest in the potential acquisition of the JSF. The Government has examined its capabilities very carefully in the context of the Air Combat Capability Review, and remains confident that the JSF's combination of stealth, advanced sensors, networking and data fusion capabilities, when integrated into the networked ADF, will ensure Australia maintains its strategic capability advantage out to The Government has decided that it would be prudent for the ADF to acquire an airborne electronic attack capability. To that end, it has decided that the production arrangements for the second batch of 12 Australian F/A-18F Super Hornets will include wiring those aircraft to enable them, should later strategic circumstances dictate,to be converted to the electronic warfare 'Growler' variant - the EA-18G. Should we acquire this capability, it would provide a potent ability to protect our own communications and electronic systems while jamming, suppressing or otherwise denying an adversary the full use of the electromagnetic spectrum in the area of operations. The Broader Air Combat System 9.65 Air combat capability is achieved by having a sophisticated system built on advanced multirole combat aircraft as well as ISR systems, Airborne Early Warning and Control (AEW&C) and air-to-air refuelling aircraft, air bases with their supporting functions and seamless joint command and control systems. Defence will continue to improve its capability to develop full situational awareness of Australia's airspace through a project that will fuse air surveillance information from multiple sources, to create a 'Recognised Air Picture' of the ADF's primary operational environment. Additionally, we will invest in improved military air traffic control, navigation and communications systems and deployable mobile regional operations centres The Government will continue with the acquisition of five KC-30A air-to-air refuelling aircraft, and six new AEW&C aircraft. When the KC-30A aircraft enter service from 2010, they will not only greatly enhance our air combat capability by extending the range and endurance of our fighters, but will also Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

188 augment our air-lift capability, as each aircraft can deploy around 270 troops and significant quantities of stores over strategic distances The Wedgetail AEW&C aircraft will transform our air combat capability when it enters service from 2011, by providing vastly improved situational awareness and an ability to control and coordinate aircraft to enable mission execution. Defence will also investigate upgrading the AEW&C aircraft with CEC to enable it to more effectively cue weapons systems and perform other functions in an air warfare information 'grid'. Maritime Surveillance and Response 9.68 The sheer size of the air and sea space within our primary operational environment presents particular challenges in relation to surveillance and armed maritime response across such a vast area To meet this challenge, the Government will acquire eight new maritime patrol aircraft to replace the current AP-3C Orion fleet. These new aircraft will provide a highly advanced surface search radar and optical, infra-red and electronic surveillance systems. With these systems, along with a high transit speed and the ability to conduct air-to-air refuelling, these aircraft will provide a superior capability for rapid area search and identification tasks. They will also provide a highly advanced ASW capability, including an ability to engage submarines using air-launched torpedoes. After subsequent upgrades, they will be capable of firing stand-off anti-ship missiles We will also acquire up to seven large high-altitude, long-endurance UAVs to supplement the manned maritime patrol aircraft. These large UAVs, with an ocean-spanning range, will markedly expand the surveillance coverage of the maritime approaches to Australia, in both area and duration. They will also have a significant overland capability to provide support to our ground forces in a range of circumstances. Strategic UAVs provide persistent ISR, enhancing our situational awareness in both the land and maritime domains. Air Lift Capability 9.71 Large transport aircraft such as the C-17 Globemaster heavy air transport aircraft and the C-130 Hercules have a crucial role in providing the capability to lift, deploy, and sustain our forces, and in supporting other tasks such as humanitarian assistance, disaster relief and aero-medical evacuation The Government has decided to increase our air transport capability through the acquisition of two additional C-130J Hercules aircraft and up to ten light tactical fixed-wing aircraft to replace the DHC-4 Caribou aircraft. These new aircraft will complement the current air transport fleet of four C-17 and 12 C-130J aircraft. The older C-130H aircraft will be retired. The Government will ensure that these new light tactical fixed-wing aircraft will have significantly greater range, speed and payload than the retiring Caribou transports. Extra lift capability will be provided by the five KC-30A multirole tankertransport aircraft. 80 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

189 Strategic Strike 9.73 Currently, Australia relies primarily on its air combat capability for strategic strike. In the future, the stealthy JSF, employing a range of precision weapons and supported by AEW&C and air-to-air refuelling aircraft, will deliver a potent and survivable strike capability. This builds on the enhanced strike capability provided by the upgraded F/A-18A/B fleet, which will employ the Joint Air to Surface Standoff Munition (JASSM) with a range of over 200 nautical miles. Special Forces could also carry out strike missions, principally by providing targeting information but potentially also by direct means The Government places a priority on broadening our strategic strike options, which will occur through the acquisition of maritime-based land-attack cruise missiles. These missiles will be fitted to the AWD, Future Frigate and Future Submarine. Defence will fit the necessary control and firing systems to the AWD as an early enhancement. The incorporation of a land-attack cruise missile capability will be integral to the design and construction of the Future Frigate and Future Submarine. We will not seek to retrofit this capability to the Collins submarine fleet The acquisition of a maritime-based land-attack cruise missile capability for the ADF will provide the Government with additional options to conduct long-range precision strike operations against hardened, defended and difficult to access targets, while minimising the exposure of ADF platforms and personnel to attack by enemy forces. Advanced internal guidance and supporting weapon control systems in modern versions of this capability would also better enable the ADF to fulfil its obligations under the laws of armed conflict through greater accuracy and control. This long-range precision strike capability will be supported by enhanced geospatial capabilities and targeting analysis support Acquisition of a land-attack cruise missile capability is fully consistent with Australian treaty obligations and customary international law. It is also consistent with our long held policy of maintaining credible capabilities for the defence of Australia, and will act as a hedge against longer-term strategic uncertainty. Information Superiority 9.77 This section describes the key capability priorities for modernising and enhancing the ADF's information superiority capabilities. Intelligence, Surveillance and Reconnaissance 9.78 We need comprehensive levels of situational awareness in the ADF's primary operational environment, including a capacity for continuous wide area surveillance of our northern approaches. In other contingencies, we need very high levels of situational awareness in the specific area of ADF operations The Government will make a substantial investment in ISR capabilities. This includes expenditure on a number of mostly classified projects specifically related to enhancing Defence's intelligence capability. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

190 9.80 As a significant new measure, the Government places a high priority on assured access to high-quality space-based imagery to meet Defence's needs for mapping, charting, navigation and targeting data. It has decided to improve Australia's intelligence collection capabilities by acquiring a satellite with a remote sensing capability, most likely to be based on a high-resolution, cloud-penetrating, synthetic aperture radar. This important capability will add to Australia's standing as a contributing partner within our alliance framework with the United States, which will be given access to the imagery collected by this system The Government will also continue to progressively upgrade the Jindalee over-the-horizon Radar (JORN) system, to ensure that this capability meets our needs into the future. Situational Awareness 9.82 To conduct operations successfully, Defence will increasingly need to merge information from many sources and deployed assets. These will include submarines, JORN, airborne ISR assets, maritime patrol aircraft, long-range UAVs, AEW&C aircraft, the JSF aircraft (which will have unprecedented ISR capabilities for a combat aircraft), the AWDs and other surface combatants, as well as signals and human intelligence, imagery and outputs from a variety of space-based intelligence and surveillance systems. This vast pool of information will be augmented by data from non-defence sources. When fused and distributed, the information provides a common operating picture across the ADF's primary operational environment, and selected areas of interest beyond that, depending on strategic and operational imperatives To achieve this goal, Defence will embark on a major enhancement of its ISR management processes and information architecture. Defence will enhance its ISR capabilities through bringing together all relevant assets into a Defence-wide architecture, employing very secure, high-capacity ICT systems. This will ensure that ISR resources and information sources are more effectively utilised, different systems are linked, universal data standards and protocols are employed, and critical information is made available to those who need it, in real time. As part of this initiative, Defence will ensure that 'stove-piping' of information is eliminated and that the principle of 'need-to-share' (within sensible security constraints) becomes pervasive We will bolster this approach by improving ISR linkages with the United States, especially in the wider Asia-Pacific region covered by the US Pacific Command. At the Australia-United States Ministerial Consultations in April 2009, Australia and the United States agreed on principles that will guide greater cooperation on intelligence, surveillance and reconnaissance. The principles reflect the recommendations of a joint study team, established following AUSMIN 2008, which considered options for improving our capability to gather and share information from a wide range of sensors. This initiative has the potential to improve the visibility of activities in our maritime approaches and across the region through the sharing of surveillance information and capabilities. Increased investment in ISR cooperation with the United States will allow us to boost our ISR capability and contribute practically to the deepening of our already strong alliance relationship. 82 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

191 Cyber Warfare 9.85 In the past decade the growing importance of operations in cyberspace has become more apparent. Our national security could potentially be compromised by cyberattacks on our defence, wider governmental, commercial or infrastructure-related information networks. The potential impacts of such attacks have grown with Defence's increasing reliance on networked operations. Therefore, we must focus on developing capabilities that allow us to gain an edge in the cyberspace domain, and protect ourselves This emerging threat will require significant and sustained investment by Defence in new technology and analytical capability to guard the integrity of its own information and ensure the successful conduct of operations The Government has decided to invest in a major enhancement of Defence's cyber warfare capability. A comprehensive range of expanded and new capabilities will maximise Australia's strategic capacity and reach in this field. Many of these capabilities remain highly classified, but in outline they consist of a much-enhanced cyber situational awareness and incident response capability, and the establishment of a Cyber Security Operations Centre to coordinate responses to incidents in cyberspace The Cyber Security Operations Centre will include a continuously staffed watch office and an analysis team to respond to cyberthreats in a timely fashion. Its staff will include ADF and DSTO personnel. This new Centre will be created within the Defence Signals Directorate (DSD), which already possesses significant cybersecurity expertise While this capability will reside within Defence and be available to provide cyber warfare support to ADF operations, it will be purpose-designed to serve broader national security goals. This includes assisting responses to cyber incidents across government and critical private sector systems and infrastructure. Whole-of-government coordination will be achieved through the appropriate representation within the Centre from relevant Government agencies. Those agencies include the Attorney-General's Department, which has the lead on e-security programs for Government and the private sector, as well as the Australian Federal Police and relevant agencies of the Australian intelligence community. Electronic Warfare 9.90 Electronic warfare covers a range of techniques to protect our own electronic systems, while denying the adversary the full use of their systems. Effective use of EW techniques can enhance the protection of our deployed forces, increase their effectiveness, and deny our adversaries information about our locations, intentions and capabilities The Government places a high priority on strengthening the ADF's EW capabilities. This will occur through a number of projects aimed at delivering enhancements to reporting systems and databases, such as those supporting analysis and dissemination of EW-related information; intelligence capabilities for maritime and land forces; and improved EW detection systems. The Government will Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

192 continue to develop our force level EW capability. These new capabilities will be an integral part of an enhanced information environment for ADF personnel. The DSTO will continue to undertake research and development of new and emerging EW techniques and technologies Defence will establish a Joint EW Centre through the collocation of a number of different ADF EW organisations, aimed at growing a critical mass of personnel and expertise. This centre will be responsible for training, research and development, countermeasure development, and the validation and verification of EW systems. Subject to further evaluation, the new centre will probably be located in Adelaide. Command, Control, Communications and Battlespace Management 9.93 Effective command and control of our joint forces will remain a crucial information superiority function. Joint Operations Command plays a central role in satisfying this requirement. Defence must also retain its ability to deploy, at very short notice, joint headquarters of various sizes to command assigned forces whenever they are deployed Defence requires a fully integrated command support system covering all levels of operation and all environments, with the ability to participate in coalition operations, and to collaborate with other agencies. To help achieve these goals, the Government intends to enhance Defence's joint command support system, as well as protected, high-speed communication systems and associated networking capabilities. Building the Networked Force 9.95 To take maximum advantage of the suite of sensors, weapons and other systems that are being acquired, Defence needs to ensure that it adheres to a centrally coordinated plan to link those elements together in what will over time become the networked force. The development of such a force presents new challenges in the way Defence manages projects that deliver capability and will require significant coordination, cross project collaboration and industry liaison. It will also need the support of a comprehensive joint training and education program and a clear master plan with key milestones The Government has confirmed that Defence is to build a networked ADF, and that it will achieve this by way of progressively delivering networked maritime, land, air and ISR domains. The Government has decided that Defence is to have in place the ICT infrastructure, information tools, command support, battlespace management systems and joint training programs necessary to provide a reliable battlespace network across the entire ADF. Emerging Capability Priorities 9.97 In a number of emerging capability priority areas, the Government has decided to hedge against future risk through modest capability developments, while keeping open the option of enhancing our capabilities, should circumstances require. This is a response to emerging areas of potential 84 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

193 direct threat which might pose serious and even grave threats to our national security if they are not countered. These areas include: cyberattack on our defence, security, government and civilian information infrastructure; space warfare involving attacks on critical space systems, especially those of our principal ally, the United States; ballistic missile attack on our population centres and infrastructure, especially where WMD warheads might be involved; and WMD attack by non-state actors using unconventional means Relevant priorities announced in this White Paper should be regarded as hedging developments against future risk. The Government will monitor emerging threats very closely and adjust our plans if necessary. Cyber warfare capability is dealt with in the preceding section on information superiority, and is not further discussed here. Space Situational Awareness and Mission Assurance 9.99 Space assets,including communications,intelligence,surveillance,positioning,navigation and targeting systems, will play an increasingly important role in military operations. Counter-space technologies will pose an increasing risk to the networked space-based systems on which we rely so heavily on for operational success. The emergence of counter-space technologies that can deny, disrupt and even destroy space-based capabilities will make space mission assurance and survivability increasingly important Our strategic capability advantage depends on our ability to access space, gain the benefits of spacebased systems and protect ourselves from foreign exploitation by space-based capabilities. Protecting our assets from counter-space capabilities and from accidental damage caused by space debris will be critical. We rely on the United States for much of our space advantage, but we should also seek ways to develop our nascent but growing expertise in space capabilities The Government has placed a priority on space situational awareness and has requested that Defence explore means by which to strengthen our space situational awareness and mission assurance capability. This will include the ADF developing a career stream for space specialists. Missile Defence Threats posed by ballistic missiles and their proliferation, particularly by states of concern such as North Korea, constitute a potential strategic challenge for Australia. Such threats include potential direct threats to Australia, threats to deployed Australian forces (particularly in East Asia and the Middle East), and other threats to regional security and stability The Government is opposed to the development of a unilateral national missile defence system by any nation because such a system would be at odds with the maintenance of global nuclear deterrence. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

194 We would be especially concerned at developments that might undercut the deterrent value of the strategic nuclear forces of the major nuclear powers, and especially the viability of their second strike capabilities Within this policy framework, Australia's approach to ballistic missile defence will continue to be based on examining capability options appropriate to Australia's strategic circumstances. We will explore the development of capabilities for in-theatre defence of ADF elements and the defence of other strategic interests - including our population centres and key infrastructure The Government will review its policy directions in this field annually, at which time it will authorise an annual plan of Defence engagement, research and development activities. Counter-Weapons of Mass Destruction Capabilities The Government has decided to enhance the counter-wmd capabilities of the ADF by establishing a deployable defensive counter-wmd capability in the Incident Response Regiment in support of land force or special operations activities. This will include some decontamination capabilities, as well as area and close survey, technical advice, and sophisticated measurement capabilities Although we do not intend to develop a more substantial deployable counter-wmd capability in the immediate future, the Government has not ruled out doing so if our strategic circumstances warrant such a move. Such a force could provide cueing to assist in strike tasks (for example, by special forces) to eliminate the source of a WMD threat. The Government would, of course, only take such action in self-defence within the bounds of our international legal obligations. Future Capability Options The Government has directed Defence to develop additional force structure options for possible consideration in future years. Those options may be brought forward as Australia's strategic and fiscal circumstances change, in which case they would be a basis for force structure options which might be considered in the next White Paper Such options could potentially include measures to further boost our capacity to deter and defeat attacks on Australia, to contribute to stability and security in our immediate region, to further hedge against emerging strategic risks, or some combination of those. 86 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

195 ChapTEr TEN: HOW PrEParED DOES THE adf NEED TO BE? Preparedness 10.1 Military capability is achieved by developing a force structure appropriately prepared for a range of potential operations. Defence preparedness, the ADF's ability to undertake military operations, comprises two key components: readiness and sustainability. Preparedness is core business for Defence and, other than success on operations, is the most significant performance outcome that Defence delivers to Government Judgements about preparedness are important for both strategic and cost reasons. Striking a balance between maintaining some forces at high levels of preparedness and others at lower levels is critical if we are to optimise strategic outcomes within the resources invested in Defence by Government. This challenge has implications for both the readiness of our forces and their sustainability on operations and directed tasks Having our forces at high rates of preparedness would enable us to respond rapidly and efficiently to a short-notice contingency; not holding sufficient forces at appropriate preparedness levels could leave us unprepared should a contingency arise that we had not planned for But preparedness comes at a cost. The higher the preparedness levels, the higher the cost. The cost of preparedness is driven by the timeframe within which forces must be ready for contingency operations, the expected duration of the contingency, the quantity of forces expected to be able to respond, the professional skills and pre-deployment training required to deliver the desired effects, and the complexity of the equipment to be used. Units at a very short notice to move (in some cases, a few hours) cost more to maintain than units at longer notice to move. Maintaining a large number of force elements to meet a wide range of potential contingencies at short notices to move is not a practical or effective use of limited resources Defence needs to hold some forces at high states of readiness to commit to short-notice contingencies that may arise. When determining which short notice contingencies to be prepared for, the likelihood and consequence of an event arising is analysed The ability to continue to conduct directed tasks and operations over time, which is known as sustainability, is a consequence of having enough military personnel to replace or rotate deployed troops during a prolonged operation, the serviceability of major platforms and other equipment, the quantities of available supplies and replacement items, and the ability of critical functions such as sea and air lift to be used at elevated or prolonged rates of effort. Sustainability is also influenced by the Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

196 capacity of industry to provide contracted support services, maintain, repair and replace equipment, generate supplies, provide specialist skills, and contribute to reconstitution once the mission is complete An important aspect of preparedness is the concept of concurrency, which is the ability of the force to conduct a number of operations in separate locations simultaneously. Concurrency poses challenges in particular ways. While there may be sufficient combat forces to conduct simultaneous deployments in geographically diverse environments, crucial joint enabling capabilities can often be stretched by the concurrent need to support and sustain our forces over long distances in different operating environments. Force Levels and Preparedness Goals 10.8 The Government has decided that, in return for the resourcing to be provided to Defence in the years ahead, the ADF must be able to maintain prescribed levels of operational capability, measured against force levels and preparedness goals. These requirements have been set in relation to the ADF's base level of capacity, and readiness, sustainability, concurrency and operating limitations. They represent what the future force, when fully built, must be able to do without further significant mobilisation of other national resources The Government expects the ADF to be postured to be able to carry out the following missions, potentially at the same time, or in carefully managed sequences over concentrated periods of time: establish and maintain sea control and air superiority at key locations in the ADF's primary operational environment; project maritime and air power beyond that area if that is necessary to defend Australia; maintain persistent situational awareness of our sea and air approaches; undertake strategic strike missions if that is necessary to defend Australia; deploy a brigade group able to engage in combat operations, and sustain that force for a prolonged period of time in our primary operational environment (but for much shorter periods beyond that area); deploy a battalion group to a different area of operations for a prolonged period of time in our primary operational environment (but for much shorter periods beyond that area); maintain other forces in reserve for short-notice, limited-warning missions, such as the evacuation of Australian citizens from regional trouble spots; project and sustain land forces operating in our primary operational environment by air and sea, including in credible non-permissive contingencies; provide tailored contributions to operations in support of our wider strategic interests (for example, a Special Forces Task Group, a combined arms Army Battalion Group or Company Group, a 88 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

197 detachment of maritime patrol or air-lift transport aircraft, a major surface combatant, or specialist elements such as medical, logistics, command, and communications teams); support civil efforts to protect and secure our offshore maritime domain, including in relation to dealing with unauthorised arrivals, fisheries protection, and other border security tasks; contribute ADF ISR and wide area surveillance capabilities to the national surveillance and border protection effort; maintain high readiness force elements to support domestic or offshore counter-terrorism efforts, particularly in relation to resolving complex terrorist incidents and securing ships or offshore resource infrastructure; assist civil authorities in securing major events of public significance, such as the 2000 Sydney Olympics and the 2007 APEC Leaders Meeting; assist civil authorities in dealing with the proliferation of WMD, explosive ordnance disposal, and chemical, biological, radiological and nuclear defence; support emergency response efforts in the event of man-made or natural disasters within Australia, and particularly assist in situations where the scale of a disaster exceeds the capacity of other agencies and jurisdictions; provide humanitarian assistance and disaster relief assistance to our neighbours, and more broadly if necessary; and provide search and rescue support, especially across the breadth of Australia's area of maritime search and rescue responsibility, whether close to the mainland or in remote parts of the Southern, Pacific and Indian Oceans. Improving Preparedness As part of the White Paper process, Defence reviewed its preparedness management arrangements to provide greater transparency on preparedness and associated personnel and operating cost pressures. Based on that review, the Government has directed Defence to refine its preparedness management arrangements so as to ensure a better alignment between strategic guidance, preparedness goals and ADF activity levels, and to optimise the resources available for frontline activities Defence will develop a better process for translating preparedness requirements into activity levels, to ensure that the ADF is prepared to do what is required of it by Government, while containing unnecessary growth in personnel and the operating costs of preparedness, and achieving significant potential savings in this area over the long term. Specific preparedness management reforms include: the development of a comprehensive preparedness decision support capability; the reform of applicable personnel and operating cost policies and processes; and Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

198 the development of relevant information systems and skills to support improved management of preparedness and to ensure better control of personnel and operating costs. The Use of Reserves In some circumstances, Defence may be required to surge its capabilities to rapidly increase force levels, enhance preparedness or broaden our military response options. The balance and structure of the ADF's full-time and part-time forces can be a force multiplier in such circumstances, and could be managed more strategically Over recent years, Defence has employed part-time units in several operational deployments and large scale 'national security' activities such as the Olympics, the Commonwealth Games, APEC meetings and visits by international dignitaries. Critical specialists, such as surgeons and other professionals, provide invaluable service to Defence operations on a part-time basis. Part-time personnel also routinely undertake extended operational deployments in the near region, such as the infantry company group currently deployed on rotation to Solomon Islands. Part-time units can also undertake very short notice aid to the civil community tasks, such as assistance during and after bushfires and floods. Individual part-time personnel from all Services have also contributed to multinational peacekeeping tasks in a number of theatres, and have served in multinational headquarters and coalitions However, a number of factors have constrained the ability of part-time personnel to play a larger role in the delivery of trained and ready capability. These factors include: the complexity of the tasks performed by the ADF (and the sophisticated and intensive mission preparation required); the availability of part-time personnel for extended duty; the complexity, cost and availability of some equipment (and the higher training load required to maintain competencies); the significant annual wastage rate among part-time personnel, which can be a brake on the delivery of capability; and the dispersion of part-time units and facilities The Government is committed to a better integration between part-time and full-time service in the ADF, and removing the factors which can impede the contribution that part-time forces can make to ADF capability. Chapter 9 describes how this will be done in relation to the Army, which contains the largest number of part-time personnel The Government also intends to further enhance the High Readiness Reserves (HRR), a category of part-time service that allows for some part-time personnel in the Army and the Royal Australian Air Force to be held at much higher readiness for deployment than most reservists. By January 2010, six company-sized Army combat teams, made up of HRR personnel, will be available for operational 90 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

199 tasking such as protecting points of entry (for instance ports or airfields), and guarding headquarters and vital installations. Defence will grow this capability, to provide a total of more than 1,000 troops in deployable combat teams, and more than 1,700 additional individuals and small teams to roundout other elements of the Army, including Special Forces. Additionally, the Army's Reserve Response Forces (RRF) provide six teams, each of company-size, for the purpose of Defence Assistance to the Civil Community, in the case of natural disasters, and Defence Force Assistance to the Civil Authority tasks. As discussed in Chapter 9, Defence will also investigate a new form of part-time service based on workforce sponsorship, with the current HRR scheme possibly being adapted to support such an initiative The Air Force Reserve contributes to an integrated total force capable of timely and effective employment and deployment to meet Air Force capability requirements over a range of contingencies and offers Government a range of options in meeting contemporary operations, peace-making and peacekeeping, disaster relief and other local or regional activities. The Air Force Operational Reserve, incorporating the HRR, augments Air Force operational capability by providing an additional just-intime, prepared personnel surge. The current operational Air Force Reserve is trained and prepared to the same standard as regular forces and capable of taking its place alongside regular personnel. Over the past two years some 150 Air Force reservists have deployed on overseas operations voluntarily and a similar number have backfilled positions behind deployed permanent Air Force members in the same period The Navy will continue its workforce integration program, which focuses on discrete capability outputs. The Navy Reserve Capability Enhancement Program, currently in its third year, will continue the participation of trained reservists in providing surge capacity for all Navy force elements. The Navy will continue to assess the optimal workforce size and mix, including part-time service, in the transition phase to the new amphibious capability to be provided by the LHDs from 2011 and beyond The Government also intends to investigate other models of part-time service, including focused contributions to operations, and 'sponsored Reserves'. Focused contributions, in which a part-time force element is focused on a particular type of mission, provides specialist capabilities or supports a long-term operational commitment, are particularly useful. Sponsored Reserves is a system by which private companies are contracted to deliver trained and ready groups of personnel, with skills in particular fields such as transport, maintenance, supply and health. The Use of Contractors on Operations The ADF has undertaken a series of demanding operational deployments in recent times, and commercial contractors have been used, in some form, on all of those deployments. Contractors have worked best in secured environments and their deployment has allowed ADF elements to redeploy, reconstitute and prepare for subsequent operations. Contractors have also provided significant support in East Timor and the Middle East by assisting in the preparation of stores and equipment for return to Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

200 Australia. The ADF will continue to develop the skills and experience necessary to manage and support commercial contractors in operational environments The greater use of contractors through such methods as support contracts and Sponsored Reserves, for longer-term stabilisation and reconstruction operations will potentially give the ADF more flexibility and the ability to choose the most cost-effective workforce mix for a given operational task. Mobilisation Chapter 3 describes the concept of strategic hedging, which provides a way to manage the risk that the strategic environment might deteriorate to a greater extent than is anticipated. In some circumstances that deterioration could be so significant that the currently available full-time and part-time forces would be insufficient to meet Australia's defence needs, even if we surged latent capabilities within Defence. In such circumstances, we might need to draw on significantly greater contributions from the national economy and society If circumstances of national peril were to arise, and the defence of Australia required it, the Government would of course direct a national effort to protect our territory and population and to preserve our way of life. The act of national mobilisation would not be taken lightly. Only a very substantial deterioration of our strategic environment that placed Australia under grave threat would justify such a course A substantial national mobilisation effort would require additional planning for the employment of national assets such as transportation systems, logistics capabilities, and hospital and health support services. Defence will pursue adequate mobilisation planning in order to have appropriate strategies in place, and to assess the issues associated with mobilisation. 92 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

201 ChapTEr ElEvEN: alliances and international DEfENCE relationships Importance of Alliances and International Defence Relationships 11.1 Central to Australia's strategic posture, and one of the most important ways Australia seeks to promote its strategic interests, is our network of alliances, our bilateral and multilateral defence relationships, and the growing range of multilateral security forums and arrangements in our region. These connections help us to promote stable strategic frameworks in our immediate neighbourhood, in the wider Asia- Pacific region, and at the global level. Such frameworks help to reduce the potential for threats to emerge and to mitigate their consequences when they do. Our defence relationships give Australia an important voice that underpins our credibility as a middle power which is active in promoting security Australia's defence relationships also strengthen the ADF by providing access to equipment, intelligence and training opportunities. Ultimately, our defence relationships are designed to underpin the possible use of military force Such relationships require long-term investment and effort to establish ties able to withstand pressures that may emerge. This Chapter explains why we make that investment and outlines how our international defence relationships complement our broader foreign policy goals, how they assist in building confidence and transparency, especially in the Asia-Pacific region; and how they provide the ballast which ensures that when circumstances demand we can work together with trusted allies and partners in crises and, if necessary, in conflict Australia's capacity to engage in defence diplomacy with key allies and regional partners is underpinned by the skills of our ADF personnel and civilians in Defence, including Defence personnel posted overseas and the resources available to them. Promoting Australia's middle power role puts a premium on highly developed analytical and policymaking skills, and our ability to understand and shape strategic developments. The Government remains committed to enhancing these skills and retaining the resourcing necessary for this essential foundation of our global and regional engagement plans. The US Alliance 11.5 Our alliance with the United States is our most important defence relationship. In day-to-day terms, the alliance gives us significant access to materiel,intelligence,research and development,communications systems, and skills and expertise that substantially strengthen the ADF. The alliance relationship is an integral element of our strategic posture, as explained in Chapter 6. Without access to US capabilities, Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

202 technology, and training, the ADF simply could not be the advanced force that it is today, and must be in the future, without the expenditure of considerable more money Formal undertakings to support each other in time of need underpin our defence relationship with the United States. Those undertakings are stated in the Australia-New Zealand-US (ANZUS) Security Treaty of 1951, in which the parties agreed to "act to meet the common danger". This does not commit Australia or the United States to specific types of actions, but it does provide a clear expectation of support. In this context, Australia chose to invoke the ANZUS Treaty for the first time following the 11 September 2001 attack on the United States Australia and the United States will continue to look for ways to deepen our defence cooperation. Under the umbrella of the Enhanced Defence Cooperation Initiative, agreed between our two countries in 2007, we are exploring how we can develop a combined humanitarian assistance and disaster relief capability to enhance our joint responses to catastrophic regional events. Significant collaboration is also underway in the ISR field, with Australian and US officials actively pursuing new options for enhanced cooperation. Australia and the United States have also agreed to continue development of the Joint Combined Training Capability which both reduces the cost, and improves the quality, of unilateral and bilateral training. Australia will also continue to provide access to training and exercise ranges for US forces, including strategic bombers Satellite communications are vital to the United States and Australia, and we will continue collaboration in this area. The US-Australia Military Satellite Communications Partnership Statement of Principles of 2008 commits both nations to exploring further technical collaboration and joint access to satellite communications capabilities. Without this collaboration, Australia would have to devote significantly more resources to develop the intelligence and communication capabilities we need Both countries are also committed to fostering cooperation in other areas, such as: strategic planning and wargaming; the harmonisation of capability requirements and interoperability; technology access and acquisition; combined operational planning; regional engagement cooperation; missile defence and space situational awareness and mission assurance (which were covered in Chapter 9); research, development, test and evaluation; and logistics and materiel support. Joint Facilities For almost 50 years, through the joint defence facilities, Australia has made a significant contribution to US national security by hosting or supporting some of the United States' most sensitive and critical strategic capabilities. These include systems related to intelligence collection, ballistic missile early warning, submarine communications, and satellite-based communications Australia's geography, stable democratic system, developed economy and technical expertise, combined with our close alliance with the United States, will continue to underpin the enduring value of the joint defence facilities. The contributions of these facilities to global US capabilities both strengthen the alliance and greatly enhance our own capabilities. 94 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

203 11.12 The Joint Defence Facility at Pine Gap near Alice Springs continues to be the pre-eminent example of this strategic cooperation. The capabilities at Pine Gap will evolve to meet new demands and take advantage of new technologies, and the facility will remain a central element of Australia's security and of our relationship with the United States. It will continue to contribute to the intelligence collection capabilities of both countries, support monitoring of compliance with arms control and disarmament agreements, and underpin global strategic stability by providing ballistic missile early warning information to the United States. The activities conducted at Pine Gap will continue to be undertaken on the basis of our full knowledge and concurrence, and with direct capability benefits for Australia. Any future proposal for hosting similar facilities will have to meet the same standards. The Wider Asia-Pacific Region Japan is a critical strategic partner in our region and more broadly, not least because of our shared interests as close US allies. Given its strong national capacity and defence capabilities, Japan can make a significant contribution to the security and reconstruction of fragile states and to the development of greater international capacity in areas such as humanitarian assistance, disaster relief and peacekeeping operations. We will continue to work to develop our practical defence cooperation with Japan, building on our operational cooperation in Iraq and improving the interoperability of our defence forces, bilaterally and with the United States through the Trilateral Strategic Dialogue The 2008 Memorandum on Defence Cooperation will underpin our defence relationship with Japan by providing a framework for expanding practical engagement between the ADF and the Japan Self Defense Forces. The Memorandum recognises the gradual maturation of the defence relationship from one based on dialogue to one based on practical cooperation. Key elements include an expression of intent to further cooperation in counter-terrorism,disaster relief,humanitarian assistance,peacekeeping and maritime security; a commitment to explore cooperation in science and technology; a commitment to develop an annual calendar of defence activities; an emphasis on multilateral and trilateral defence cooperation with the United States; and a formal commitment to regular bilateral Defence Ministers' meetings As China assumes a greater role on the regional and world stage, the Government recognises that Australia must build a deeper understanding of China's security policies and posture. China is critical to stability in Northeast Asia and the wider region. Its approach to regional security in North Asia and the wider region, and how it interacts with our key strategic partners (the United States, Japan, and increasingly India), is fundamental to Australian interests. Along with these countries, China will be central to the development of a cooperative security community in the Asia-Pacific region. Closer to home, we need to engage China as a responsible stakeholder in support of our common desire to see stable, prosperous and well-governed nations in our immediate region Developing our defence relationship with China is therefore a priority. Greater engagement is essential to encourage transparency about Chinese military capabilities and intentions, understand each other's Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

204 approaches and secure greater cooperation in areas of shared interest. To that end, in 2008 we upgraded our bilateral Defence Strategic Dialogue to talks at the Secretary of Defence and Chief of Defence Force level. At a practical level, we are committed to deepening our educational and professional exchanges with China, and to exploring opportunities for future joint activities Australia also has a strong bilateral relationship with the Republic of Korea; one that reflects our mutual interests in regional stability and common alliance with the United States. We will continue to pursue cooperative activities, including peacekeeping training, professional and educational exchanges and defence industry cooperation. The Government will also explore opportunities to work together on maritime security and disaster relief and humanitarian assistance in the region India is an important partner for Australia given our shared democratic values, our maritime interests, and our commitment to combating regional and global terrorism and maintaining a rules-based global security order. As India extends its reach and influence into areas of shared strategic interest, we will need to strengthen our defence relationship and our understanding of Indian strategic thinking. In the near term, we are looking for opportunities to expand high-level defence dialogue, building upon annual talks between the Chief of the Defence Force and his Indian counterpart. We should also increase education and training exchanges and practical cooperation in areas such as defence information sharing, counter-terrorism and peacekeeping Australia and India will have a strong mutual interest in enhancing maritime security cooperation in the Indian Ocean, where we both have key strategic interests to manage. Maritime trade through the eastern Indian Ocean is particularly important for both countries, and we will explore opportunities to work together with India to ensure that those waters are kept secure and open over the decades ahead. The Government has specifically directed Defence to examine opportunities for increased bilateral maritime cooperation Our engagement with major and emerging powers is part of the Government's strategy to develop a regional community with the capacity to forge a constructive Asia-Pacific security environment. We need to secure the constructive engagement of all of the major powers in this arrangement, while promoting the interests of the region's middle powers and protecting the more fragile states in our neighbourhood. This should be an integral part of an Asia Pacific Community that should, ultimately, engage these countries across the spectrum of economic, political and security issues. Southeast Asia For reasons of size, strategic weight, and outlook, Australia's relationship with Indonesia remains our most important defence relationship in the immediate region. Our proximity means we share many of the same security challenges, not least terrorism, narcotics and people smuggling. Australia has a fundamental interest in a stable, unified and democratic Indonesia underpinned by a professional military. Indonesia has undergone a significant transformation since the last Defence White Paper in 2000, and the defence relationship has broadened and matured into a sophisticated partnership. 96 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

205 11.22 The Lombok Treaty on Security Cooperation, ratified in 2008, is the key element in a robust framework of agreements being developed to advance our shared security interests. In the Defence relationship, that framework includes the Joint Statement on Defence Cooperation signed by the Chief of the Defence Force and his Indonesian counterpart in January Our ability to manage this key relationship will be underpinned by the strong commitment by both governments to the sustained advocacy of our shared strategic interests. In coming years we will look to further expand our practical cooperation, exercises, personnel and institutional links, capacity building and strategic dialogue Singapore is another key partner in Southeast Asia. We have a close defence partnership with Singapore based on common strategic understandings and close cooperation between our military forces. We will continue to look for opportunities to expand our combined training and other practical bilateral cooperation, and explore ways we can work together on multilateral peace and security initiatives The FPDA with Singapore, Malaysia, the United Kingdom and New Zealand remains a useful mechanism to confront both traditional and emerging challenges.the arrangements also help to facilitate our strong defence ties with Malaysia, which have been proven during our history of joint operational deployments - including most recently in East Timor - and through our cooperation at RMAF Butterworth Deepening bilateral cooperation with other Southeast Asian countries, including Vietnam and Cambodia, will remain an important goal. We will work particularly closely with modernising defence forces in the Philippines and Thailand, where we will continue to have an interest in helping them develop their counter-terrorism capabilities, and the professionalism of their armed forces as they confront difficult internal security challenges. We will also continue to assist our Southeast Asian neighbours to develop greater capacities to contribute to regional security Defence can also work with neighbours in building regional counter-terrorism capacity. In the recent past, Australia has worked hard with regional nations to establish relationships aimed at strengthening regional counter-terrorism arrangements and capabilities. This is exemplified by our work with Indonesia under the auspices of the Lombok Treaty on Security Cooperation. We have also worked with other regional neighbours, such as Singapore and the Philippines. Defence will continue to undertake its substantial program of cooperation in this crucial area. New Zealand Our defence relationship with New Zealand continues to be reinforced by our work together on successive deployments and combined operations in East Timor, Solomon Islands and elsewhere. Security crises in East Timor, instability in Fiji, and insurgency in Afghanistan underscore the coincidence of our security interests and the critical need for close coordination of defence postures and forces The Government especially reaffirms its commitment through this White Paper to working with New Zealand to promote security, stability and development in the Pacific and East Timor. This requires that we continue to align our approaches to defence relations and capacity-building and preventative Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

206 diplomacy. But we must also plan together on the basis that our combined operations in pursuit of our common security interests, as has occurred over recent years, are the new norm. It is therefore critical that our two defence forces maximise interoperability and align our operational planning, logistics, communications, capability development and procurement activities to the maximum extent practicable As the ADF incorporates new systems and capabilities, maintaining the current level of interoperability between our separate defence forces will require a concerted effort on the part of both countries. With this in mind, Australia and New Zealand should look for opportunities to rebuild our historical capacity to integrate Australian and New Zealand force elements in the Anzac tradition. This operational integration would of course be without prejudice to our respective policy choices. It could be as modest as integrating our air transport logistics support to operations, or as ambitious as an Anzac task force capable of deploying seamlessly at short notice into our immediate region. To be effective, any integrated force elements would need to exercise regularly together as a unified capability. South Pacific and East Timor Australia's security interests in the South Pacific require that we continue to lead efforts to promote economic security, good governance and internal stability. Stabilisation operations will remain an option in extreme cases of instability. But for Australia to make any lasting progress in helping our immediate neighbours our efforts must encompass elements from across government to build capacity and administrative, economic, legal and police institutions. While continuing to lead by example, a key to the success of our efforts will be enlisting the support of regional governments and coordination with other donor countries in the Pacific, including the United States, France, Japan, China, and New Zealand We will continue to work closely with the Government of East Timor and our international partners to adjust the ADF presence as the security situation improves. As this plays out, the focus of our defence engagement will transition to capacity building in order to develop the professionalism and capability of East Timor's defence force, including its capacity to protect East Timor's significant maritime resources In Papua New Guinea (PNG), we will continue to support the development of a professional defence force with improved capabilities in core areas such as border and maritime security. Importantly, we will work closely with the PNG Government to ensure that the PNG Defence Force is affordable and sustainable For over 20 years, the Pacific Patrol Boat Program, and other measures designed to assist in the development of maritime security capacity, have been a feature of our Defence cooperation in the Pacific. Our aim has been to assist our neighbours to develop the capacity to protect their maritime resources and enforce sovereignty. The Government has directed Defence, the Department of Foreign Affairs and Trade and other Australian Government agencies to develop an approach to regional 98 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

207 maritime security that reflects Australia's commitment to assisting our neighbours in these areas in future. In particular, working with regional stakeholders, we will seek measures to enhance the capacity of regional countries to enforce their sovereignty, protect their resources and counter transnational crime. South Asia Aside from Australia's growing relationship with India, discussed in an earlier section, Australia has a range of relationships with the countries of South Asia. Pakistan has pivotal importance in relation to international efforts to defeat terrorism. Pakistan faces a range of challenges in relation to its security, demography and economy. As a nuclear power, fragility in Pakistan could present a real challenge to a stable global order. Australia will need to continue to support Pakistan's democratic institutions while also urging and reinforcing Pakistan's efforts to eliminate terrorist networks from its territory through greater defence engagement and capacity building assistance Australia enjoys a modest defence relationship with Afghanistan. It is based primarily on Australia's ongoing contribution to International Security Assistance Force efforts in Afghanistan that is helping to strengthen security and build the capacity of the Afghan National Security Forces. High-level meetings involving Defence Ministers occur regularly, supplemented by extensive engagement by senior officials. A Defence Attaché is cross-accredited to Kabul from Australia's Embassy in Islamabad. The Middle East and Africa Australia has a range of national security interests in the Middle East, including substantial economic and trade interests, maintaining peace and security within the region, preventing the proliferation of WMD, and helping to ensure global access to Middle East energy reserves. The Middle East is also the location of our longest-running naval deployment, where we have had a continued presence since As the armed forces of Gulf States become more sophisticated, we will continue to pursue opportunities for cooperation It will remain in Australia's interests to encourage peace and stability in Africa as part of our contribution to global security, through targeted defence cooperation and capacity building in areas such as peacekeeping. These efforts will contribute to Africa's capacity to manage its security, and a newlyestablished Defence Attaché to the African Union will strengthen Australia's ability to engage with Africa in areas of mutual interest. The United Kingdom Australia's longstanding defence relationship with the United Kingdom has been strengthened by our recent shared operational experience in Iraq and Afghanistan. We also cooperate in the areas of intelligence, capability development and science and technology. This collaboration is underpinned by closely shared strategic priorities, including in areas such as countering international terrorism and Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

208 the WMD proliferation. We will continue to work with the United Kingdom to enhance interoperability between our forces and improve our ability to work together in coalitions, including as part of the FPDA Building on shared history, our work together in Afghanistan and Iraq provides a strong basis for close cooperation and gives impetus to a more contemporary relationship focused on our common strategic interests, maximising the benefits of interoperability, capability development and training. The announcement of annual senior-level bilateral defence cooperation talks at the 2008 Australia-United Kingdom Ministerial Consultations, to draw together our various dialogues and to set out a strategic framework for future cooperation, demonstrates both nations' continuing commitment to strengthening bilateral defence cooperation into the future. Europe and the North Atlantic Treaty Organization Australia continues to benefit from a broad range of cooperative programs in capability development, materiel, industry, logistics, and science and technology with a range of European countries, especially Spain, France, Germany, Italy and Sweden. We also value our strong practical cooperation with France in the Pacific and Southern Oceans as well as our work in Afghanistan alongside a number of European countries, particularly the Netherlands, United Kingdom, France and Germany Australia's engagement with the North Atlantic Treaty Organization (NATO) and the European Union (EU) centre on three main themes: seeking ways to respond effectively to threats posed by international terrorism; contributing to international counter-proliferation efforts; and sharing the challenge of dealing with the destabilising effects of failing and failed states. Australia's international engagement strategy centres on developing our capacity to work effectively with NATO and the EU to address these challenges where it is in our strategic interests to do so. Our focus will be on developing and enhancing strategic and operational-level mechanisms that support the achievement of coordinated responses. Multilateral Security Globally, Australia's defence relations will remain an important tool to promote our middle power influence; and to build support and capacity for peacekeeping, coalition operations, and other collective security activities in support of a stable global security order. The strength of those relations and the credibility of our alliance relationships enhance our capacity to support the United Nations, NATO and other multilateral institutions Strong and activist engagement with the United Nations will be integral to promoting a favourable global security order. Our regional neighbours generally view the United Nations as an important multilateral entity and one that can be used to shape behaviour in the global security order. The United Nations brings credibility to our peace and security efforts when we operate directly under the auspices or mandate of the United Nations, as we have in East Timor. 100 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

209 11.44 In order to maintain broader regional and global security interests, Australia is a longstanding supporter of key disarmament and arms control initiatives. The threat from state-based WMD programs, and potential access to them by non-state groups, will remain serious security concerns for Australia. The introduction of WMD and their means of delivery into our region would have profound effects on our security and on future defence capability requirements Australia will continue to lead and participate in efforts to promote disarmament and counter-proliferation through practical and cooperative measures. The Government, together with the Government of Japan, recently established the International Commission on Nuclear Non-proliferation and Disarmament seeking to shape a global consensus ahead of the 2010 Nuclear Non-Proliferation Treaty Review Conference. Australia is also an active member of the international Proliferation Security Initiative and remains committed to assisting regional states to implement arms control and nonproliferation treaties, and promote effective national export control regimes. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

210 ChapTEr TwElvE: DEfENCE intelligence 12.1 A strong Defence intelligence capability is central to Australia's strategic posture. It helps to prevent strategic or operational surprise, to inform policy, to stay abreast of developments that complicate the ADF's ability to do what we need it to do, and most crucially, to support our deployed forces on operations. Defence also has a national intelligence role in support of broader national security At its core, Defence intelligence helps decision makers interpret and anticipate complexity and uncertainty by providing intelligence which provides vital inputs to strategic and operational decision making, whether in relation to ADF operations, strategic policy or decisions on capability Specifically Defence intelligence provides: support to the planning and conduct of operations and direct operational support to deployed ADF commanders and units; insights into the strategic posture, policy, intent and military capabilities and proliferation activities of countries relevant to Australia's national security; insights into the actions, capabilities, motives and intent of foreign non-state actors that pose a potential or actual threat to Australia's national security; assessments of conventional and WMD-related weapon systems and defence technologies and knowledge to enable the development of tactics, techniques, procedures and countermeasures to defeat threats to the ADF; collection, analysis and distribution of foreign signals intelligence and geospatial intelligence; guidance on communications, computer and information security to Defence and the Government; mapping, charting and other forms of geospatial support to ADF operations and national security operations and planning; and other functions that go beyond the direct needs of the Defence portfolio and support other agencies in safeguarding Australia's national security. Long-Term Strategic Warning 12.4 Defence intelligence has a vital role in providing us with strategic warning. It gives decision makers time to think, plan and act before events occur. At the strategic level, indicators and warnings help provide the lead time necessary to make longer term capability investments and to adjust plans. This helps to prevent strategic surprise. The modernisation of forces in our region and developments in major power relations are two areas in which this warning function is invaluable. As others in the 102 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

211 region build their military capabilities, we need to anticipate them and plan accordingly in our force development process. As the distribution of strategic power changes, we have to reassess our posture and risk environment. Crisis Warning and Support to Operations 12.5 We must carefully balance the longer term strategic warning function with the crucial operational intelligence function, which is so important to our ability to prosecute operations. At times of crisis or heightened operational periods, Defence intelligence provides timely and action-focused intelligence. This capability is a critical enabler for ADF operations. Crisis warning capabilities enable anticipatory action to be taken in the case of emerging threats and inform ADF planning, readiness and force posture Nowhere is intelligence as critical to decision making as on the battlefield. Every possible advantage that ADF commanders and troops can be given can save lives and protect platforms. The Defence intelligence agencies and their international partners, along with their partners in the broader Australian intelligence community, provide direct operational support to deployed ADF personnel - today in the Middle East, Afghanistan, East Timor and Solomon Islands. Timely intelligence support enables the risks to ADF personnel to be managed while they achieve their operational objectives, and is crucial to the information superiority our forces require. Intelligence Support to Capability Development 12.7 Capability development to plan the future ADF is also supported by the work of the Defence intelligence agencies. Programs need to take account of assessments of the future strategic environment and of emerging and in-service capabilities of other forces and of non-state actors. Similarly, for the current force-in-being, Defence intelligence provides critical information that supports both the development of countermeasures and improvements in doctrine and tactics for systems and capabilities already in service with the ADF. Defence's National Intelligence Role 12.8 Defence intelligence performs a number of roles that support whole-of-government activities. The Defence intelligence agencies help to protect Australia's official communication and information systems; support Australia's whole-of-government counter-terrorism activities, consular activities, sovereignty enforcement and counter-proliferation operations; and provide imagery and geospatial products for national events (such as APEC in 2007). They work as an integrated part of the broader Australian intelligence community, which responds to the directions and priorities of the Government's national security machinery. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

212 Defence Intelligence Review 12.9 The Review of Future Defence Intelligence Capability was an integral part of the White Paper process. The review outlined how Defence's intelligence capability could be developed to meet future operational and strategic needs more cost-effectively than by simply extrapolating the current model and practices. The resulting recommendations will be implemented to deliver a more efficient and effective capability underpinned by a robust support framework that enables the Defence intelligence capability to adapt to expected future circumstances and demands. These recommendations included: the development of a single integrated Defence intelligence ICT capability across the three Defence intelligence agencies to provide intelligence ICT infrastructure and services on a common basis to the maximum extent possible. It will enhance connectivity and provide seamless access to tools and data for users within the intelligence agencies, including other agencies in the Australian intelligence community through the Australian Intelligence Community Network, and specialist ADF units; opportunity for efficiencies in the delivery of shared services such as human resources services within the Defence intelligence environment; and changes to the way that intelligence training is conducted Defence responses to these recommendations are detailed in the following section. Defence Intelligence Capability Into the future, Defence intelligence capabilities need to adapt to operate in new intelligence environments and to support next-generation capabilities and operational and planning activities. The growing volume and complexity of information (including the continuing rise in the range and utility of open source information), together with the demand for more and faster intelligence support require new analytic tools and methods, such as the single integrated ICT capability discussed in the previous section Defence intelligence agencies will have to work in an increasingly integrated fashion with each other and across the Australian intelligence community, with the wider range of Australian agencies with national security roles, and with its international partners, especially to address difficult intelligence targets and issues, and develop new ways of providing information in easily digestible formats. Investment in Defence's intelligence capabilities will reduce operational and strategic risks and will be an important contributor to retaining Australia's overall strategic capability advantage The intelligence agencies rely on highly educated, skilled and effective personnel. Initiatives for recruiting, retaining and developing personnel are evolving within the intelligence agencies, and will be informed by the Defence intelligence review's recommendations on training methods and the delivery of shared human resource services. The agencies are investing in the competition for talent, and 104 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

213 developing programs to identify and recruit people with the necessary skills and knowledge. New intelligence technologies and capabilities depend on having the right people to use them and provide accurate, analysed intelligence The Defence intelligence agencies will utilise new technologies in analysis and assessment of intelligence information. Defence will deliver enhanced capability to support the intelligence needs of Government by providing more timely and effective dissemination of intelligence, and the tools to enable greater collaboration on intelligence production and assessment within the Australian intelligence community and among international partners Ensuring that these new intelligence capabilities are fully integrated with the ADF will be critical to the provision of intelligence support to operations, while also enhancing the ADF's ability to support the intelligence agencies. This will be accomplished by harnessing the outputs of the ADF's ISR assets, along with the intelligence agencies' own capabilities. Integrating this intelligence with the sensors will ensure that maximum support is provided to the war fighter and support for senior decision makers The rapid advance of technology will create challenges and opportunities for the Defence intelligence collection agencies and specialist ADF intelligence units. The increasing mobility, sophistication and agility of potential adversaries requires Australia to have access to advanced signals and geospatial intelligence technologies to maintain our capability edge. The investment outlined in this White Paper will ensure that Defence keeps up with, and exploits technology to meet, this requirement The increasing speed, greater volume and higher security of information will present challenges to signals intelligence access and analysis. Defence will deliver new capabilities to ensure greater access to signals intelligence and more effective analysis of that intelligence. Capabilities to provide diverse signals intelligence access and collection opportunities will be acquired, as well as new analytic tools and methods. Investment in signals intelligence provides a basis for the delivery of the cybersecurity capabilities identified in Chapter Effective command and control, situational awareness and navigation of ADF elements and the provision of appropriate targeting support for advanced weapons systems are fundamentally dependent on accurate and timely geospatial data. That information is derived from imagery that is mainly collected remotely, either from space or from aircraft. The Government has decided to acquire a satellite imaging capability to complement existing plans for airborne imagery collection, providing Australia with a robust, remote imaging capability Relationships with key intelligence partners such as the United States, the United Kingdom, Canada and New Zealand, and wider partnerships and exchanges including within the Asia-Pacific region, will remain vital. They will continue to provide leverage for Australia's own capabilities, and add to the contestability and robustness of the Australian agencies' work. Intelligence relationships will deepen and evolve as Defence increases cooperation in response to shared threats. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

214 12.20 Security of information and personnel will continue to underpin the effectiveness of the Defence organisation. The role of the Defence Security Authority, which promotes an effective security culture through developing Defence's security policies, investigating security breaches and undertaking security vetting of staff for Defence and defence industry, will be developed and improved by the adoption and refinement of new techniques and technologies, such as e-vetting. Accountability and Oversight The Defence intelligence agencies are subject to extensive accountability and oversight to protect important principles such as privacy, and to ensure the legality and probity of intelligence functions In addition to oversight by the Minister for Defence, the Defence intelligence agencies are accountable to the Parliamentary Joint Committee on Intelligence and Security, which reviews administration and expenditure, and the Inspector-General of Intelligence and Security, who provides independent assurance that the intelligence agencies are acting legally and with propriety, and in the case of collection agencies, within the legislative framework of the Intelligence Services Act, Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

215 ChapTEr ThirTEEN: DEfENCE MaNaGEMENT and reform 13.1 Defence has undergone significant change over the past two decades, and the Government recognises the value of the various reforms which have over the years improved the way Defence does business. These stretch all the way back to the consolidation of the Defence group of departments in the early 1970s, and have since included: commercialisation of Defence support functions, starting in the 1980s, which freed up significant military resources which were able to be redirected to combat-related roles; the creation and enhancement of the ADF's joint command and control arrangements in the 1990s, which have been further improved with the establishment of a truly joint and collocated ADF operational headquarters in Headquarters Joint Operations Command; a variety of programs since the 1980s aimed at increasing Defence efficiency; the establishment of the Defence Materiel Organisation (DMO) and a more structured approach to capability development; and the strengthening of Defence's financial control systems, which in recent years has seen a steady reduction in the book value of the uncertainty associated with Defence's financial statements. The Need for Further Reform 13.2 While these efforts have led to significant improvements, they have not fully tackled the fundamental issues regarding Defence's management performance. Further reforms are needed in areas such as strategic planning; capability development; management and procurement; and enterprise support services. Fundamental to the success of such reforms will be a much sharper definition of individual accountabilities for the outcomes the Government expects Defence to deliver, and the processes which underpin them. Defence must become a cost-conscious enterprise in which leaders and managers at every level understand and act on the need to free up the maximum amount of funding for reinvestment in current and future capability. To achieve this, the next wave of reform must be planned, led and managed on a whole-of-enterprise basis. Defence leaders at every level must be clear about, and held to account for, their specific contribution to the success of reform and ultimately the organisation as a whole The Government has endorsed a Strategic Reform Program comprising a comprehensive set of reforms that will fundamentally overhaul the entire Defence enterprise, producing efficiencies and creating savings of about $20 billion. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

216 13.4 The Strategic Reform Program will drive efficiencies without compromising effectiveness. It draws on detailed analysis of almost every aspect of the Defence enterprise, including strategic planning; capability development; the estate; ICT; intelligence; sustainment; logistics; non-equipment procurement; preparedness, personnel and operating costs; science and technology; shared services; and workforce management. This analysis was informed by an independent audit of the Defence budget Governments the world over are facing the most serious economic and financial crisis in decades. In this environment, the Strategic Reform Program will deliver Australia a genuinely strategic and national advantage: savings will be reinvested in capability and Defence's call on national resources constrained. The Strategic Reform Program 13.6 The Government considers deep reform of how Defence does business to be a critical national priority. It will regularly review progress, and will hold Defence leaders and managers to account. In broad terms, the Strategic Reform Program will: provide a vehicle for deep and enduring reform within Defence; enhance management performance within Defence; ensure that productivity within Defence is increased and able to be sustained, so that the maximum possible level of resources are directed to the current and future capability; generally improve the way Defence does business, both in terms of efficiency and effectiveness; and help ensure that the goals set out in this White Paper are delivered The Strategic Reform Program has three key objectives: improved accountability; improved planning; and enhanced productivity. Improved Accountability 13.8 To meet the objective of improved accountability, Defence will: clarify who is accountable for what in relation to key deliverables, in terms of : the outcomes delivered to Government on a daily basis (such as joint capability or policy advice); and underpinning Defence-wide management processes (such as pay and logistics); improve its business planning and enterprise-level risk management functions and capabilities; 108 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

217 ensure that organisational and individual performance is better measured and managed; improve the quality of advice to Government and Ministers; and strengthen its internal audit function. A New Budget Management Model 13.9 To further improve accountability and better manage resources, Defence will provide its senior leaders with greater authority to manage their budgets and non-financial inputs through the introduction of an outputs-driven budget management model This measure will see relevant funding allocated to capability managers (such as the Service Chiefs). The capability managers will agree an appropriate level of affordable and sustainable services with the relevant internal Defence provider (such as the Defence Support Group). On the basis of these agreements, funding will be transparently transferred to the provider group. Central to this model will be consistency and standardisation of support services across Defence bases and establishments. Variations to agreed service levels will be fully costed and only pursued if they represent value for money Through the introduction of output-based budget management, capability managers and service providers will cut unnecessary costs and achieve value for money in delivering the outputs for which they are accountable. This initiative will be based on clear, precise and documented service level agreements and other performance management arrangements.there will be much greater visibility of the true costs of goods and services used within Defence, without the need for complex transfer pricing arrangements. At the same time, Defence will continue to consolidate, centralise and standardise shared services. Improved Planning Improved defence planning processes will be crucial to the success of this White Paper. Government has directed Defence to prepare a new White Paper at intervals no greater than five years as the centrepiece of a new strategic, risk-based approach to defence planning. This five yearly cycle will act as a series of gates for progression of the key aspects of Defence planning. It will consist of the annual Defence Planning Guidance for the first three years; a strategic assessment, force structure review and independent audit update in the fourth year; and development and release of a White Paper in the fifth year In order to ensure a tighter alignment between strategic guidance, capability decisions and resource allocation, the Government has directed that the DPG process is to be overhauled and strengthened Between White Papers, the DPG will become the Government's premier defence planning document. The DPG will need to take into account the Government's national security priorities as outlined in the latest National Security Statement and through the annual national security priority and budget setting mechanisms. This will ensure that Defence's priorities are consistent with the Government's Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

218 overarching national security policy and budget priorities. The National Security Committee of Cabinet will consider the DPG annually, in sufficient time to set strategic direction for Defence's corporate and budget planning cycle, and recommend any necessary adjustments Within Defence, the DPG will set strategic guidance for force structure and capability development, corporate planning, enterprise-level risk management and resource planning, the management of ADF preparedness and critical enabling functions In the year prior to development and release of a White Paper, Defence will prepare for Government consideration a strategic risk assessment that identifies key changes to the strategic environment and any need for change to the principal tasks of the ADF. There will also be a comprehensive force structure review, analysing any new major projects that may come into the Defence Capability Plan in coming years against strategic fundamentals and budgetary constraints. An independent audit update will review the affordability of current and proposed expenditure plans, review performance on all reform activities and identify opportunities for further productivity improvements. Better Managing Defence Costs One of the most important benefits of improved planning will be a strengthened capacity for Defence to understand and manage costs and financial risks. To this end, Defence will focus especially on improving the way it plans and manages major acquisitions, and personnel and operating costs. These reforms will include changes to the capability development process to tighten the link between strategic requirements and capability decisions, and improve the quality of long-term cost estimates The Government has also directed that greater attention be paid in the planning process to the wholeof-life cost dimensions of capability. This will be critical in providing Government with increased levels of confidence with respect to cost, schedule and technical risk when it considers major Defence projects. This will also assist in minimising scope variations in major acquisitions, and help drive down cost pressures While a certain degree of volatility and movement in Defence's costs is to be expected, it will be imperative that, through improved planning, Defence better anticipates and mitigates cost pressures. More generally, the Government expects Defence to build a better picture of long-term costs and a culture of resource efficiency and continuous improvement, with a view to reducing the cost of doing business without creating undue capability or operational risk. Enhanced Productivity The Government expects Defence to become more businesslike, efficient and prudent in its use of resources, with the aim of saving time and money and achieving better economies of scale. Leaders and managers at every level will be expected to promote cost-conscious workplaces in which everyone is mindful of the need to free up resources for investment in current and future capability. 110 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

219 13.21 Reforms to enhance productivity will cover the full spectrum of Defence business and generate significant savings. The introduction of more efficient maintenance techniques will produce savings in the sustainment budget. Other savings will come from reducing 'back office' administrative functions to the most efficient levels; reducing levels of travel and being more efficient in the use of power and utilities; and improved contracting and elimination of low priority purchases In terms of enterprise support services, enhanced productivity will require significant improvements in how Defence undertakes its human resources management, personnel administration, financial services, procurement and contracting, general service delivery, and administrative support functions. Wherever possible, Defence will introduce more centralised and standardised support services and processes, make greater use of e-business, reduce internal red tape and simplify business processes. Reforms in many areas, non-equipment procurement in particular, will require hard decisions involving changes to policies and practices Reforms to the maintenance of military equipment and inventory management will deliver ongoing productivity by redesigning work practices and focusing on the continual reduction of waste from: overproduction; maintenance waiting times; transportation; over-processing; and excess inventory. A rationalisation of the supply-chain network will streamline and strengthen the backbone of military operations The ICT reform program will deliver business efficiencies and lower costs in Defence's information and communications technologies. This will be achieved through measures such as the development of a single Defence desktop environment, an improved network to support higher speed connectivity and the consolidation of Defence's data centres Enhanced productivity will also be achieved through the introduction of an improved, integrated workforce management system. Defence will ensure that it has the right number of workers in the right jobs with the right skills. Significant savings will be achieved through avoiding unnecessary cost premiums by ensuring ADF personnel or expensive contractors are not doing jobs which require a lower and less expensive set of skills and competencies. Implementing the Strategic Reform Program To enable the Government to oversee the implementation of the Strategic Reform Program, a robust governance and assurance framework will be developed. This framework will ensure that Government retains visibility of the progress Defence is making in implementing the White Paper and pursuing reform, and ensure that there is strong personal commitment and ownership across Defence for driving reform Accountability for implementation will be devolved to the line leadership responsible for each area of reform, but will be coordinated centrally through the Strategic Reform Program and underpinned by clear performance measures and milestones. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

220 13.28 Reforms of the magnitude envisaged will take several years to implement. Defence is fully committed to reaping the savings that will flow from reform, all of which will be reinvested in capability. Government recognises the need for Defence to maintain flexibility in the areas that are targeted for savings, how savings are generated and the timing and ramp up of individual savings Defence will develop detailed implementation plans for all reform measures, for which senior leaders will be held accountable. In addition to these specific savings, Defence has also factored into its projected employee costs an allowance for productivity targets that have been judged to be feasible. Managers will be funded for their budget, less this productivity dividend which commences around the middle of the decade when the specific savings measures have been achieved In the case of the DMO, the planned reforms are entirely consistent with the intent of the Defence Procurement and Sustainment Review, conducted in 2008 by Mr David Mortimer AO, that the DMO become more businesslike. The DMO is fully committed to implementing the reforms and reaping the associated savings. As a prescribed agency under the Financial Management and Accountability Act, 1997, it will be important for the DMO to maintain flexibility in how it implements reform A Defence Strategic Reform Advisory Board will be established, chaired by a person from the private sector with the appropriate skills and experience to advise on a significant reform program in a large and complex organisation. The key functions of the Board will be to provide advice on how the reforms should be implemented, and assist in ensuring the reforms are being implemented in the way intended by Government. The Board will comprise an appropriate balance of internal and external members. Public sector members of the Board will include the Secretaries of the Departments of the Department of the Prime Minister and Cabinet, the Treasury, the Department of Finance and Deregulation; and the Secretary of Defence, the Chief of the Defence Force and the Chief Executive Officer of the DMO. To ensure that strategic reform is pursued on a whole of portfolio basis, the Board will encompass the functions of the former Defence Procurement Advisory Board. The Board will report to the Minister for Defence, who will in turn advise the National Security Committee of Cabinet of progress in Defence reform Defence will establish, and resource appropriately, internal arrangements to support and facilitate the reform effort. It will also build the expert capabilities, including by tapping commercial expertise where appropriate, to ensure that deep reform can be implemented successfully and to the standard required by Government. The Secretary and Chief of the Defence Force will lead the reform effort, ensuring there is ownership across the entire organisation and that senior leaders demonstrate personal commitment and take responsibility for particular initiatives. 112 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

221 ChapTEr FOurTEEN: PEOPLE in DEfENCE A Key Strategic Priority - Our People 14.1 People are at the heart of delivering the Defence capability. To support and sustain the current and projected future force and the new capabilities described in this White Paper, we will need to grow the full-time military workforce to approximately 57,800 personnel, and the civilian workforce, including contractors, to approximately 21,900 over the next decade.attracting and retaining the future workforce will be one of the most significant challenges facing Defence, and the Government is determined to ensure that Defence puts in place the right strategies to achieve the required outcomes To ensure that we have the people we need we must be able to respond to a fast-moving and fastchanging labour environment. We must be adaptable to the changing needs of those who serve and those who are attracted to a career in Defence. The Defence People Strategy will address the key issues in building the Defence workforce over time, and provide strategies for how Defence will deliver that workforce. Specifically, Defence will seek to provide a compelling and competitive career offer, professional and personal development, career fulfilment and a safe and healthy workplace. This Strategy will also recognise the critical support that families provide, and the importance of Defence as a unique national institution The Defence People Strategy is informed by a review of Defence's workforce challenges undertaken as part of the White Paper. The Strategy will address the major themes that have emerged from these reviews in responding to our workforce needs and the needs of our people. The first theme to be addressed requires Defence to build the policies and remuneration that will deliver a flexible, effective and efficient workforce. The second commits Defence to an appropriate level of investment to establish and sustain a healthy workforce. The third involves a remix of the employment offer to deliver a competitive package that reflects the contemporary labour market. The final theme recognises that the Defence workforce is under pressure and that we must, as a priority, ensure we maintain capability by investing in and supporting our people to deliver capability today and into the future The Government has directed significant new investment in people initiatives. The effectiveness of this investment will be measured by workforce stability, strong recruiting figures, good retention rates, appropriate separation rates and overall workforce health. Success will be built on the offer of a rewarding career that motivates people to serve and stay, as well as recognition that people want to be more involved in their work, have greater control over their life, and expect higher levels of choice for broader personal and family reasons. The future members of Defence will have more options available to them and Defence understands that it must compete for their talents. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

222 14.5 Defence will also focus on key areas of our workforce that need close attention. Defence will continue to seek new ways to recruit and retain technical trades as well as key professional groups such as tradespeople and health professionals.we will work with women,indigenous Australians,and Australians from a wide variety of ethnic backgrounds to attract these groups to our workforce. Addressing trade shortfalls and ensuring Defence reflects the make up of the broader Australian community are key priorities Recognising the significant workforce challenges presently being experienced by the Navy, the Government will provide funding for additional Navy personnel to fill 700 positions within the Navy's workforce structure. This will address the Navy's current structural hollowness, reduce the pressures on its current workforce, and ensure the Navy can meet the workforce demands of the future maritime capabilities. Additionally the funding will provide the workforce to plan and introduce new capabilities, such as the Future Submarine, AWD, and LHD, and improve the delivery of the Navy's essential governance systems Defence will require a new approach to building and sustaining the workforce requirements of the new submarine capability. The Navy has addressed this through broad initiatives in the New Generation Navy Strategy, as well as providing targeted innovations in Navy's Submarine Sustainability program that cover training, crewing, conditions of service, sea-time and others to ensure that we address current shortfalls and build a robust workforce. The new Submarine Sustainability program comprises a five-phase strategy designed to develop a sustainable submarine force over the next five years. The program focuses on getting more qualified submariners to sea and on improving support for them once deployed. The strain on seagoing submariners will be eased by increasing crew sizes from 46 to 58 people In order to build and sustain the workforce requirements of the Enhanced Land Force and the Adaptive Army initiative, the Army Plan has been developed.this plan sets in place the force structure, disposition and numbers required to grow the Army and will be adapted to meet the needs of this White Paper. The workforce challenges of the Army Plan will be met through the Army People Plan. This plan, which sits within the Defence People Management Framework, identifies the Army's strategic personnel themes and puts in place initiatives to attract, recruit, develop, retain and transition the quality people that the Army needs in order to provide the capability described in this White Paper For the Air Force, the major capability transition over the next decade will mean that the Air Force workforce will need some modest growth and to be reshaped to meet the demands of new systems, processes and modern, flexible employment practices. Further, the Air Force will need to undertake some organisational restructuring to enable our workforce to deliver the significant level of capability enhancement described in this White Paper. 114 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

223 Defence's Strategic Approach to Building our Workforce Strategically, Defence should be rigorous in determining the number and mix of people in the total Defence workforce. Managing the workforce from a total workforce perspective, in terms of total labour cost rather than by a simple measure of numbers in each component of the workforce, will lead to a more strategic delivery of capability and the management of cost While cost and capability issues will influence numbers, skilling and workforce mix, there are a range of people issues that impact on how the workforce is managed. The long-term strategic response to people issues must be to provide adequate investment in people and their conditions. At the same time, Defence must also ensure the leadership, culture and behaviour of the organisation creates a positive environment that builds commitment to perform at a high level and remain in Defence. An unbalanced approach that focuses too much on remuneration or too little on leadership in the workplace will lead to a poor workforce outcome The Government has directed Defence to develop a strategic approach to people. This will be delivered by improving workforce strategy and alignment through the defence people management framework, improving governance arrangements, and an integrated workforce intelligence model. The Defence people strategy will be the foundation on which the future workforce will be built over time. It will be based on a range of initiatives to improve Defence s management of its people, including recruitment, retention, job satisfaction and workplace reform. Over the next four years, the Government will invest in targeted improvements in the areas of remuneration, supporting Defence families, housing and accommodation, health and rehabilitation and diversity. Remuneration The Government has provided funds for improvements to the remuneration of ADF non-commissioned soldiers, sailors, airmen and airwomen, through a new pay structure that provides more appropriate recognition and reward for rank and skill advancement in the ADF. Additionally, rates of pay for trainees undertaking longer-term training is being improved and a new 'trainee allowance' introduced. Supporting Defence Families The Government intends to extend the trial health care arrangements announced in the Budget, and has committed additional funding over the next three years for the provision of basic medical and dental care to Defence families living in remote and regional locations The Government will increase the number of Community Development Officers available to help Defence families access Defence, community and local, State and Federal Government services. The Defence Community Organisation will also develop better arrangements to equip the immediate families of fulltime ADF members with the information and ability to access social networks and support systems in their posting locations. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

224 ADF Housing and Accommodation Defence will develop a simple, transparent and flexible package of housing and accommodation assistance options, aimed at reducing the number of anomalies in the current housing and accommodation assistance policy. The options will provide an outcome that will better meet the emerging challenge of changes in society's expectations, accommodation availability and family structures. Health and Rehabilitation In an environment in which health-care costs are growing, Defence must continue to provide highquality health care in a timely and affordable fashion that supports both operational capability requirements and efficient and effective health support to non-deployed members within Australia. To do this, Defence will reform its health-care delivery options to better achieve greater efficiency and patient satisfaction ADF personnel will be provided with primary outpatient and low-dependency inpatient health care through improved delivery and management of clinical services. Higher acuity inpatient care will also be provided by a small number of ADF facilities. This will include integrated health workforce solutions by uniformed, APS and contracted health-care providers Defence will also develop strategic alliances with State Government and private institutions to provide inpatient health care to ADF personnel from state-of-the-art facilities and additional access to clinical research affecting ADF personnel Defence will implement workforce changes to ensure that the ADF has an effective structure to deliver physical and mental health initiatives and services, such as the ADF Rehabilitation Program, and other measures to reduce the impact of injury and illness within the ADF. These changes offer opportunities for uniformed ADF health-care providers to work in tertiary-level health facilities with improved training and continuous professional development opportunities. The Government is committed to providing the best mental health support to ADF members. Defence will improve the delivery of mental health services by implementing the recommendations of the independent Review of Mental Health Care in the ADF and Transition through Discharge conducted by Professor David Dunt. These physical and mental health initiatives are expected to improve the individual and collective readiness of ADF health personnel to operate in environments in which seriously wounded casualties can be expected. Diversity Programs to increase recruitment opportunities for women, indigenous and multicultural Australians, including an indigenous development program, will also be implemented. 116 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

225 Better Management - An Integrated Workforce Strategic reform will create an integrated workforce that has the right mix of military, civilian and contractor personnel, able to deliver a cost-effective, flexible and adaptable workforce best placed to meet the future challenges outlined in this White Paper, as well as to manage temporary workforce shortages and address critical skill deficiencies Defence will seek to optimise the workforce mix by employing permanent ADF members where there is a direct requirement to do so. On average, full-time military personnel cost around 30 per cent more than their civilian counterparts, due to conditions of service. Where part-time military or Australian Public Service personnel can perform the task, their employment can be a more efficient use of Defence funds Contracted personnel also form part of the Defence workforce mix.however,non-deployable contractors cost Defence more than their equivalents in the Australian Public Service (on average around per cent more due to market pricing). Defence will examine areas where positions can be converted from contractors to the Australian Public Service Proposed changes to the Defence workforce mix will not compromise Australia's defence capability. Approximately 78 per cent of current ADF members are posted to combat or combat-related roles, and that will not change. The remaining 22 per cent are posted to military support roles. The introduction of reform will address retention and diversity considerations, and will take into account the important role of military positions in areas such as training, respite, trade sustainability, representative duties and specialist military skills The ADF Reserves are a fundamental element of Defence's workforce. Over the foreseeable future, the composition and capability of the ADF Reserves will change as Defence's integrated workforce matures. In adapting the role of the ADF Reserves, Defence will work to streamline the transition between full and part-time service during an ADF career This will be particularly important for the Army, which will consider the contribution of part-time service in detail during the preparation of its implementation plan for the Army's force structure. This plan will be developed within the strategic guidance and funding parameters of this White Paper. The plan will propose options that will include the contribution of the ADF Reserves to Defence capability. Retention ADF personnel remain in the Navy, Army or Air Force as a consequence of loyalty to the organisation, their job satisfaction, their remuneration, and their conditions of service. They leave because of location instability, impacts on families, long separations and lack of employment for spouses in remote locations, job dissatisfaction, and perceived career development limitations. To compete for Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

226 their continued commitment, Defence must offer remuneration and conditions of service that address, among other things, frequent posting moves, housing, spousal employment, children's education and family support. Recruitment In conjunction with the retention measures discussed above, the Defence People Strategy will propose measures to increase Defence's competitiveness in the recruitment marketplace. This will redefine Defence's employment offer to make it more attractive as a rewarding career in which people are motivated to serve and stay As part of this package, Defence will clearly articulate who it is, what it offers, how it fulfils its obligations, and why that should be attractive to its current and future workforce. Importantly, Defence must be clear about what it expects from the workforce in return, by clearly articulating the mutual responsibility of Defence and the individual employee or ADF member. Internal Workplace Reform Government has also directed Defence to substantially reform the workforce to drive productivity improvements, based on three initiatives: a leaner, more effective business support model; a largely civilianised and professionalised non-deployable military workforce; and the conversion of contractor positions to less expensive full-time civilian positions To deliver a more effective human resource business support model, Defence will redesign its core business processes to streamline and automate workflows where possible; revise the level of services offered; consolidate and centralise like functions through the increased use of shared services for functions such as payroll and accounts receivable; and improve recruiting and non-equipment contracting services. This will be critically dependent on the implementation of new information technology solutions that will improve administration and pay for Defence. 118 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

227 ChapTEr FiFTEEN: SUPPOrTiNG THE adf 15.1 In all of Defence's activities, from operational deployments and day-to-day business activities to the strategic management of the organisation, enabling support functions are critical to success. Enabling functions are considered to be the 'backbone' of Defence business, and include our ICT systems, bases and infrastructure, and logistics and other support services. These areas support the ADF through the delivery of facilities, materiel, garrison support, information and other services. Other support functions, such as procurement and sustainment, and science and technology support, are covered in other Chapters of this White Paper In many cases, the challenges outlined in this White Paper will change the nature and types of business that Defence does. The fast pace of technological change, the introduction of new capabilities and the continued high operational tempo of the organisation, mean that Defence's support functions must be managed effectively and efficiently, and re-examined periodically for their future effectiveness The critical services provided by the Defence backbone were reviewed during the development of this White Paper, with the aim of optimising support to the ADF in cost-effective ways well into the future. Information and Communications Capability 15.4 Future demands on Defence ICT include an increasing focus on information superiority and the networked capabilities discussed in Chapter 9. The prospect of new disruptive technologies that could threaten network capabilities will also increase, as will the threat and complexity of cyber warfare Defence's information and communications capability has developed over many years, and there is a need to draw together the various Defence communications and information domains into a single, properly governed information environment, delivering a capability fully aligned with the priorities set by the Chief of the Defence Force and Secretary The ICT reform program will deliver business efficiencies and lower costs in Defence's information and communications technologies. This will be achieved through such measures as the development of a single Defence desktop environment, an improved network to support higher-speed connectivity, and the consolidation of Defence's data centres, from 200 to fewer than ten. More robust governance arrangements for Defence's ICT spending and the management of the Defence information environment will also be implemented. These measures will improve operational effectiveness and corporate functions The proposed reforms will deliver to Defence a secure and robust ICT capability that supports war fighting and business requirements. All Defence personnel, regardless of location, will be able to access and share information and collaborate with their counterparts in Defence, the Government and industry, and other allied or coalition partners, using social networking capabilities. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

228 15.8 There will be one network connecting fixed and deployed locations built on a single set of standards and approved products that encompass all security levels and the ability to determine that the right person has the right authority to access information and services. A typical desktop set-up, available to all Defence sites, will be a single screen connected to a wireless network that can display multiple security 'sessions' Secure voice and video will be available to the desktop in most fixed and deployed locations. Deployed commanders and strategic decision makers will have a single view of the battlespace through a single Common Operating Picture accessing a wide range of data from sensors and sources, whilst corporate data will be easily accessed, manipulated and aggregated by Defence staff The reform program will see Defence with an enhanced ICT platform that will be characterised by tighter cost control, greater efficiencies (which will be reinvested in new capabilities), and faster decision cycles focused on delivering high-quality ICT services delivered to Defence. There are five key initiatives in the ICT reform package: optimising the value of Defence ICT investment through development of a single portfolio for ICT funding across all parts of Defence, the production of a single work plan for the Defence Information Environment, data centre consolidation and an ICT Products and Services Catalogue; closer stakeholder engagement and alignment through the implementation of a more responsive stakeholder engagement model. The Chief Information Officer will become the Coordinating Capability Manager for all Defence ICT; provision of agreed priority solutions involving the creation of an enterprise architecture across Defence, consolidation and simplification of the technology base, standardised ICT solutions, and the creation of a single information environment; strengthening ICT capability through the consolidation of software and application purchases and maintenance, re-engineering the ICT capability development and delivery methodologies, and developing better Defence ICT career path management and workforce planning arrangements; and programming the ICT Reform to integrate ICT reform agendas across Defence and delivering the required governance arrangements to take the reform program forward Reforming Defence's information environment will be a complex undertaking, and must necessarily be undertaken in stages. Some changes are already underway, including implementing new mechanisms to better govern ICT investments and spending across all parts of Defence, and implementing new sourcing strategies where ICT services will be procured through more centralised frameworks and through more strategic and enduring arrangements with fewer numbers of vendors. In the future, additional changes will also be necessary to consolidate a 'whole of Defence' approach to ICT planning and decision making. 120 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

229 15.12 Adopting a single Defence enterprise architecture will be a significant change to ICT planning and investment processes within Defence. As the architecture matures, a more centralised and consolidated approach to delivering ICT services and infrastructure will be implemented. As a result, Government will make changes in scope, acquisition strategies, delivery methodologies and levels of funding for a number of ICT-related capital acquisition projects while maintaining the current level of investment. This initiative in itself will ensure a more targeted approach to ICT investment, reduce risks and improve 'time to market' for the delivery of new ICT capabilities Assured access to military and commercial satellite communications will be needed into the foreseeable future. The core satellite communication capabilities for the ADF will continue to be provided through access to the Wideband Global System operated by the United States, which will provide global broadband communications for fixed and large mobile platforms. This will be complemented by narrow-band ultra high frequency (UHF) satellite capabilities, mainly to support mobile land forces There are a number of initiatives for access to narrow-band satellite communications capabilities in planning. These include capabilities to support military operations in the ADF's primary operational environment, as well as globally. The scope of the projects may well change depending on commercial, technical and alliance opportunities. The Government will accelerate decision making on UHF satellite communications capabilities needed to support land operations. In the future Australia will look to jointly pursue the development of satellite capabilities - both commercial and military - with the United States and other allies. The US-Australia Military Satellite Communications Partnership Statement of Principles of 2008 commits both nations to exploring further technical collaboration and joint access to satellite communications capabilities. The Defence Estate The Defence estate is the largest and most complex land and property holding in Australia. It provides the facilities which directly enable the generation, projection and sustainment of operational capability. The Defence estate also supports our personnel, providing them with a safe place to work and their families to live The Government has agreed on the following strategic basing principles to meet the future needs of Defence: Defence base locations should be aligned with strategic requirements and ensure critical capabilities are suitably dispersed for security reasons; Defence should consolidate units into fewer, larger and sustainable multi-user bases aimed at increasing the alignment of functions at Joint and Service level and their capacity to support operations; Defence should aim to group bases near strategic infrastructure and industry to promote knowledge sharing, innovation, and to maximise the effectiveness of industry support to the ADF; Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

230 where possible, Defence should locate bases in 'family friendly' areas which provide better employment, specialist medical and educational opportunities for families, and with the potential to reduce posting turbulence in order to improve retention; and Defence should maintain an urban and regional disposition to enable the continued provision of part-time capability into the future The Government will invest $200 million over the next four years in the Defence estate. Defence will also introduce improvements to estate planning to ensure that funding is prioritised according to the ADF's capability needs, the strategic basing principles and to maximise value for money from Defence's facilities works contracts Defence bases, training areas and ranges are increasingly under pressure from urban encroachment. Residential developments are now much closer to operating Defence sites, giving rise to concerns about impacts on the community including aircraft, vehicle and other noise, explosions and other activities. Defence will continue to work closely with state and local government planning authorities to ensure the ongoing sustainability of Defence sites and the management of any impacts on communities Environmental management is another important aspect of the sustainability of the Defence estate. Defence is the responsible steward of 3.4 million hectares of land and over 120 Commonwealth heritage listed sites. Effective environmental management is not only vital in its own right, but is essential to ensure the long-term sustainability of ADF capability and the Defence estate. Through sustainable environmental management, Defence aims to leave a positive legacy for future generations, while preserving the capacity to undertake land, sea and air activities necessary to support ADF capability. Infrastructure Enhancements to Support Capability The mounting of Defence operations relies upon significant infrastructure support. Darwin and Townsville remain critical ports for operations in the defence of Australia and in our immediate neighbourhood, although southern ports and bases also play a vital role. Some ports are limited in their ability to support operations due to the current physical and logistics infrastructure, including loading facilities, the availability of large vehicle marshalling areas and the reliable provision of specialist stores, such as naval aviation fuel and explosive ordnance The Government has decided to enhance some specific infrastructure to support the mounting and sustainment of operations, including: remediation of instrumented ranges used for testing and evaluation (including Woomera in South Australia); lengthening the wharf in Townsville and providing a new boat ramp in Darwin to facilitate the loading and unloading of our LHDs: and enhancing fuel storage capacity in both Townsville and Darwin. 122 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

231 Defence Support Services In addition to those support functions described earlier, Defence support services also include personnel, family, accounts, other financial and business support services, as well as non-equipment procurement and contracting advice, garrison support services and the provision of accommodation, meals and other supplies. Defence spends around $5 billion a year on these support services The cornerstone of improvement to Defence support services will involve maximising the delivery of services and the development of better buying and contracting practices to ensure a more efficient service to the organisation. Defence will also consolidate, centralise and standardise 'like' services, delivering improved shared services such as garrison support, payroll, human resources and finance functions and developing more efficient methods of service delivery. A new 'centre of excellence' will be created within the Defence Support Group to provide advice and carry out the standardisation process. Consequential workforce impacts will be carefully planned and managed, and subject to appropriate consultation with staff These reforms have the potential to produce significant savings over the decade in productivity improvements to non-equipment procurement spending. Workforce reductions are also expected from the consolidation and centralisation of services. Whilst the efficiency and productivity improvements will see reductions, overall there will be a net growth in the workforce through White Paper initiatives, civilianisation of military back office functions and insourcing of contractor support. Consequential workforce impacts would be carefully planned and managed, and subject to appropriate consultation with staff To achieve the required outcomes of reform of Defence support services, the proposed changes will challenge the orthodoxies about demand and consumption policy and how services have traditionally been provided. The emphasis will be on adopting a more commercial mindset to guarantee productivity improvements and efficiency gains while providing the support vital for a capable ADF This approach will require the introduction of a whole-of-defence enterprise resource management system coupled with stronger governance arrangements to deliver an improved performance management framework.these changes will provide budget transparency,clearer lines of accountability, improved product costing, garrison support, estate management information, and personnel and financial support systems. Joint Logistics A robust, flexible and responsive logistics system is at the heart of the ADF's capability. To attain the standard of logistics support required for the ADF in the future, Defence will improve its logistics infrastructure network, optimising the use of associated technologies and then applying similar reforms to its retail network. Defence will also optimise its equipment maintenance. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

232 15.28 Therefore, the Government has decided to rationalise the Defence storage and distribution network. Outdated facilities will be replaced and Defence's 24 wholesale sites will be consolidated into seven, supported by seven specialist logistics units. The rationalisation will optimise the storage and distribution functions of Defence to provide effective operational support sustainably and efficiently. Furthermore, Defence will pursue the most cost-effective procurement option, which could potentially involve a public-private partnership arrangement. To drive better value into its contracts, Defence will also re-tender its base storage, distribution and maintenance function Defence's fuel management will be improved.this will have national impacts, as Defence is a significant national user of fuel. A strategic fuel management program will be put in place to coordinate all aspects of fuel management Defence will pursue opportunities for significantly increasing the productivity of logistic support activities in inventory management and the supply-chain. Reform will focus on optimising inventory holdings through improved modelling and analysis of inventory requirements. The Government has directed that Defence both reduce the size of inventory holdings and improve the alignment between inventory holdings and actual demand to optimise the return on expenditure. 124 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

233 ChapTEr SixTEEN: PrOCUrEMENT, SUSTaiNMENT and industry SUPPOrT 16.1 Procurement, sustainment, and industry support are critical to defence capability and operational effectiveness. The ADF requires a deep, diverse and secure supply chain to acquire and maintain the capabilities it needs, and Defence's procurement and sustainment systems must continue to be as flexible and responsive as possible. Procurement Reform 16.2 The Government requires the DMO to deliver military acquisition and sustainment projects on-time, onbudget and to the required level of capability, safety and quality. The process of Defence procurement and sustainment has undergone significant reform over the years, and there have been a number of important achievements. Following the 2003 Defence Procurement Review, the DMO became a prescribed agency under the Financial Management and Accountability Act, 1997 in July In May 2008, the Government commissioned an independent, formal evaluation of the DMO and a re-examination of Australia's defence acquisition and sustainment process. Conducted by Mr David Mortimer AO, the review recommended a more commercially-focused DMO in order to promote improved outcomes for Defence In response to the Mortimer Review, the Government supports the need for the DMO to become more businesslike and recognises the urgent need to make further changes to the way Defence develops, acquires and sustains military capability. The Government has directed the DMO to launch a significant internal change program, building on what Mr Mortimer identified as a strong record of reform since the 2003 Kinnaird Review Four key principles will underpin the DMO's more businesslike approach. First, the entire Defence portfolio must become more accountable to Government and more transparent in managing the billions of dollars invested in developing and acquiring military capabilities Second, as the key implementation body within the Defence portfolio, the DMO must strengthen its capacity to provide independent advice on the cost, risk, schedule and acquisition strategies for major capital equipment Third, the DMO must develop a stronger businesslike culture to deliver projects on-time, on-budget and to the agreed requirements. To complement this, there will also be substantial change within the rest of Defence to improve the way the capability development process is carried out. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

234 16.8 Fourth, the already strong procurement relationships within the Defence portfolio must be further strengthened. In particular, Defence will clarify the authorities, roles and responsibilities of the Defence capability managers, the DMO and other Defence stakeholders, and ensure earlier engagement between the DMO and the Capability Development Group Later this year, the Government will publicly release an implementation plan for building a more businesslike and commercial culture in the DMO. The plan will: set quantifiable key performance indicators and measures of success, in particular by providing directors of the DMO's Systems Program Offices with a charter of responsibilities and accountabilities; identify the individuals who will be accountable for delivering the cultural change plan; specify necessary structural and staffing changes within the DMO, which will include a strengthening of the DMO's senior level commercial expertise; and develop an appropriate framework for the DMO to report to Ministers and the Parliament. Smart Maintenance Defence will also pursue opportunities for significantly increasing the productivity of the supporting maintenance activities.maintenance reform will focus on eliminating waste and reducing incidental work in the supply-chain processes. Defence will roll out a program of established efficiency management techniques, which will deliver ongoing productivity, increased equipment availability and savings Productivity improvements in maintenance and supply-chain processes performed internally by Defence and externally by defence industry will be targeted. Defence will also develop appropriate incentive arrangements in its future maintenance contracts to encourage industry providers to implement ongoing productivity improvements. Defence will expect industry to make commensurate productivity improvements to maintain their long-term supply opportunities. International Defence Materiel Relationships The DMO maintains a number of relationships with allies and other partner nations in order to ensure that Australia has access to the world's best technologies, systems and capabilities; to promote best practice in defence contracting; and to coordinate global responses to commercial behaviours in the international defence supply chain The DMO uses those relationships to identify interoperability objectives, explore collaborative activities, share data on reciprocal projects, benchmark acquisition and sustainment processes, and streamline technology transfer arrangements. Recent examples include technical exchanges of information on submarines, radar systems and stealth characteristics. The relationship with the United States is particularly important in this regard. 126 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

235 Industry Capacity A significant proportion of the funding allocated to Defence for the procurement of goods and services is likely to go to locally-based companies, which are a key element of the Australian industrial landscape. The Government expects Defence to ensure best value for money in Defence spending, based on open and effective competition Major defence acquisitions are large in scale and scope. Some sensitive or classified programs can only be delivered by skilled Defence professionals. The DMO's and industry's workforces need to be highly skilled if the ADF is to gain maximum return on the Government's investment The DMO and Australian industry face many challenges in delivering the required capability to the ADF. In the recent past, Defence's major capital equipment projects have suffered schedule delays because of constraints on the availability of sufficient skilled Defence industry workers. This has resulted in unplanned slippage of defence capital expenditure and schedule delays against agreed milestones While Defence will seek to maximise the spending in local defence industry, such expenditure must be managed within the acceptable cost, schedule and risk constraints of the strategic guidance in this White Paper. Project requirements must ultimately reflect the demands of operational performance, but they need to be tempered by an understanding of cost, risk and what the market can deliver, including 'off-the-shelf'. The Government needs to make informed decisions about the appropriate mix of cost, risk and capability. Consequently, the Government has decided that military-off-the-shelf and commercial-off-the-shelf solutions to Defence's capability requirements will be the benchmark against which a rigorous cost-benefit analysis of the military effects and schedule aspects of all proposals will be undertaken. Such an approach is consistent with the Defence Procurement and Sustainment Review. Defence Industry Policy The Government recognises the important role that defence industry plays in support of ADF capability, from the provision and maintenance of military equipment to the delivery of a wide range of support services. Growing the capacity and competitiveness of local defence industry is a policy objective of the Government and will require ongoing investment in skills development, workforce growth and improved productivity. The Government will remain closely engaged in defence industry policy to ensure that Australian industry provides the maximum support possible to the ADF while maintaining control of cost, schedule and quality The best way to manage, over time, a real increase in local industry capacity and competitiveness is to continue to grow local industry at an achievable rate. As a consequence, Defence will adopt procurement and industry strategies to grow local industry capacity and competitiveness, including: increasing industry capacity and competitiveness through targeted productivity and workforce growth initiatives; Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

236 building greater flexibility into Defence Capability Plan reprogramming to mitigate the adverse capacity and capability impacts associated with large expenditure peaks and troughs; and if necessary, increasing the amount of offshore expenditure, to a level that allows for a more managed, sustainable and achievable local industry growth rate Total self-sufficiency in defence industry capabilities would be impractical for a nation of Australia's size, and is not necessary in any event under our defence policy as explained in Chapter 6. The Government is committed to ensuring that certain strategic industry capabilities remain resident in Australia. Defence should not pay a premium for local industry work, unless the costs and risks of doing so are clearly defined and justifiable in terms of strategic benefits. Choices are necessary when identifying which local industry capabilities should have priority To this end, Government has decided to establish priority industry capabilities (PIC), which are defined as those industry capabilities which would confer an essential strategic capability advantage by being resident within Australia, and which, if not available, would significantly undermine defence selfreliance and ADF operational capability. The Government is prepared to intervene in the market to ensure that PICs remain healthy and available The Government will determine the level and focus of assistance necessary to support PICs through a rigorous process based on clear criteria. The National Security Committee of Cabinet will make decisions about whether and how to support PICs. Support would only be provided in cases where market failures would be so detrimental to our strategic interest as to justify such intervention. The Government would take the following factors into account in making any intervention decision: the criticality of the industry capability to our posture of defence self-reliance; the value-for-money represented by such intervention; the 'health' of the industry sector, in terms of workforce size and skill levels; capacity constraints; individual firm viability (in cases where this would be justified); and market structure Possible intervention strategies might include demand management by Defence, export promotion and support, skills development, investment facilitation, and long-term contracting arrangements to assist firms in terms of access to finance and productivity investment decisions. The Government has also decided that Centres of Excellence be established to address any identified capability and capacity shortfalls in PIC categories. These centres will have a number of roles, including managing skill enhancement programs, targeting research and development activities, and exploiting commercialisation and export opportunities The Government has decided not to publicly identify in detail the specific capabilities that are likely to attract PIC support. To do so would confer an advantage on any adversary seeking to exploit critical 128 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

237 strategic vulnerabilities, and would compromise commercial leverage. However, the Government accepts that the maximum level of transparency consistent with this constraint is desirable The Government has directed Defence to develop strategic policy advice (in the context of the annual DPG) for its consideration on the strategic basis for identifying those industry capabilities which would attract priority support as PICs. On the basis of that strategic advice and employing the criteria explained in this Chapter, the Government will decide on levels of support for PICs in a rigorous manner which ensures that value-for-money is achieved To assist this process, the Government will monitor a broad range of industry capabilities, such as: 'high-end' system and 'systems of systems' integration capabilities, including for EW development, the protection of networks and computers, including in the field of cyber defence, communications security testing services and through-life support of cryptographic equipment, and system life cycle management capabilities to maintain and extend the service life of ADF systems; naval shipbuilding, including specialist design and engineering services; warship repair, maintenance and upgrade capabilities, and essential facilities; submarine design and construction, repair, maintenance, upgrade and overhaul capabilities; selected development, production, upgrade and through-life support of underwater acoustic technologies and systems; development, repair and precision machining of composite and exotic materials, signature management capabilities and coatings, and anti-tampering capabilities; the ability to produce selected ballistic munitions and explosives; repair, maintain, test and evaluate guided weapons; repair, maintain and upgrade capabilities in relation to infantry weapons, small arms and remote weapons stations on combat vehicles; through-life and real-time support of mission and safety critical software; system assurance capabilities for both ICT hardware and software; the repair and maintenance of specialist AEW&C systems; the development and through-life support of JORN and phased-array radars; secure test facilities and test ranges; the development and support of targeting and precision navigation capabilities; development of capabilities in the field of combat clothing and personal load carriage equipment; repair and maintenance of armoured vehicles; and the repair, maintenance and upgrade of rotary- and fixed-wing aircraft In addition to these initiatives, the Government has decided to develop and implement a range of measures to overcome capability and capacity shortfalls in both prime suppliers and small to medium enterprises. These measures include: encouraging international prime contractors to take up opportunities for local industry participation in international global supply chains; Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

238 enhancing the Skilling Australia s Defence Industry (SADI) program to expand the pool of appropriately skilled workers, enhance work and career pathways in the defence industry sector and address specific defence industry capability and productivity gaps. In particular, the SADI programs will continue to work with defence industry, secondary schools, universities and other institutions to encourage students to enter engineering courses and then to mentor and create career pathways for those that do so; developing of a skilling program specifically targeted at improving Australia s system integration and engineering skills base; and if necessary, rebalancing offshore and local procurement activities Through these reforms, Defence will deliver an improved capability procurement and acquisition service to Government. Guided by a stronger businesslike philosophy, increased accountability and greater efficiency, the DMO will support and sustain the ADF in its pursuit of the strategic priorities outlined in this White Paper. 130 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

239 ChapTEr SEvENTEEN: DEfENCE SCiENCE and TECHNOLOGY Australia's Strategic Capability Advantage: The Science and Technology Dimension 17.1 The future operating environment of the ADF will be shaped in very large measure by changes in military technology and its employment, especially in the Asia-Pacific region. Superiority in combat and other forms of military operations will hinge on continual advances in military technology, especially in areas such as EW, precision targeting, stealth and signature management, battlespace awareness, command and control and information networking In particular, the ready availability of commercial-off-the-shelf military systems, including those which rely on sophisticated electronics and computing, will increasingly enable less developed countries and non-state actors to acquire modern weapons as well as electronic, surveillance and communications systems. The ADF will be required to operate in an environment which is increasingly complex, as more potential adversaries will have access to a wider range of capabilities which are comparable to ours, or will be able to exploit vulnerabilities in ours As the United States continues to invest heavily in modernising its military forces, the challenge for allies of maintaining interoperability with US forces will also increase, and the transfer of especially sensitive technologies, which are likely to give US forces a winning edge, will be restricted to a few very trusted partners and controlled carefully. At the same time, the United States will seek technology collaboration with trusted partners in the development of new systems. Australia will be well placed to cooperate in such endeavours In this environment, Australia's self-reliant scientific and technological capabilities will become a relatively more critical element of our strategic capability advantage, as will collaboration with our scientifically and technologically advanced allies and friends, particularly the United States, and access to special technologies and capabilities A continued focus on the exploitation and application of new advanced technologies will be especially crucial in ensuring that the ADF has access to highly advanced and networked capabilities.the ADF will also require a winning edge in terms of information superiority (especially in relation to comprehensive situational awareness, rapid decision making and precise force application) This Chapter outlines the role of Defence science and technology in ensuring that we maintain the strategic capability advantage we need. Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

240 The White Paper Review of Defence Science and Technology 17.7 Recognising these factors, Defence undertook a review of its scientific and technological activities as part of the White Paper process, encompassing the DSTO, as well as the academic and industry contribution to science and technology support to Defence. The review examined those capabilities required to: innovate and adapt generally available technology for Australia's specific defence purposes; access classified technologies and capabilities from allied sources; and commercialise defence technologies and weapon systems within Australian industry The review found that in order to maintain our strategic capability advantage, Australia must have deep defence science and technology expertise. It must work hard to preserve its relative advantage in this area. The review examined Defence's science and technology activities in four major areas. Firstly, 'future-proofing' Defence by increasing the resources available to focus on the early stage of capability development. Secondly, implementing an enhanced governance model for the DSTO. Thirdly, simplifying the mechanisms for prioritising the DSTO's funding to support the development of capability, and adjusting the DSTO's internal business and management structures. Finally, providing greater clarity around the delivery of Defence science and technology to support non-defence national security capabilities. The Government's response to this review is explained in this Chapter. The Defence Science and Technology Organisation 17.9 The DSTO's mission covers the full spectrum of science and technology support for Defence, namely: support to ADF operations; support to the current force; advice throughout the planning and development phases of defence acquisition programs including advice on all aspects of technical risk and risk mitigation strategies; and enabling and long-range research to support future defence needs including by way of monitoring and exploiting breakthrough technologies The DSTO has major research facilities located in Melbourne and Adelaide, with additional research facilities in Sydney, Brisbane, Perth, Canberra and Scottsdale. The DSTO's 2,300 staff of predominantly scientists, engineers, IT specialists and technicians work in critical Defence technology areas such as Air Vehicles and Air Operations; Maritime Platforms and Maritime Operations; Land Operations; Command, Control and Communications and Intelligence; EW and Radar; ISR; Weapons Systems; Joint Operations; Human Protection and Performance; and Counter-Terrorism. The Defence-focused expertise of its staff and the scale and depth of its research infrastructure enables the DSTO to carry out highly classified research, from basic science right through to the development of engineered prototypes. 132 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

241 DSTO Support to ADF Operations The DSTO provides direct support to current ADF operations, including through attachment of the DSTO staff to deployed units. The DSTO will continue to embed specifically trained analysts and technologists into areas of operation to provide immediate support to deployed units. The DSTO's deployed staff will be able to rapidly reach back to Australian-based facilities to modify and adapt equipment and procedures to meet the changing requirements in areas of operation. Countering improvised explosive devices (IED), for example, requires a suite of force protection measures ranging from blast protection, electronic countermeasures, enhancements to communications and personnel protection equipment through to predicting as best we can the adversary's intentions, using modelling and analysis. The DSTO has been heavily involved in these efforts in recent years. DSTO Support to the Current Force The DSTO will support the current and projected force in terms of increasing operational effectiveness, improving safety, maximising asset availability and reducing the cost of ownership of assets. The DSTO supports major platforms throughout their life to ensure, as they age, that the capability, availability and safety provided and the cost of ownership continue to meet Defence requirements. For example, as the Collins class submarines age, the DSTO will continue to use its major facilities and expertise in areas such as propeller design, materials, sensors and networks to maintain them as an effective military capability. These activities will also position the DSTO to support development of the future submarine capability. Supporting Effective Capability Decision Making The DSTO will provide enhanced support throughout the planning and development phases of defence acquisition programs using its expertise in evaluating defence projects, and will advise on all aspects of technical risk including risk mitigation strategies, in close partnership with the Capability Development Group and the DMO. In supporting acquisition, the DSTO will increase its efforts early in the capability life cycle, in line with recommendations of the 2008 Defence Procurement and Sustainment Review, applying its knowledge of future technologies, combined with modelling, testing and simulation skills, to reduce the potential risks and costs in later phases of acquisition. The DSTO has already initiated a coordinated and comprehensive approach to the capability requirements of the new air combat capability and the Future Submarine capability As more technologically-advanced systems are introduced into the ADF, there will be an increasing need for independent, deeply-informed science and technology support to reduce capability risk, and in integrating capabilities into the force structure. For example, new weapon and sensor systems and their integration with ADF platforms will need to be more intensively supported through software and hardware modelling, simulation and live trials. The DSTO will maintain the ability to conduct both virtual Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

242 and real testing of full-scale units, both weapon systems and platforms, to provide assurance of the capability advantage The DSTO will apply a whole-of-organisation approach to minimise capability risk through a combination of its technical expertise, knowledge of operations analysis within a joint operations framework, ability to work with military subject matter experts, a rigorous approach to systems-level evaluation, a deep knowledge of the international defence science and technology landscape through its longstanding involvement in international partnerships, and its close links with the intelligence community. Long-Range Defence Research Activities The DSTO will continue a significant program of research into forward-looking enabling technologies such as hypersonics, computer security, electro-optics and smart materials which will impact future Defence capability. With the pace of technology change increasing, and the time for technologies to reach maturity and obsolescence decreasing, leaps in technology developed in the civilian sector can also be strategically disruptive, and need to be monitored closely as a result. The DSTO will investigate emerging technologies such as nanotechnology and biotechnology, generally developed for civilian purposes, to assess how they may be used for Defence purposes and whether they may be potential threats. The DSTO will work with intelligence agencies and international partners to better understand global developments in such areas, and how they may impact on Australia's strategic capability advantage. Building the DSTO of the Future To ensure that the DSTO is well positioned to be at the forefront of key technologies, Government has decided to fund a program of technology upgrades in the DSTO s laboratories and technical facilities. This will include investment in facilities such as the DSTO s missile simulation centre and phased array radar testbed The DSTO will also increase its investigation and application of key enabling technologies which will provide significant returns for development of the future force, such as: integrated ISR; cyber warfare (including computer security); electronic warfare; underwater warfare; and networked systems. Enhanced Governance Arrangements for the DSTO The Government has established an Advisory Board for the DSTO, consisting of internal and external members, to provide guidance to the DSTO as it embarks on these future programs. The Board 134 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

243 has membership from Defence, industry, and academia, and includes the Chief Scientist of Australia. It supports the Chief Defence Scientist on strategic issues related to the effective development and application of science and technology in Defence. Improved DSTO Funding and Business Processes The DSTO will also implement a change program to simplify science and technology requirement priority setting processes. The DSTO will integrate robust priority setting and reporting into its governance arrangements to ensure greater accountability and more transparent program management. A Reinforced DSTO Workforce The DSTO is rebalancing its workforce to achieve an efficient, streamlined organisation aligned to demands of a high-tempo and high-technology acquisition program, and the need to ensure it is world class in the areas which provide significant returns for development of the future force. The DSTO workforce will grow to reach a peak within the next five years to accommodate the anticipated support required for the acquisition program. Delivering Defence Support to Non-Defence National Security The expertise that resides in the DSTO can also provide unique capabilities to support the Government's broader national security requirements, in areas such as chemical, biological and nuclear defence; explosives effects and IEDs; intelligence-related technologies; and cybersecurity. The DSTO will continue to support broader Government needs, using its science and technology skills developed for Defence purposes The DSTO's support to non-defence national security agencies expands on the DSTO capacity in key technology areas of relevance to Defence and enables the leverage of technology developed for nondefence agencies back into Defence. Examples of scientific and technological developments in this area include the synthesis and analysis of 'homemade' explosives for domestic security, which are applicable to the DSTO support to countering IEDs on the battlefield. Enhancing External Engagement To reap the maximum benefit from Australia's broader science and technology base in industry,academia and in publicly-funded research organisations as well as our strong international relationships, the DSTO will continue to collaborate closely with external organisations through a number of mechanisms. The DSTO will continue to work with industry to support Defence needs, including through the Capability Technology Demonstrator Program and the Defence Science Access Network The DSTO can leverage technology and capability from other nations. By undertaking world-class research in certain niche areas, and through international collaboration, Australia is able to access overseas capabilities that would otherwise not be available to the ADF. Our prime multilateral science Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

244 and technology relationship is through The Technical Cooperation Program with the United States, United Kingdom, Canada and New Zealand. This allows Australia to work with these nations across a broad spectrum of defence science and technology issues, to explore potential technological opportunities at significantly less cost to Australia, and to benefit from tests and trials using a range of methods and environmental conditions where the cost would be otherwise prohibitive. Beyond this, the DSTO has a number of bilateral international relationships, the most significant of which continues to be that with the United States. In the first few years the prime areas for engagement will be in ISR, cyber warfare, EW, underwater warfare and networked systems The Government has decided to fund a significant program of enhanced external engagement between the DSTO and its national and international partners, which will focus on the critical science and technology areas where Australia must innovate in order to maintain its strategic capability advantage. 136 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

245 ChapTEr 18: THE GOVErNMENT S financial PLaN for DEfENCE 18.1 For the first time, an Australian Government has committed to funding a Defence White Paper for the life of the White Paper The Government s financial plan for Defence will fund the force structure, readiness, sustainment, personnel, infrastructure and other objectives outlined in this White Paper The Government s financial plan for Defence has two components Firstly, the funding parameters (excluding the net costs of major overseas operations) for Defence are: 3 per cent real growth in the Defence budget to ; 2.2 per cent real growth in the Defence budget from to 2030; 2.5 per cent fixed indexation to the Defence budget from to 2030; that Defence will reinvest savings from its Strategic Reform Program back into priority Defence capabilities as agreed by the Government; and shortfalls against the White Paper funding plan will be offset by Defence Secondly, the Government has directed Defence to undertake a substantial program of reform, efficiencies and savings to underpin the achievement of White Paper objectives. In addition to meeting the broad objectives of the White Paper, these savings will allow Defence to correct long-term hollowness and remediate the enabling functions of the Australian Defence Force The Government has committed to real growth in the Defence budget of 3 per cent to and 2.2 per cent real growth thereafter to This will allow Defence to bolster capability and ensure that our men and women in uniform have all the capability, training, and protection they need to do their job as safely, as effectively, and as efficiently as is possible Long term funding stability, including more certain indexation arrangements and real growth for the Defence portfolio is essential for long term planning In the 2000 White Paper it was decided that Defence be indexed by the Non-Farm GDP Implicit Price Deflator. At the time this was a relatively stable index, however, as evidenced during the global economic crisis, this index has been subject to substantial fluctuations To ensure that Defence can make the types of long-term plans outlined in this White Paper, the Government has decided that Defence should be granted fixed indexation for the period to This fixed indexation will remove the need for Defence to constantly adjust its expenditure parameters to Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

246 suit short term fluctuations in the broader economy. The Government has decided to fix indexation at 2.5 per cent for the period to Using a fixed indexation factor that accords with the target for consumer price inflation that is agreed by the Australian Government and the Reserve Bank of Australia will greatly assist Defence planning The Government has directed that any savings achieved within the Strategic Reform Program in the Defence portfolio should be reinvested to ensure that this White Paper can be achieved. Over the past year, Defence has carried out a major review of its budget and business to identify efficiency savings and reprioritise activities. Savings have been placed in the Defence Strategic Investment Reserve for reallocation The Government has committed to sustainable funding arrangements for the Defence budget in future years to provide funding certainty for planning and real funding growth to meet the growing cost of the military equipment we will need in an increasingly demanding world This White Paper provides appropriate funding to meet our strategic and capability needs, to ensure that every dollar is well targeted and well managed to get the right Defence capability for the right cost. 138 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

247 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force

248 140 Defending Australia in the Asia Pacific Century: Force 2030

249

RESUME. bagian selatan yang juga merupakan benua terkecil di dunia. Di sebelah. barat Australia berbatasan dengan Indonesia dan Papua New Guinea,

RESUME. bagian selatan yang juga merupakan benua terkecil di dunia. Di sebelah. barat Australia berbatasan dengan Indonesia dan Papua New Guinea, RESUME Australia adalah sebuah negara yang terdapat di belahan bumi bagian selatan yang juga merupakan benua terkecil di dunia. Di sebelah barat Australia berbatasan dengan Indonesia dan Papua New Guinea,

Lebih terperinci

BAB VI KESIMPULAN. Parlemen selama 30 tahun. Kakek John Malcolm Fraser berasal dari Nova Scotia.

BAB VI KESIMPULAN. Parlemen selama 30 tahun. Kakek John Malcolm Fraser berasal dari Nova Scotia. BAB VI KESIMPULAN Malcolm Fraser dilahirkan 21 mei 1930, dari keluarga petani dan peternak domba yang kaya, kakeknya Sir Simon Fraser adalah salah seorang pertama-tama dipilih sebagai senator mewakili

Lebih terperinci

PERSOALAN DEFENCE AND SECURITY

PERSOALAN DEFENCE AND SECURITY PERSOALAN DEFENCE AND SECURITY AUSTRALIA SEBAGAI THE FRIGHTENED COUNTRY Sejak 1788 yang dipengaruhi oleh pengalamanpengalaman dari masa kolonisasi (Werner Levi) Konsep Defence in Depth --) lingkaran pertahanan

Lebih terperinci

BAB V SIMPULAN DAN SARAN

BAB V SIMPULAN DAN SARAN BAB V SIMPULAN DAN SARAN 5.1 Simpulan Bab ini merupakan kesimpulan dari penelitian skripsi peneliti yang berjudul Peran New Zealand dalam Pakta ANZUS (Australia, New Zealand, United States) Tahun 1951-.

Lebih terperinci

untuk memastikan agar liberalisasi tetap menjamin kesejahteraan sektor swasta. Hasil dari interaksi tersebut adalah rekomendasi sektor swasta yang

untuk memastikan agar liberalisasi tetap menjamin kesejahteraan sektor swasta. Hasil dari interaksi tersebut adalah rekomendasi sektor swasta yang Bab V KESIMPULAN Dalam analisis politik perdagangan internasional, peran politik dalam negeri sering menjadi pendekatan tunggal untuk memahami motif suatu negara menjajaki perjanjian perdagangan. Jiro

Lebih terperinci

BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN SARAN. banyak korban jiwa baik warga negara Indonesia maupun warga negara asing, korban jiwa

BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN SARAN. banyak korban jiwa baik warga negara Indonesia maupun warga negara asing, korban jiwa BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN SARAN 5.1 KESIMPULAN Peristiwa terorisme pada tahun 2002 di Bali dikenal dengan Bom Bali I, mengakibatkan banyak korban jiwa baik warga negara Indonesia maupun warga negara asing,

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Masalah Penelitian

BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Masalah Penelitian BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Masalah Penelitian New Zealand merupakan negara persemakmuran dari negara Inggris yang selama Perang Dunia I (PD I) maupun Perang Dunia II (PD II) selalu berada di

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. Amerika Serikat masih berupa non-intervensi. Namun ketika Perang Dunia Kedua

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. Amerika Serikat masih berupa non-intervensi. Namun ketika Perang Dunia Kedua BAB I PENDAHULUAN A. Latar Belakang Masalah Ketika Perang Dunia Pertama terjadi, tren utama kebijakan luar negeri Amerika Serikat masih berupa non-intervensi. Namun ketika Perang Dunia Kedua terjadi Amerika

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. A. Latar Belakang

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. A. Latar Belakang 1 BAB I PENDAHULUAN A. Latar Belakang Sejak Orde Baru memegang kekuasaan politik di Indonesia sudah banyak terjadi perombakan-perombakan baik dalam tatanan politik dalam negeri maupun politik luar negeri.

Lebih terperinci

Signifikasi Kawasan Asia Pasifik. Yesi Marince, S.Ip., M.Si

Signifikasi Kawasan Asia Pasifik. Yesi Marince, S.Ip., M.Si Signifikasi Kawasan Asia Pasifik Yesi Marince, S.Ip., M.Si A NEW WORLD AND ASIA PACIFIC ORDER Bagaimana Berakhirnya Perang Dingin mempengaruhi kawasan Asia Pasifik? 1. Alasan pelaksanaan containment policy

Lebih terperinci

BAB V KESIMPULAN. Indonesia adalah negara tetangga yang penting bagi Australia. Sebagai

BAB V KESIMPULAN. Indonesia adalah negara tetangga yang penting bagi Australia. Sebagai BAB V KESIMPULAN Indonesia adalah negara tetangga yang penting bagi Australia. Sebagai negara kepulauan dengan jumlah populasi yang besar pula, Indonesia terletak di antara Samudra India dan Samudra Pasifik.

Lebih terperinci

BAB V KESIMPULAN. Berdasarkan kajian yang penulis lakukan mengenai Politik Luar Negeri

BAB V KESIMPULAN. Berdasarkan kajian yang penulis lakukan mengenai Politik Luar Negeri BAB V KESIMPULAN Berdasarkan kajian yang penulis lakukan mengenai Politik Luar Negeri Indonesia Terhadap Pembentukan Negara Federasi Malaysia dan Dampaknya bagi Hubungan Indonesia-Amerika Serikat Tahun

Lebih terperinci

JURUSAN SOSIAL YOGYAKARTA

JURUSAN SOSIAL YOGYAKARTA UPAYA JEPANG DALAM MENJAGA STABILITAS KEAMANAN KAWASAN ASIA TENGGARA RESUME SKRIPSI Marsianaa Marnitta Saga 151040008 JURUSAN ILMU HUBUNGAN INTERNASIONAL FAKULTAS ILMU SOSIAL DAN POLITIK UNIVERSITAS PEMBANGUNAN

Lebih terperinci

sebagai seratus persen aman, tetapi dalam beberapa dekade ini Asia Tenggara merupakan salah satu kawasan yang cenderung bebas perang.

sebagai seratus persen aman, tetapi dalam beberapa dekade ini Asia Tenggara merupakan salah satu kawasan yang cenderung bebas perang. BAB V KESIMPULAN Asia Tenggara merupakan kawasan yang memiliki potensi konflik di masa kini maupun akan datang. Konflik perbatasan seringkali mewarnai dinamika hubungan antarnegara di kawasan ini. Konflik

Lebih terperinci

BAB 5 KESIMPULAN. Universitas Indonesia

BAB 5 KESIMPULAN. Universitas Indonesia BAB 5 KESIMPULAN Dalam bab terakhir ini akan disampaikan tentang kesimpulan yang berisi ringkasan dari keseluruhan uraian pada bab-bab terdahulu. Selanjutnya, dalam kesimpulan ini juga akan dipaparkan

Lebih terperinci

I. PENDAHULUAN. 1.1 Latar Belakang. Globalisasi menjadi sebuah wacana yang menarik untuk didiskusikan

I. PENDAHULUAN. 1.1 Latar Belakang. Globalisasi menjadi sebuah wacana yang menarik untuk didiskusikan I. PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Globalisasi menjadi sebuah wacana yang menarik untuk didiskusikan dalam berbagai bidang, tak terkecuali dalam bidang ekonomi. Menurut Todaro dan Smith (2006), globalisasi

Lebih terperinci

ASEAN ( Association of Southeast Asia Nations ) adalah organisasi yang dibentuk oleh perkumpulan Negara yang berada di daerah asia tenggara

ASEAN ( Association of Southeast Asia Nations ) adalah organisasi yang dibentuk oleh perkumpulan Negara yang berada di daerah asia tenggara ASEAN ( Association of Southeast Asia Nations ) adalah organisasi yang dibentuk oleh perkumpulan Negara yang berada di daerah asia tenggara ASEAN didirikan di Bangkok 8 Agustus 1967 oleh Indonesia, Malaysia,

Lebih terperinci

MUHAMMAD NAFIS PENGANTAR ILMU TEKNOLOGI MARITIM

MUHAMMAD NAFIS PENGANTAR ILMU TEKNOLOGI MARITIM MUHAMMAD NAFIS 140462201067 PENGANTAR ILMU TEKNOLOGI MARITIM Translated by Muhammad Nafis Task 8 Part 2 Satu hal yang menarik dari program politik luar negeri Jokowi adalah pemasukan Samudera Hindia sebagai

Lebih terperinci

PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA,

PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA, KEPUTUSAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 1 TAHUN 2005 TENTANG PANITIA NASIONAL PENYELENGGARA PERTEMUAN KHUSUS PARA PEMIMPIN NEGARA-NEGARA ASEAN, NEGARA-NEGARA LAIN, DAN ORGANISASI-ORGANISASI INTERNASIONAL

Lebih terperinci

Pengaruh Politik Domestik Terhadap Kebijakan Politik Luar Negeri Australia

Pengaruh Politik Domestik Terhadap Kebijakan Politik Luar Negeri Australia Ciptahadi Nugraha 10/296341/SP/23828 Pengaruh Politik Domestik Terhadap Kebijakan Politik Luar Negeri Australia Seperti yang kita ketahui, dalam politik pemerintahan Australia terdapat dua partai yang

Lebih terperinci

DENGAN RAHMAT TUHAN YANG MAHA ESA PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA,

DENGAN RAHMAT TUHAN YANG MAHA ESA PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA, UNDANG-UNDANG REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 47 TAHUN 2007 TENTANG PENGESAHAN PERJANJIAN ANTARA REPUBLIK INDONESIA DAN AUSTRALIA TENTANG KERANGKA KERJA SAMA KEAMANAN (AGREEMENT BETWEEN THE REPUBLIC OF INDONESIA

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang

BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang Kerja sama merupakan upaya yang dilakukan oleh perseorangan, kelompok maupun negara untuk mencapai kepentingan bersama. Lewat bekerjasama, tentu saja seseorang, kelompok

Lebih terperinci

LAMPIRAN PERATURAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 7 TAHUN 2008 TENTANG KEBIJAKAN UMUM PERTAHANAN NEGARA PENDAHULUAN

LAMPIRAN PERATURAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 7 TAHUN 2008 TENTANG KEBIJAKAN UMUM PERTAHANAN NEGARA PENDAHULUAN LAMPIRAN PERATURAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 7 TAHUN 2008 TENTANG KEBIJAKAN UMUM PERTAHANAN NEGARA PENDAHULUAN 1. Umum. Pertahanan negara sebagai salah satu fungsi pemerintahan negara merupakan

Lebih terperinci

Amerika Tanam Pengaruh di Asia Sejak Desember 1949

Amerika Tanam Pengaruh di Asia Sejak Desember 1949 Amerika Tanam Pengaruh di Asia Sejak Desember 1949 http://forum.viva.co.id/showthread.php?t=1896354 Jika kita telisik lebih mendalam, sebenarnya kebijakan strategis AS untuk menguasai dan menanam pengaruh

Lebih terperinci

2015 KETERLIBATAN AUSTRALIA DALAM PERANG VIETNAM

2015 KETERLIBATAN AUSTRALIA DALAM PERANG VIETNAM BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang Masalah Penelitian Setelah Perang Dunia ke II (PD II) berakhir, negara-negara di kawasan Asia Tenggara mulai dihadapkan pada dua kondisi yang berbeda. Kondisi pertama,

Lebih terperinci

BAB 1 PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang

BAB 1 PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang BAB 1 PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Pada tahun 1853, dengan kapal perangnya yang besar, Komodor Perry datang ke Jepang. Pada saat itu, Jepang adalah negara feodal yang terisolasi dari negara-negara lainnya

Lebih terperinci

2 dunia. Kerjasama yang terjalin diantara negara-negara menjadikan status antar negara adalah partner bukan musuh sehingga keinginan untuk saling bers

2 dunia. Kerjasama yang terjalin diantara negara-negara menjadikan status antar negara adalah partner bukan musuh sehingga keinginan untuk saling bers BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Globalisasi telah menjadi fenomena yang terjadi secara global yang cukup mempengaruhi tatanan dunia hubungan internasional dewasa ini. Globalisasi merupakan proses

Lebih terperinci

MATA KULIAH TEORI ILMU HUBUNGAN INTERNASIONAL TEORI-TEORI KERJASAMA INTERNASIONAL. Oleh : Dr. Agus Subagyo, S.IP., M.Si

MATA KULIAH TEORI ILMU HUBUNGAN INTERNASIONAL TEORI-TEORI KERJASAMA INTERNASIONAL. Oleh : Dr. Agus Subagyo, S.IP., M.Si MATA KULIAH TEORI ILMU HUBUNGAN INTERNASIONAL TEORI-TEORI KERJASAMA INTERNASIONAL Oleh : Dr. Agus Subagyo, S.IP., M.Si Teori Aliansi Teori Integrasi Teori Kerjasama Teori Peranan TEORI ALIANSI TEORI ALIANSI

Lebih terperinci

turut melekat bagi negara-negara di Eropa Timur. Uni Eropa, AS, dan NATO menanamkan pengaruhnya melalui ide-ide demokrasi yang terkait dengan ekonomi,

turut melekat bagi negara-negara di Eropa Timur. Uni Eropa, AS, dan NATO menanamkan pengaruhnya melalui ide-ide demokrasi yang terkait dengan ekonomi, BAB V PENUTUP 5.1 Kesimpulan Dengan berbagai aspek yang telah dinilai oleh pembuat kebijakan di Montenegro untuk bergabung dalam NATO, terdapat polemik internal dan eksternal yang diakibatkan oleh kebijakan

Lebih terperinci

DAFTAR PUSTAKA. Chauvel, Richard H. Budaya dan Politik Australia, terj.oleh Harlinah, Sujinah,Yayasan Obor Indonesia, Jakarta, 1992.

DAFTAR PUSTAKA. Chauvel, Richard H. Budaya dan Politik Australia, terj.oleh Harlinah, Sujinah,Yayasan Obor Indonesia, Jakarta, 1992. DAFTAR PUSTAKA Buku: Chauvel, Richard H. Budaya dan Politik Australia, terj.oleh Harlinah, Sujinah,Yayasan Obor Indonesia, Jakarta, 1992. Firth, Stewart. Australian in International Politics: Introduction

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. India dan Pakistan merupakan dua negara yang terletak di antara Asia

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. India dan Pakistan merupakan dua negara yang terletak di antara Asia BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Masalah India dan Pakistan merupakan dua negara yang terletak di antara Asia Tengah dan Asia Tenggara yang terlingkup dalam satu kawasan, yaitu Asia Selatan. Negara-negara

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN Latar Belakang

BAB I PENDAHULUAN Latar Belakang BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang Pasca kekalahannya dalam Perang Dunia II, Jepang berusaha untuk bangkit kembali menjadi salah satu kekuatan besar di dunia. Usaha Jepang untuk bangkit kembali dilakukan

Lebih terperinci

I. PENDAHULUAN. A. Latar Belakang Masalah. Sekarang ini sulit dikatakan bahwa suatu negara bisa hidup sendirian sepenuhnya

I. PENDAHULUAN. A. Latar Belakang Masalah. Sekarang ini sulit dikatakan bahwa suatu negara bisa hidup sendirian sepenuhnya I. PENDAHULUAN A. Latar Belakang Masalah Sekarang ini sulit dikatakan bahwa suatu negara bisa hidup sendirian sepenuhnya tanpa berhubungan dengan negara lain. setiap negara pasti akan memiliki kepantingan

Lebih terperinci

ADLN - PERPUSTAKAAN UNIVERSITAS AIRLANGGA Cooperative Security: Studi Kasus Traktat Lombok antara Indonesia dan Australia TESIS

ADLN - PERPUSTAKAAN UNIVERSITAS AIRLANGGA Cooperative Security: Studi Kasus Traktat Lombok antara Indonesia dan Australia TESIS Cooperative Security: Studi Kasus Traktat Lombok antara Indonesia dan Australia TESIS Untuk memperoleh Gelar Magister dalam Program Studi Hubungan Internasional pada Program Magister Fakultas Ilmu Sosial

Lebih terperinci

PERADABAN AMERIKA MODERN DOSEN : AGUS SUBAGYO, S.IP., M.SI

PERADABAN AMERIKA MODERN DOSEN : AGUS SUBAGYO, S.IP., M.SI FISIP HI UNJANI CIMAHI 2011 PERADABAN MODERN DOSEN : AGUS SUBAGYO, S.IP., M.SI Revolusi Amerika 1776 Perang Sipil di Amerika 1861-1845 Perkembangan Amerika Serikat dan Amerika Latin Amerika Serikat Sebagai

Lebih terperinci

bilateral, multilateral maupun regional dan peningkatan henemoni Amerika Serikat di dunia. Pada masa perang dingin, kebijakan luar negeri Amerika

bilateral, multilateral maupun regional dan peningkatan henemoni Amerika Serikat di dunia. Pada masa perang dingin, kebijakan luar negeri Amerika BAB V KESIMPULAN Amerika Serikat merupakan negara adikuasa dengan dinamika kebijakan politik luar negeri yang dinamis. Kebijakan luar negeri yang diputuskan oleh Amerika Serikat disesuaikan dengan isu

Lebih terperinci

mengakibatkan potensi ancaman dan esklasi konflik. Eskalasi konflik di kawasan mulai terlihat dari persaingan anggaran belanja militer Cina, Korea

mengakibatkan potensi ancaman dan esklasi konflik. Eskalasi konflik di kawasan mulai terlihat dari persaingan anggaran belanja militer Cina, Korea BAB V PENUTUP Tesis ini menjelaskan kompleksitas keamanan kawasan Asia Timur yang berimplikasi terhadap program pengembangan senjata nuklir Korea Utara. Kompleksitas keamanan yang terjadi di kawasan Asia

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang Penelitian Rinrin Desti Apriani, 2013

BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang Penelitian Rinrin Desti Apriani, 2013 BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang Penelitian Invasi dan pendudukan Vietnam ke Kamboja yang dilakukan pada akhir tahun 1978 merupakan peristiwa yang begitu mengejutkan baik bagi Kamboja sendiri maupun

Lebih terperinci

PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA

PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA UNDANG-UNDANG NOMOR 47 TAHUN 2007 TENTANG PENGESAHAN PERJANJIAN ANTARA DAN AUSTRALIA TENTANG KERANGKA KERJA SAMA KEAMANAN (AGREEMENT BETWEEN THE REPUBLIC OF INDONESIA AND AUSTRALIA ON THE FRAMEWORK FOR

Lebih terperinci

BAB 4 KESIMPULAN. 97 Universitas Indonesia. Dampak pengembangan..., Alfina Farmaritia Wicahyani, FISIP UI, 2010.

BAB 4 KESIMPULAN. 97 Universitas Indonesia. Dampak pengembangan..., Alfina Farmaritia Wicahyani, FISIP UI, 2010. BAB 4 KESIMPULAN Korea Utara sejak tahun 1950 telah menjadi ancaman utama bagi keamanan kawasan Asia Timur. Korea Utara telah mengancam Korea Selatan dengan invasinya. Kemudian Korea Utara dapat menjadi

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. Amerika Serikat merupakan negara adikuasa yang memiliki pengaruh

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. Amerika Serikat merupakan negara adikuasa yang memiliki pengaruh BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Masalah Amerika Serikat merupakan negara adikuasa yang memiliki pengaruh sangat besar bagi ekonomi dunia. Secara politik, Amerika Serikat merupakan negara demokrasi

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN masih menyisakan satu persoalan yaitu masalah status Irian Barat. Indonesia

BAB I PENDAHULUAN masih menyisakan satu persoalan yaitu masalah status Irian Barat. Indonesia BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Masalah Hasil Perjanjian Komisi Meja Bundar antara Indonesia dengan Belanda pada tahun 1949 masih menyisakan satu persoalan yaitu masalah status Irian Barat. Indonesia

Lebih terperinci

DOSEN : Dr. AGUS SUBAGYO, S.IP., M.SI

DOSEN : Dr. AGUS SUBAGYO, S.IP., M.SI DOSEN : Dr. AGUS SUBAGYO, S.IP., M.SI FISIP HI UNJANI CIMAHI 2011 Tinjauan Umum Teori Kepentingan Nasional Teori National Interest Versi Hans J. Morgenthau Teori National Interest Versi Donald Nuchterlin

Lebih terperinci

DAFTAR PUSTAKA. Abdulgani, H. Roeslan, Ganyang Setiap Bentuk Neo-Kolonialisme yang Mengepung Republik Indonesia, dalam Indonesia, 1964-B

DAFTAR PUSTAKA. Abdulgani, H. Roeslan, Ganyang Setiap Bentuk Neo-Kolonialisme yang Mengepung Republik Indonesia, dalam Indonesia, 1964-B BAB V KESIMPULAN Jepang menjadi lumpuh akibat dari kekalahanya pada perang dunia ke dua. Namun, nampaknya karena kondisi politik internasional yang berkembang saat itu, menjadikan pemerintah pendudukan

Lebih terperinci

BAB IV PENUTUP. Strategi keamanan..., Fitria Purnihastuti, FISIP UI, 2008

BAB IV PENUTUP. Strategi keamanan..., Fitria Purnihastuti, FISIP UI, 2008 BAB IV PENUTUP A.Kesimpulan Sangat jelas terlihat bahwa Asia Tengah memerankan peran penting dalam strategi China di masa depan. Disamping oleh karena alasan alasan ekonomi, namun juga meluas menjadi aspek

Lebih terperinci

I. PENDAHULUAN. Isu globalisasi sering diperbincangkan sejak awal tahun Globalisasi

I. PENDAHULUAN. Isu globalisasi sering diperbincangkan sejak awal tahun Globalisasi I. PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang Isu globalisasi sering diperbincangkan sejak awal tahun 1980. Globalisasi selain memberikan dampak positif, juga memberikan dampak yang mengkhawatirkan bagi negara yang

Lebih terperinci

BAB IV KESIMPULAN. Perkembangan pada konstalasi politik internasional pasca-perang Dingin

BAB IV KESIMPULAN. Perkembangan pada konstalasi politik internasional pasca-perang Dingin BAB IV KESIMPULAN Perkembangan pada konstalasi politik internasional pasca-perang Dingin memiliki implikasi bagi kebijakan luar negeri India. Perubahan tersebut memiliki implikasi bagi India baik pada

Lebih terperinci

BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN SARAN

BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN SARAN BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN SARAN 5.1 Kesimpulan Sejak awal integrasi ke dalam wilayah Negara Kesatuan Republik Indonesia (NKRI) tahun 1976, Timor Timur selalu berhadapan dengan konflik, baik vertikal maupun

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. untuk menjaga keamanan nasional sekaligus memenuhi kepentingan nasional.

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. untuk menjaga keamanan nasional sekaligus memenuhi kepentingan nasional. 1 BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Kekuatan militer merupakan salah satu aspek penting dalam menjaga stabilitas negara. Semua negara termasuk Indonesia membangun kekuatan militernya untuk menjaga keamanan

Lebih terperinci

menjadi katalisator berbagai agenda ekonomi Cina dengan negara kawasan Indocina yang semuanya masuk dalam agenda kerja sama Cina-ASEAN.

menjadi katalisator berbagai agenda ekonomi Cina dengan negara kawasan Indocina yang semuanya masuk dalam agenda kerja sama Cina-ASEAN. BAB V KESIMPULAN Kebangkitan ekonomi Cina secara signifikan menguatkan kemampuan domestik yang mendorong kepercayaan diri Cina dalam kerangka kerja sama internasional. Manuver Cina dalam politik global

Lebih terperinci

BAB VI. 6.1 Kesimpulan Strategi Suriah dalam menghadapi konflik dengan Israel pada masa Hafiz al-

BAB VI. 6.1 Kesimpulan Strategi Suriah dalam menghadapi konflik dengan Israel pada masa Hafiz al- 166 BAB VI 6.1 Kesimpulan Strategi Suriah dalam menghadapi konflik dengan Israel pada masa Hafiz al- Assad berkaitan dengan dasar ideologi Partai Ba ath yang menjunjung persatuan, kebebasan, dan sosialisme

Lebih terperinci

Kerja sama ekonomi internasional

Kerja sama ekonomi internasional Meet -12 1 hubungan antara suatu negara dengan negara lainnya dalam bidang ekonomi melalui kesepakatankesepakatan tertentu, dengan memegang prinsip keadilan dan saling menguntungkan. Tujuan umum kerja

Lebih terperinci

HUBUNGAN INTERNASIONAL DI ASIA TENGGARA PADA ERA PERANG DINGIN. Dewi Triwahyuni

HUBUNGAN INTERNASIONAL DI ASIA TENGGARA PADA ERA PERANG DINGIN. Dewi Triwahyuni HUBUNGAN INTERNASIONAL DI ASIA TENGGARA PADA ERA PERANG DINGIN Dewi Triwahyuni International Relation Department, UNIKOM 2013 Backgroud History 1950an 1980an Hubungan internasional di Asia Tenggara pada

Lebih terperinci

BAB 20: SEJARAH PERANG DINGIN

BAB 20: SEJARAH PERANG DINGIN www.bimbinganalumniui.com 1. Perang Dingin a. Perang terbuka antara Blok Barat dan Blok Timur b. Ketegangan antara Blok Barat dalam masa ideologi c. Persaingan militer antara Amerika Uni di Timur Tengah

Lebih terperinci

ASEAN DAN KERJASAMA EKONOMI REGIONAL. [Dewi Triwahyuni]

ASEAN DAN KERJASAMA EKONOMI REGIONAL. [Dewi Triwahyuni] ASEAN DAN KERJASAMA EKONOMI REGIONAL [Dewi Triwahyuni] FAKTOR-FAKTOR PENDORONG KERJASAMA DI ASIA TENGGARA Setiap negara butuh hubungan dan kerja sama dengan negara lain dalam berbagai hal. Sebagai contoh,

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN Latar Belakang Masalah

BAB I PENDAHULUAN Latar Belakang Masalah BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang Masalah Kecurigaan dan ketakutan adalah persepsi awal bangsa Australia terhadap Asia secara keseluruhan. Pada masa kolonialisme, Australia memandang negaranegara Eropa

Lebih terperinci

PERATURAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 7 TAHUN 2008 TENTANG KEBIJAKAN UMUM PERTAHANAN NEGARA DENGAN RAHMAT TUHAN YANG MAHA ESA

PERATURAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 7 TAHUN 2008 TENTANG KEBIJAKAN UMUM PERTAHANAN NEGARA DENGAN RAHMAT TUHAN YANG MAHA ESA www.bpkp.go.id PERATURAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 7 TAHUN 2008 TENTANG KEBIJAKAN UMUM PERTAHANAN NEGARA DENGAN RAHMAT TUHAN YANG MAHA ESA PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA, Menimbang : a. bahwa penyelenggaraan

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. setiap negara bertujuan agar posisi ekonomi negara tersebut di pasar internasional

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. setiap negara bertujuan agar posisi ekonomi negara tersebut di pasar internasional BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1. 1. Latar Belakang Penelitian Negara-negara di seluruh dunia saat ini menyadari bahwa integrasi ekonomi memiliki peran penting dalam perdagangan. Integrasi dilakukan oleh setiap negara

Lebih terperinci

BISNIS INTERNASIONAL. By Nina Triolita, SE, MM. Pertemuan ke 14 Pengantar Bisnis

BISNIS INTERNASIONAL. By Nina Triolita, SE, MM. Pertemuan ke 14 Pengantar Bisnis BISNIS INTERNASIONAL By Nina Triolita, SE, MM. Pertemuan ke 14 Pengantar Bisnis BISNIS INTERNATIONAL Kegiatan bisnis yang dilakukan antara Negara yang satu dengan Negara yang lain. Kegiatan : Perdagangan

Lebih terperinci

PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA,

PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA, KEPUTUSAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 6 TAHUN 2013 TENTANG PERUBAHAN ATAS KEPUTUSAN PRESIDEN NOMOR 28 TAHUN 2005 TENTANG PEMBENTUKAN TIM NASIONAL UNTUK PERUNDINGAN PERDAGANGAN INTERNASIONAL PRESIDEN

Lebih terperinci

1. DARI IDEOLOGI HINGGA TERORISME

1. DARI IDEOLOGI HINGGA TERORISME 1 1. DARI IDEOLOGI HINGGA TERORISME Dalam sejarahnya, manusia memang sudah ditakdirkan untuk berkompetisi demi bertahan hidup. Namun terkadang kompetisi yang dijalankan manusia itu tidaklah sehat dan menjurus

Lebih terperinci

PERDAGANGAN INTERNASIONAL PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA,

PERDAGANGAN INTERNASIONAL PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA, w w w.bpkp.go.id KEPUTUSAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 6 TAHUN 2013 TENTANG PERUBAHAN ATAS KEPUTUSAN PRESIDEN NOMOR 28 TAHUN 2005 TENTANG PEMBENTUKAN TIM NASIONAL UNTUK PERUNDINGAN PERDAGANGAN INTERNASIONAL

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. kita. Konflik tersebut terjadi karena interaksi antar kedua negara atau lebih

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. kita. Konflik tersebut terjadi karena interaksi antar kedua negara atau lebih 1 BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Konflik internasional antar dua negara cukup terdengar akrab di telinga kita. Konflik tersebut terjadi karena interaksi antar kedua negara atau lebih terganggu akibat

Lebih terperinci

DENGAN RAHMAT TUHAN YANG MAHA ESA PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA, Dengan persetujuan DEWAN PERWAKILAN RAKYAT REPUBLIK INDONESIA

DENGAN RAHMAT TUHAN YANG MAHA ESA PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA, Dengan persetujuan DEWAN PERWAKILAN RAKYAT REPUBLIK INDONESIA UNDANG-UNDANG NEGARA REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 9 TAHUN 1997 TENTANG PENGESAHAN TREATY ON THE SOUTHEAST ASIA NUCLEAR WEAPON FREE ZONE (TRAKTAT KAWASAN BEBAS SENJATA NUKLIR DI ASIA TENGGARA) DENGAN RAHMAT

Lebih terperinci

BAB 1 PENDAHULUAN. menjadi duta besar pertama Amerika untuk RIS. Sementara pemerintahan Truman di Amerika Serikat sedang berusaha

BAB 1 PENDAHULUAN. menjadi duta besar pertama Amerika untuk RIS. Sementara pemerintahan Truman di Amerika Serikat sedang berusaha BAB 1 PENDAHULUAN A. LATAR BELAKANG Indonesia telah memilih Ir. Soekarno sebagai Presiden RIS Pada tanggal 16 Desember 1949, Jakarta ibu kota Republik Indonesia Serikat yang baru, rakyat Indonesia secara

Lebih terperinci

DENGAN RAHMAT TUHAN YANG MAHA ESA PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA,

DENGAN RAHMAT TUHAN YANG MAHA ESA PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA, UNDANG-UNDANG REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 20 TAHUN 2007 TENTANG PENGESAHAN PERSETUJUAN ANTARA PEMERINTAH REPUBLIK INDONESIA DAN PEMERINTAH REPUBLIK FILIPINA TENTANG KEGIATAN KERJASAMA DI BIDANG PERTAHANAN

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. Politik Luar Negeri Indonesia sejak awal kemerdekaan sedikit banyak

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. Politik Luar Negeri Indonesia sejak awal kemerdekaan sedikit banyak BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Masalah Politik Luar Negeri Indonesia sejak awal kemerdekaan sedikit banyak dibentuk oleh kepentingan-kepentingan untuk menjawab tantangan dari realita Perang Dingin,

Lebih terperinci

KEPUTUSAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 6 TAHUN 2013 TENTANG

KEPUTUSAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 6 TAHUN 2013 TENTANG KEPUTUSAN PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA NOMOR 6 TAHUN 2013 TENTANG PERUBAHAN ATAS KEPUTUSAN PRESIDEN NOMOR 28 TAHUN 2005 TENTANG PEMBENTUKAN TIM NASIONAL UNTUK PERUNDINGAN PERDAGANGAN INTERNASIONAL PRESIDEN

Lebih terperinci

perdagangan, industri, pertania

perdagangan, industri, pertania 6. Organisasi Perdagangan Internasional Untuk mempelajari materi mengenai organisasi perdagangan internasional bisa dilihat pada link video berikut: https://bit.ly/2i9gt35. a. ASEAN (Association of South

Lebih terperinci

memperoleh status, kehormatan, dan kekuatan dalam menjaga kedaulatan, keutuhan wilayah, serta pengaruhnya di arena global.

memperoleh status, kehormatan, dan kekuatan dalam menjaga kedaulatan, keutuhan wilayah, serta pengaruhnya di arena global. BAB V PENUTUP Kebangkitan Cina di awal abad ke-21tidak dapat dipisahkan dari reformasi ekonomi dan modernisasi yang ia jalankan. Reformasi telah mengantarkan Cina menemukan momentum kebangkitan ekonominya

Lebih terperinci

BAB V KESIMPULAN. ini terjadi dan meningkatnya kebutuhan suatu negara akibat berkembangnya

BAB V KESIMPULAN. ini terjadi dan meningkatnya kebutuhan suatu negara akibat berkembangnya BAB V KESIMPULAN Keamanan energi erat hubungannya dengan kelangkaan energi yang saat ini terjadi dan meningkatnya kebutuhan suatu negara akibat berkembangnya industrialisasi dan kepentingan militer. Kelangsungan

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. internasional, negara harus memiliki syarat-syarat yang harus dipenuhi yaitu,

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. internasional, negara harus memiliki syarat-syarat yang harus dipenuhi yaitu, BAB I PENDAHULUAN A. Latar Belakang Negara merupakan salah satu subjek hukum internasional. Sebagai subjek hukum internasional, negara harus memiliki syarat-syarat yang harus dipenuhi yaitu, salah satunya

Lebih terperinci

DAFTAR ISI. I.6.1 Kelemahan Organisasi Internasional secara Internal I.6.2 Kelemahan Organisasi Internasional dari Pengaruh Aktor Eksternal...

DAFTAR ISI. I.6.1 Kelemahan Organisasi Internasional secara Internal I.6.2 Kelemahan Organisasi Internasional dari Pengaruh Aktor Eksternal... DAFTAR ISI DAFTAR ISI... i DAFTAR TABEL... iii DAFTAR GAMBAR... iii DAFTAR GRAFIK... iii DAFTAR SINGKATAN... iii ABSTRAK... iii ABSTRACT... iv BAB I PENDAHULUAN... 1 I.1 Latar Belakang... 1 I.2 Rumusan

Lebih terperinci

BAB V KESIMPULAN. Runtuhnya Uni Soviet pada tahun 1990an merubah konstelasi politik dunia. Rusia

BAB V KESIMPULAN. Runtuhnya Uni Soviet pada tahun 1990an merubah konstelasi politik dunia. Rusia BAB V KESIMPULAN Runtuhnya Uni Soviet pada tahun 1990an merubah konstelasi politik dunia. Rusia berubah dari super power state menjadi middle-power state (negara dengan kekuatan menengah). Kebijakan luar

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN A. Latar Belakang Penelitian Ana Fajriasari, 2013

BAB I PENDAHULUAN A. Latar Belakang Penelitian Ana Fajriasari, 2013 BAB I PENDAHULUAN A. Latar Belakang Penelitian Berbagai organisasi internasional antara lain PBB, Bank Dunia dan World Tourism Organization (WTO), telah mengakui bahwa pariwisata merupakan bagian yang

Lebih terperinci

2 masing-masing negara masih berhak untuk menentukan sendiri hambatan bagi negara non anggota. 1 Sebagai negara dalam kawasan Asia Tenggara tentunya p

2 masing-masing negara masih berhak untuk menentukan sendiri hambatan bagi negara non anggota. 1 Sebagai negara dalam kawasan Asia Tenggara tentunya p 1 BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Dalam era globalisasi yang semakin maju ini ada banyak isu-isu yang berkembang. Bukan hanya isu mengenai hard power yang menjadi perhatian dunia, tetapi isu soft

Lebih terperinci

BAB V PENUTUP. Tesis ini berupaya untuk memberikan sebuah penjelasan mengenai

BAB V PENUTUP. Tesis ini berupaya untuk memberikan sebuah penjelasan mengenai BAB V PENUTUP Tesis ini berupaya untuk memberikan sebuah penjelasan mengenai hubungan antara kebangkitan gerakan politik Islam dalam pergolakan yang terjadi di Suriah dengan persepsi Amerika Serikat, yang

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. Indonesia merupakan salah satu negara yang mempunyai kekayaan sumber

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. Indonesia merupakan salah satu negara yang mempunyai kekayaan sumber BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Masalah Indonesia merupakan salah satu negara yang mempunyai kekayaan sumber daya alam yang melimpah. Keadaan sumber daya alam yang melimpah inilah yang menjadi keunggulan

Lebih terperinci

HUBUNGAN INDONESIA-AUSTRALIA PADA MASA PEMERINTAHAN JOHN HOWARD TAHUN SKRIPSI

HUBUNGAN INDONESIA-AUSTRALIA PADA MASA PEMERINTAHAN JOHN HOWARD TAHUN SKRIPSI HUBUNGAN INDONESIA-AUSTRALIA PADA MASA PEMERINTAHAN JOHN HOWARD TAHUN 1996-2007 SKRIPSI OLEH: GARGARISNA DIPUTRA NIM. 050210302029 PROGRAM STUDI PENDIDIKAN SEJARAH JURUSAN PENDIDIKAN ILMU PENGETAHUAN SOSIAL

Lebih terperinci

Efektivitas ASEAN Economic Community Terhadap Optimalisasi Kualitas Industri Kerajinan Keramik Dinoyo Malang

Efektivitas ASEAN Economic Community Terhadap Optimalisasi Kualitas Industri Kerajinan Keramik Dinoyo Malang PASAR BEBAS Efektivitas ASEAN Economic Community Terhadap Optimalisasi Kualitas Industri Kerajinan Keramik Dinoyo Malang Latar Belakang Integrasi ekonomi merupakan salah satu sarana dalam meningkatkan

Lebih terperinci

KERJA SAMA KEAMANAN MARITIM INDONESIA-AUSTRALIA: TANTANGAN DAN UPAYA PENGUATANNYA DALAM MENGHADAPI KEJAHATAN LINTAS NEGARA DI PERAIRAN PERBATASAN

KERJA SAMA KEAMANAN MARITIM INDONESIA-AUSTRALIA: TANTANGAN DAN UPAYA PENGUATANNYA DALAM MENGHADAPI KEJAHATAN LINTAS NEGARA DI PERAIRAN PERBATASAN LAPORAN PENELITIAN KERJA SAMA KEAMANAN MARITIM INDONESIA-AUSTRALIA: TANTANGAN DAN UPAYA PENGUATANNYA DALAM MENGHADAPI KEJAHATAN LINTAS NEGARA DI PERAIRAN PERBATASAN Oleh: Drs. Simela Victor Muhamad, MSi.

Lebih terperinci

KEBIJAKAN AMERIKA SERIKAT UNTUK MEMPERTAHANKAN EMBARGO EKONOMI TERHADAP KUBA PASCA NORMALISASI HUBUNGAN KEDUA NEGARA

KEBIJAKAN AMERIKA SERIKAT UNTUK MEMPERTAHANKAN EMBARGO EKONOMI TERHADAP KUBA PASCA NORMALISASI HUBUNGAN KEDUA NEGARA KEBIJAKAN AMERIKA SERIKAT UNTUK MEMPERTAHANKAN EMBARGO EKONOMI TERHADAP KUBA PASCA NORMALISASI HUBUNGAN KEDUA NEGARA United State s Policy on Maintaining Economic Embargo on Cuba after Normalization of

Lebih terperinci

Kelebihan dan Kelemahan Pelaksanaan Sistem Pemerintahan Negara Republik Indonesia

Kelebihan dan Kelemahan Pelaksanaan Sistem Pemerintahan Negara Republik Indonesia Kelebihan dan Kelemahan Pelaksanaan Sistem Pemerintahan Negara Republik Indonesia Sistem pemerintahan negara Indonesia telah mengalami beberapa perubahan. Semuanya itu tidak terlepas dari sifat dan watak

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. Asia Tenggara merupakan suatu kawasan di Asia yang memiliki sekitar

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. Asia Tenggara merupakan suatu kawasan di Asia yang memiliki sekitar BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Masalah Asia Tenggara merupakan suatu kawasan di Asia yang memiliki sekitar 80% merupakan wilayah lautan. Hal ini menjadikan kawasan Asia Tenggara sebagai jalur alur

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. tersebut memiliki nilai tawar kekuatan untuk menentukan suatu pemerintahan

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. tersebut memiliki nilai tawar kekuatan untuk menentukan suatu pemerintahan BAB I PENDAHULUAN A. Alasan Pemilihan Judul Kepemilikan senjata nuklir oleh suatu negara memang menjadikan perubahan konteks politik internasional menjadi rawan konflik mengingat senjata tersebut memiliki

Lebih terperinci

yang korup dan lemah. Berakhirnya masa pemerintahan Dinasti Qing menandai masuknya Cina ke dalam era baru dengan bentuk pemerintahan republik yang

yang korup dan lemah. Berakhirnya masa pemerintahan Dinasti Qing menandai masuknya Cina ke dalam era baru dengan bentuk pemerintahan republik yang BAB I PENDAHULUAN A. Latar Belakang Masalah Republik Rakyat Cina (RRC) adalah salah satu negara maju di Asia yang beribukota di Beijing (Peking) dan secara geografis terletak di 39,917 o LU dan 116,383

Lebih terperinci

Keterangan Pers Presiden RI pada acara Indonesia-Australia Annual Leaders Meeting, Bogor,5 Juli 2013 Jumat, 05 Juli 2013

Keterangan Pers Presiden RI pada acara Indonesia-Australia Annual Leaders Meeting, Bogor,5 Juli 2013 Jumat, 05 Juli 2013 Keterangan Pers Presiden RI pada acara Indonesia-Australia Annual Leaders Meeting, Bogor,5 Juli 2013 Jumat, 05 Juli 2013 KETERANGAN PERS PRESIDEN REPUBLIK INDONESIA PADA ACARA INDONESIA-AUSTRALIA ANNUAL

Lebih terperinci

BAB IV PERTIMBANGAN INDONESIA DALAM MEMBERIKAN REFERENDUM TIMOR TIMUR BERDASARKAN FAKTOR EKSTERNAL

BAB IV PERTIMBANGAN INDONESIA DALAM MEMBERIKAN REFERENDUM TIMOR TIMUR BERDASARKAN FAKTOR EKSTERNAL BAB IV PERTIMBANGAN INDONESIA DALAM MEMBERIKAN REFERENDUM TIMOR TIMUR BERDASARKAN FAKTOR EKSTERNAL A. Keterlibatan Australia Dalam Referendum Timor Timur Meskipun Australia bukanlah pihak yang berkepentingan

Lebih terperinci

POLITIK & SISTEM POLITIK

POLITIK & SISTEM POLITIK POLITIK & SISTEM POLITIK Departemen Administrasi & Kebijakan Kesehatan Fakultas Kesehatan Masyarakat Universitas Indonesia Prof. Drh. Wiku Adisasmito, M.Sc., Ph.D. Kesehatan merupakan hak semua warga negara

Lebih terperinci

1. PENDAHULUAN. 1.1 Latar Belakang

1. PENDAHULUAN. 1.1 Latar Belakang 1. PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Pariwisata saat ini telah menjadi salah satu motor penggerak ekonomi dunia terutama dalam penerimaan devisa negara melalui konsumsi yang dilakukan turis asing terhadap

Lebih terperinci

Artikel hubungan internasional antara indonesia dengan negara lain. Artikel hubungan internasional antara indonesia dengan negara lain.

Artikel hubungan internasional antara indonesia dengan negara lain. Artikel hubungan internasional antara indonesia dengan negara lain. Artikel hubungan internasional antara indonesia dengan negara lain Artikel hubungan internasional antara indonesia dengan negara lain.zip CONTOH PERJANJIAN INTERNASIONAL ANTAR NEGARA hubungan antara Indonesia

Lebih terperinci

BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN REKOMENDASI

BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN REKOMENDASI 1 BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN REKOMENDASI 5.1 Kesimpulan Pada bagian ini penulis menyajikan kesimpulan berdasakan hasil penelitian yang penulis peroleh. Kesimpulan ini memaparkan beberapa pikiran pokok yang merupakan

Lebih terperinci

I. PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang

I. PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang I. PENDAHULUAN 1.1. Latar Belakang Era globalisasi menuntut adanya keterbukaan ekonomi yang semakin luas dari setiap negara di dunia, baik keterbukaan dalam perdagangan luar negeri (trade openness) maupun

Lebih terperinci

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. menimbulkan penderitaan bagi masyarakat Korea. Jepang melakukan eksploitasi

BAB I PENDAHULUAN. menimbulkan penderitaan bagi masyarakat Korea. Jepang melakukan eksploitasi BAB I PENDAHULUAN 1.1 Latar Belakang Masalah Penelitian Sejarah Korea yang pernah berada di bawah kolonial kekuasaan Jepang menimbulkan penderitaan bagi masyarakat Korea. Jepang melakukan eksploitasi sumber

Lebih terperinci

BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN REKOMENDASI

BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN REKOMENDASI BAB V KESIMPULAN DAN REKOMENDASI 5.1 Kesimpulan Pada bagian ini merupakan kesimpulan terhadap semua hasil penelitian yang telah diperoleh setelah melakukan pengkajian dan sekaligus memberikan analisis

Lebih terperinci

DIALOG KOREA UTARA-KOREA SELATAN DAN DAMPAKNYA TERHADAP KEAMANAN KAWASAN

DIALOG KOREA UTARA-KOREA SELATAN DAN DAMPAKNYA TERHADAP KEAMANAN KAWASAN Pusat Penelitian Badan Keahlian DPR RI Gd. Nusantara I Lt. 2 Jl. Jend. Gatot Subroto Jakarta Pusat - 10270 c 5715409 d 5715245 m infosingkat@gmail.com BIDANG HUBUNGAN INTERNASIONAL KAJIAN SINGKAT TERHADAP

Lebih terperinci

BAB 5 KESIMPULAN. Dampak krisis..., Adjie Aditya Purwaka, FISIP UI, Universitas Indonesia

BAB 5 KESIMPULAN. Dampak krisis..., Adjie Aditya Purwaka, FISIP UI, Universitas Indonesia 90 BAB 5 KESIMPULAN Republik Rakyat Cina memiliki sejarah perkembangan politik, sosial dan ekonomi yang sangat dinamis semenjak ribuan tahun yang silam. Republik Rakyat Cina atau RRC adalah merupakan salah

Lebih terperinci

STATUS KEPULAUAN DOKDO DALAM PERSPEKTIF HUKUM INTERNASIONAL (STUDI TERHADAP KASUS SENGKETA KEPULAUAN DOKDO ANTARA KOREA SELATAN-JEPANG) SKRIPSI

STATUS KEPULAUAN DOKDO DALAM PERSPEKTIF HUKUM INTERNASIONAL (STUDI TERHADAP KASUS SENGKETA KEPULAUAN DOKDO ANTARA KOREA SELATAN-JEPANG) SKRIPSI STATUS KEPULAUAN DOKDO DALAM PERSPEKTIF HUKUM INTERNASIONAL (STUDI TERHADAP KASUS SENGKETA KEPULAUAN DOKDO ANTARA KOREA SELATAN-JEPANG) SKRIPSI Diajukan guna memenuhi salah satu syarat untuk menyelesaikan

Lebih terperinci

H. BUDI MULYANA, S.IP., M.SI

H. BUDI MULYANA, S.IP., M.SI PENYELESAIAN SENGKETA INTERNASIONAL H. BUDI MULYANA, S.IP., M.SI Pasal 2 (3) dari Piagam PBB Semua anggota wajib menyelesaikan perselisihan internasional mereka melalui cara-cara damai sedemikian rupa

Lebih terperinci

Para filsuf Eropa menyebut istilah akhir sejarah bagi modernisasi yang kemudian diikuti dengan perubahan besar.

Para filsuf Eropa menyebut istilah akhir sejarah bagi modernisasi yang kemudian diikuti dengan perubahan besar. Tiga Gelombang Demokrasi Demokrasi modern ditandai dengan adanya perubahan pada bidang politik (perubahan dalam hubungan kekuasaan) dan bidang ekonomi (perubahan hubungan dalam perdagangan). Ciriciri utama

Lebih terperinci